Documenti di Didattica
Documenti di Professioni
Documenti di Cultura
○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○
REGULATIONS 2016
(Under Choice Based Credit System)
www.srec.ac.in
Information on the minimum number of Credits to be earned for the successful
completion of B.E./B.Tech. Programmes for
Sri Ramakrishna Engineering College was established in the year 1994 by SNR Sons Charitable Trust. It is an Autonomous
Institution since 2007 and accredited by NAAC with ‘A’ Grade.The Institution offers 9 Undergraduate Programs and 8
Post Graduate Programs in Engineering and Technology along with MBA. All eligible Programs have been accredited and
reaccredited by the NBA, New Delhi.
VISION
To develop into a leading word class Technological University consisting of Schools of Excellence in various disciplines
with a co-existent Centre for Engineering Solutions Development for worldwide clientele.
MISSION
To provide all necessary inputs to the students for them to grow into knowledge engineers and scientists attaining.
• Excellence in domain knowledge, practice and theory
• Excellence in co-curricular and Extra-curricular talents
• Excellence in character and personality
1. Engineering knowledge: Apply the knowledge of mathematics, science, engineering fundamentals, and an
engineering specialization to the solution of complex engineering problems.
2. Problem analysis: Identify, formulate, review research literature, and analyze complex engineering problems reaching
substantiated conclusions using first principles of mathematics, natural sciences, and engineering sciences.
3. Design/development of solutions: Design solutions for complex engineering problems and design system
components or processes that meet the specified needs with appropriate consideration for the public health and
safety, and the cultural, societal, and environmental considerations.
4. Conduct investigations of complex problems: Use research–based knowledge and research methods including
design of experiments, analysis and interpretation of data, and synthesis of the information to provide valid
conclusions.
5. Modern tool usage: Create, select, and apply appropriate techniques, resources, and modern engineering and IT
tools including prediction and modeling to complex engineering activities with an understanding of the limitations.
6. The engineer and society: Apply reasoning informed by the contextual knowledge to assess societal, health,
safety, legal and cultural issues and the consequent responsibilities relevant to the professional engineering
practice.
7. Environment and sustainability: Understand the impact of the professional engineering solutions in societal and
environmental contexts, and demonstrate the knowledge of, and need for sustainable development.
8. Ethics: Apply ethical principles and commit to professional ethics and responsibilities and norms of the engineering
practice.
9. Individual and team work: Function effectively as an individual, and as a member or leader in diverse teams, and in
multidisciplinary settings.
10. Communication: Communicate effectively on complex engineering activities with the engineering community and
with society at large, such as, being able to comprehend and write effective reports and design documentation,
make effective presentations, and give and receive clear instructions.
11. Project management and finance: Demonstrate knowledge and understanding of the engineering and management
principles and apply these to one’s own work, as a member and leader in a team, to manage projects and in
multidisciplinary environments.
12. Life–long learning: Recognize the need for, and have the preparation and ability to engage in independent and
life–long learning in the broadest context of technological change.
The Department of Aeronautical Engineering established in the year 2008, offers B.E. Aeronautical Engineering Programme
and is affiliated to Anna University, Chennai. The academic advisory boards of the department comprises of external
member drawn from renowned industries and Central Government research centers who contribute effectively to the
development of curriculum and syllabi. The prescribed courses of the program cover the areas such as Aerodynamics,
Aircraft Structures, Propulsion, Control Systems, Communication systems and Unmanned Aerial Vehicles which has been
designed to meet the challenges in the industries and R&D based Organizations. The department has well equipped
laboratories and Aircraft Hanger.
VISION
The Department of Aeronautical Engineering will strive and achieve the global recognition as a center of Excellence by imparting
quality education: leading to graduates becoming professionals with specialized knowledge in Aeronautical Engineering.
MISSION
To prepare the students to acquire good fundamental knowledge in various fields of Aeronautical Engineering, develop
problem solving skills and learn application oriented concepts.
• To prepare the students to have good social, moral and ethical values.
• To provide conducive environment to enhance the potential for sponsored research and consultancy projects.
***
* Candidates should choose the open electives not from the Programme of student
6 Credits to be completed from the list
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Use the vocabulary appropriately through reading and listening skills.
CO2 : Acquire effective speaking skills by means of rhetorical functions.
CO3 : Exhibit writing skills for effective business communication.
REFERENCES
1. Wood Cambridge University, "Business Benchmark Pre-intermediate to Intermediate Business Preliminary",
2nd Edition, Cambridge University Press, 2014.
2. Gerson Sharon J., Steven M.Gerson, "Technical Writing - Process and Product", 3rd Edition, Pearson Education (P)
Ltd., 2009.
3. Rizvi M.Ashraf., "Effective Technical Communication", Tata McGraw - Hill Publishing Company Limited, 2010.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_hs03.
2. www.cambridgeenglish.org/.
REFERENCES
1. Cambridge University, "Business Benchmark Pre-intermediate to Intermediate Business Preliminary",2nd Edition
Cambridge University Press, 2014.
2. Gerson, Sharon.J and Steven M.Gerson, "Technical Writing - Process and Product", 3rd Edition, Pearson Education
(P) Ltd.,2009.
3. Rizvi. M.Ashraf, "Effective Technical Communication", Tata McGraw - Hill Publishing Company Limited, 2010.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_hs03
2. www.cambridgeenglish.org/
CURRICULUM AND SYLLABUS 25
16CH206 ENVIRONMENTAL SCIENCE AND 3003
SUSTAINABILITY
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Discuss the environmental segments and various pollution control measures.
CO2 : Describe the ecosystem and explain the conservation of biodiversity.
CO3 : Explain the various natural resources and discuss the resource management systems.
CO4 : Summarize the impacts of social issues on the environment.
ENVIRONMENTAND POLLUTION 12
Introduction - Segments of environment - State of environment - Need for sustainable development - Traditional
conservational practices in India - Pollution - Causes, effects and control measures for air pollution, water pollution and
soil/land pollution - Climate change - Global warming - Ozone depletion- Pollution control norms - Carbon foot print -
Carbon trading - Environmental Ethics - Need for environmental education and eco-centric attitude - International treaties
and Conventions - an overview - Holistic value-based education for true sustainability
ECOSYSTEM 7
Introduction - Structure and function of an eco system - Ecological succession - Food chains - Food webs - Ecological
pyramids - Types of ecosystem - Forest, terrestrial ecosystem - Ecosystem services - Threats to ecosystem - Conservation
strategies.
BIODIVERSITY 8
Introduction - Genetic, species and ecosystem diversity - Biogeographical classification of India - Values of biodiversity
- Biodiversity at global, national and local levels - India as mega-diversity nation - Hot-spots of biodiversity - Threats in
biodiversity: Habitat loss, poaching of wildlife, man-wildlife conflicts - Red Data Book - Endangered and endemic species
of India - Conservation of biodiversity.
RESOURCES AND MANAGEMENT SYSTEMS 10
Resource management systems - Linear and cyclical - Circular economy - Industrial ecology - Green technology-applicable
to water resources, energy resources, food resources, land and forest resources. Waste management - e-waste management
- Green computing.
SOCIAL ISSUES 8
Impacts of social issues on the environment: Population, illiteracy, poverty, gender equality, class discrimination-Impacts
of development projects on tribal communities - Indigenous knowledge systems and traditions of conservations -
Environment Impact Assessment(EIA) - Environment Management Plan(EMP).
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Anubha Kaushik and Kaushik C. P., "Environmental Science and Engineering", 4th multicolour edition, New Age
International Pvt. Ltd., 2014.
2. Miller T.G., "Environmental Science", 4th Edition, Pearson Education, 2015.
REFERENCES
1. Linda D Williams, "Environmental Science, Demystified", Tata McGraw-Hill Edition, 2005.
2. Rajagopalan R., "Environmental Studies: From Crisis to Cure", Oxford University Press, 2011.
3. Daniel D Chiras, "Environmental Science", Jones and Bartlett Publishers, 2012.
WEB REFERENCE
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/104103020
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the various types of biomedical wastes and their management systems.
CO2 : Describe the methods of segregation and disposal of biomedical waste.
CO3 : Discuss the sustainable management practices for biomedical waste disposal.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the concept of performance evaluation of buildings.
CO2 : Identify the suitable green building materials and explain the recycling of demolition waste
CO3 : Summarize the best practices for the conservation of water.
CO4 : Identify suitable energy technology for conservation of energy in buildings.
CO5 : Select the suitable Green building materials & prepare life cycle assessment of materials.
REFERENCES
1. Jerry Yudelson, Marketing Green Building Services: Strategies for success, Elsevier, 2008 .
2. Jerry Yudelson, Marketing Green Buildings: Guide for Engineering, Construction and Architecture, The Fairmont
Press Inc., 2006
3. Angela. M. Dean, Green by Design: Creating a Home for Sustainable Living, Gibbs Smith Publication, 2003.
4. Kirby. J O, Keefe P, and Timberlake, Sustainable Development, Earthsean pub., 2001.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/120108004/module9/lecture12.pdf
2. https://ocw.mit.edu/courses/civil-and-environmental-engineering
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of this course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand the classification of construction and contracting firms.
CO2 : Illustrate the construction planning and resource planning and categorize the network techniques such as
Bar chart, Gant chart, PERT and CPM.
CO3 : Prepare the contract and tender documents and demonstrate the aspects for management systems such as
Labour laws, regulations.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, Students will be able to
CO1 : Outline engineering education and responsibilities of engineers.
CO2 : Identify career opportunities and development trends in Mechanical Engineering.
CO3 : Appraise the different functions of engineering.
CO4 : Recognize the role of ethics in engineering.
CO5 : Relate societal and cultural values in engineering.
CO6 : Infer hazards, health and safety in engineering.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Recall various quality concepts and imbibe the different TQM principles like customer satisfaction and
employee involvement.
CO2 : Conceptualize continuous process improvement and recognize the importance of Employee involvement
and performance measurement.
CO3 : Apply the various statistical process control charts to improve the quality of the product.
CO4 : Apply various tools like QFD and FMEA for quality improvement
CO5 : To interpret the concept of Quality Management Systems and recognize the need for ISO 9000 and ISO
14000 Quality Systems.
TQM PRINCIPLES AND APPROACHES 6
Definition of Quality, Dimensions of Quality, Factors affecting Quality, Quality Planning, Quality costs. Principles of
TQM: Evaluation, Concept and definition of TQM, principles, Models, characteristics, and benefits of TQM. Approaches
to TQM: Deming Philosophy, Barriers to TQM Implementation.
ESSENTIALS OF TQM 11
Customer focus, types of customer- customer perception of quality, customer satisfaction, customer retention, supplier
Partnership, TQM leadership- role and commitment and accountability of leadership, quality policy and objectives,
Organizational structure for TQM, role of HR in TQM, training for TQM, developing quality culture. Business Excellence
Models and Various national total quality awards
TOOLS AND TECHNIQUES FOR TQM 22
Continuous process improvement: Juran Trilogy, PDSA Cycle, 5S, Kaizen. Taguchi's Quality Engineering - Quality Loss
Function, quality circles and poka-yoke.
Seven quality control tools, Statistical methods for quality improvement, Process control -Control charts for variables: X,
R charts and Control charts for attributes - P, np, c and u charts. Concept of Process Capability, six sigma and new seven
management tools Benchmarking - Reasons to Benchmark, Benchmarking Process, Quality Function Deployment (QFD)
- House of Quality, QFD Process, Benefits, Total Productive Maintenance (TPM) - Concept, Improvement Needs, FMEA
- Stages of FMEA.
QUALITY MANAGEMENT SYSTEM 6
Introduction; major elements, ISO 9001:2015: Structure, clauses, contents, interpretation and implementation and Quality
audit. ISO 14000: Environmental Management System, elements, Model and benefits.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Dale.H.Besterfiled, et al., "Total Quality Management", Pearson Education Asia, 2nd Edition, 1999, Indian Reprint,
2002.
2. Subburaj Ramasamy., "Total Quality Management", Tata McGraw Hill, 2005.
REFERENCES
1. James.R.Evans, and William.M.Lidsay., "Management and Control of Quality", Thompson Learning, 2005.
2. Narayana.V and Sreenivasan.N.S., "Quality Management - Concepts and Tasks", New Age Publications
International Edition, 1996
3. Kanishka Bedi., "Total Quality Management", Oxford University Press, 2006.
4. Mukherjee.P.N, "Total Quality Management", Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd.,2005.
WEB REFERENCES
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/110101010/
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Demonstrate the understanding of work study concepts by drawing various charts, diagrams and by
performing time study
CO2 : Detail the Manual Process Planning and Computer Aided Process Planning (CAPP) methods
CO3 : Retrieve the concepts of production planning and control and perform ABC analysis
CO4 : Calculate the selling price, catalogue price of the product
CO5 : Calculate material cost, labour cost, and Estimate production cost for welding, casting and for various
machining operations
REFERENCES
1. Khan.M.I., "Industrial Engineering", New Age International Publishers, 1st Edition, 2004.
2. Charaya.J. S. and Narang G. S., "A Textbook of Estimating and Costing Mechanical", Satya Prakashan, 4th
Edition 1985.
3. Philip.E.Hicks., "Industrial Engineering And Management: A New Perspective", McGraw-Hill, 3rd Edition, 2007.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the development and major components of aircrafts.
CO2 : Describe the basic principles and current scenario of aerodynamics, propulsion and aircraft structures.
CO3 : Describe the communication systems and their development.
CO4 : Discuss basic electronics concepts.
AVIATION DEVELOPMENT 11
History of Aviation- India in Aviation -Components of an Airplane and their functions -Different Types of Flight Vehicles
- Classifications -Conventional and Powered Controls - Basic Instruments for flying - Frontiers of Aerospace Engineering.
AERODYNAMICS AND PROPULSION 11
Aerodynamics: Science behind bird Flight, Evolution of Lift, Drag and Moment - Types of wing planforms - Aerodynamic
characteristics of Airfoils - Mach Number - Propulsion: Basic ideas about Air breathing and Rocket Engines - Exploration
into Space -Renowned organizations of Aerodynamics and Propulsion.
AIRPLANE STRUCTURES AND MATERIALS 11
General Types of Construction: Monocoque, Semi Monocoque and Geodesic Construction -Typical Wing Structure -
Materials for airplane and space vehicles- Renowned organizations of aircraft structures.
COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS 12
Aircraft communication systems - Audio transmitter and receiver principles - VHF communication system - UHF
communication systems for aircraft - Frequency bands: UHF/VHF, S, L, Ka, Ku-Multipath propagation, Spectrum
Limitations-VHF Omni range - VOR receiver principles Global positioning system principles - Triangulation - position
accuracy -Applications in aviation - Auto Pilot System.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Anderson, J.D., "Introduction to flight", 8th Edition, McGraw Hill, 2015.
2. Dala R. Cundy, Rich S. Brown, "Introduction to Avionics", 2nd Edition, Pearson, 2011.
REFERENCES
1. Kermode A.C, "Flight without Formulae", 2nd Edition, McGraw-Hill, 1997.
2. Ralph D. Bent & James L. Mackinley, "Aircraft Basic Science", 6th Edition,McGraw-Hill, 1988.
3. Powell J. "Aircraft Radio Systems", 9th Edition,Pitman publishers, 2006.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the aircraft rules related to air worthiness under C.A.R series 'B', 'C' and 'D'.
CO2 : Explain the requirements of airworthiness certification through C.A.R. series 'E', C.A.R. 145 and 147.
CO3 : Explain the requirements and registration procedures of various aircrafts under C.A.R. series 'F'.
CO4 : Explain the components of C.A.R series 'M', 'T' & 'X'.
REFERENCES
1. "Aircraft Manual (India) Volume",Published by DGCA, 2000.
2. "Advisory Circulars", Published by DGCA, 2017.
WEB REFERENCE
Civil Aviation Requirements: http://dgca.nic.in/rules/car-ind.html.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the procedures for aircraft ground handling operation and its supporting units.
CO2 : Describe the servicing of subsystems and the safety regulations in aviation maintenance.
CO3 : Describe the special tools used in the aviation maintenance shop.
CO4 : Illustrate the aircraft hardware specification systems and their procedures of implementation.
REFERENCES
1. Airframe & Powerplant Mechanics, "Aircraft hand Book" - F.A.A (AC65-15A), II Volume, 2005.
2. Airframe & Powerplant Mechanics, "General hand Book" - F.A.A (AC65-9A), II Volume, 2005.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Summarize various engineering concepts and its functions.
CO2 : Express the role of engineers in society and outline the impact of technology.
CO3 : Illustrate the morals, values, ethics and responsibilities as an engineer.
CO4 : Demonstrate the legal and regulatory obligations for public health and safety.
PREREQUISITE
16EE205 Engineering, Society and Values
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Interpret the energy scenario and outline the techno-economic, environmental impacts of energy.
CO2 : Describe the socio-economic concepts related to impact of energy, climate changes and illustrate issues
related to conservation and sustainability.
CO3 : Summarize energy planning, management and auditing.
ECONOMIC AND ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACTS OF ENERGY 15
Development of life on Earth, Earth temperature and atmosphere, Geothermal cycles, Ecological principles of nature,
Global energy scenario - Energy definition, techno, economic, environmental and institutional aspects of energy - Different
forms of energy, renewable and non-renewable energy, modern forms of energy supply chains, cost and performance of
energy chains, hidden costs of energy, energy efficiency, overall efficiency of energy chain, end use technology.
ENERGYAND SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT 15
Energy usage, quality of life in rural and urban areas, economic poverty and energy poverty, impact of energy on
environment, concepts of climate changes and its impacts , Ecological foot prints of an individual , a family, an organization
and a region. Sustainable development issues, energy usage with respect to sustainable development. Energy conservation
opportunities in household, transport, lighting, Energy conservation Act, Global warming; greenhouse gas emissions,
impacts, mitigation.
ENERGY SYSTEMS AND ECONOMY 15
Energy systems: Past, present and future, management, planning and controlling, Integrated energy planning, role of
institutions in managing, the economic and industrial activity effect on energy systems. United Nations Framework
Convention on Climate Change (UNFCCC); Sustainable development; Kyoto Protocol; Conference of Parties (COP);
Clean Development Mechanism (CDM); Prototype Carbon Fund (PCF), Principles of energy auditing, basics of energy
estimation, energy audit and energy reporting process.
CASE STUDY:
The energy audit of an institution.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Hodge B. K, "Alternative Energy Systems and Applications", 1st Edition, Wiley Publication, 2009.
2. Hinrichs and Kleinbach, "Energy: Its use and the Environment", 5th Edition, Brookscole Cengage Learning, 2013.
REFERENCES
1. Aubrecht, Gorden J, "Energy", 2nd Edition,Prentice Hall, 1994.
2. Johnson H Reddy AKR and Williams R, Wiley Eatern, "Energy for sustainable World", Goldberg, 1998.
3. "Energy for the 21st century: A comprehensive guide in conventional and alternative sources".
4. Roy L. Nersesian, M. E. Sharpe, "Renewable Energy: Power for Sustainable Features", 2004, Godfrey Boyle, Oxford
University.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Demonstrate the concepts of human values and engineering ethics.
CO2 : Illustrate the responsibilities of engineers for safety and work place rights.
CO3 : Explain the role of engineers as managers and social experimenters.
CO4 : Categorize the importance of global issues.
REFERENCES
1. Fred Luthans, "Organizational Behavior", 12th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill Education Private Limited, 2011.
2. Nandagopal R and Ajith Sankar R N, "Indian Ethos and Values in Management", Tata McGraw Hill, 2010.
3. Charles E. Harris, Jr., Michael S. Pritchard and Michael J. Rabins, "Engineering Ethics, Concepts and Cases",
4th Edition, Cengage Learning, 2012.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the concepts of project management.
CO2 : Summarize the methods of project planning and implementation.
CO3 : Interpret the scope of financial accounting and financial management.
CO4 : Explain the financial planning for Entreprenueurs.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand the treatments done in industry to reduce the disposal.
CO2 : Acquire knowledge on waste generated in aluminium industry.
CO3 : Explain the waste generated from electrical utilities.
CO4 : Gain the knowledge on pollutants from food processing, iron and steel industries.
CO5 : Discuss about various pollutants created in petroleum and pharmaceutical industries.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO 1 : List the role of clinical engineers in health care.
CO2 : Describe the concepts of management and its requirements in health care.
CO3 : Enumerate information system requirements and management in health care.
CO4 : List the requirements for design of health care establishments.
REFERENCES
1. Azzam Taktak Paul Ganney David Long Paul White, Clinical Engineering, "A Handbook for Clinical and Biomedical
Engineers", 1st Edition, Academic Press, 2013.
2. Joseph Gyro, "The Clinical Engineering Hand Book", Elsevier, 2004.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the regulatory profession and the role of the regulatory professional throughout the product
Lifecycle.
CO2 : Apply the regulatory knowledge practically in industry, regulatory agencies, research and other
environments.
CO3 : Describe the bioethical principle applications in biomedical research.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Val Theiz, "Medical Device regulatory practices: An international Perspective", Pan Stanford, 2015.
2. Daniel A.Vallero, "Biomedical Ethics for Engineers" Elsevier, 2013.
REFERENCE
Jack Wong, Raymond Tong Kaiyu, "Handbook of Medical Device Regulatory Affairs in Asia", CRC Press, 2013.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand the basics of entrepreneurs and their characteristics.
CO2 : Understand the concept of biomedical industry and its present scenario in the real World market.
CO3 : Analyze the global healthcare market existing in different bioregions and the role played by the
entrepreneurs in social networking.
CO4 : Analyze the research strategies, alliances and their liability issues.
CO5 : Determine the business models for future profits and the product developmental issues in biomedical
industry.
CO6 : Determine the healthcare start-ups funding scenario in Indian market and the effect of crowd funding
towards supporting the growth of the biomedical industry.
MEDICAL INDUSTRY-A BUSINESS PERSPECTIVE 15
Entrepreneurship -Selfemployment, Characteristics of entrepreneurs, personal potential for entrepreneurs, recent research
review of entrepreneurship - Basiccharacteristics of biomedical industry, industry process and structures-drug development
- Biomedical business models, transformation of biomedical industry - Demographictrends, policy trends, technology
trends.
ENTREPRENEURSHIP IN LIFE SCIENCES 15
Dynamics at the global scale - Global healthcare market scale, global bioregions, comparison between UK and german
clusters, bioregions and their key characteristics, research led clusters - Social networks and entrepreneurship, innovation
networks in the field of biomedical industry - Research on strategic alliances, governance and consequence of alliances,
alliance as relational liability.
BUSINESS MODELS, DELIVERY OF HEALTHCARE SYSTEM AND INDIAN STARTUP SCENARIO 15
Business models for future profits - Global market and personalized medicine - Development of products in biomedical
industry - Emergence and role of healthcare start-ups in India, funding scenario in the indian healthcare sector, crowd
funding, measures to boost fund flow to healthcare start-ups in India.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOK
1. Holger Patzelt and Thomas Brennern, "Handbook of Bioentrepreneursip", Springer, 2008.
REFERENCES
1. Indian healthcare start-ups-An inside look into funding, KPMG (Professional Service Company in Netherlands
Klynveld Peat Marwick Goerdeler), 2016.
2. Steve Bull, "The future of biomedical industry in an era of globalization", Kellogg School of Management, 2015.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand online Social Networks and its impact on Society.
CO2 : Understand Social Media Marketing.
CO3 : Explain various Privacy and Security concerns on Online Social Media.
REFERENCES
1. Bannink, RienkeBroeren, Suzannevan de Looij - Jansen, Petra M, "Cyber and Traditional Bullying Victimization as
a Risk Factor for Mental Health Problems and Suicidal Ideation in Adolescents". PLoS ONE, Vol. 9 Issue 4, April
2014 - http://eds.b.ebscohost.com.libproxy.scu.edu /ehost/detail/
2. O'keeffe, G. S., and K. Clarke-Pearson. "The Impact of Social Media on Children, Adolescents, and Families."
Pediatrics, 800-04, 2011.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://www.amazon.com/Programming-Collective-Intelligence-Building-Applications/dp/0596529325
2. http://www.amazon.com/Practical-Web-Applications-Experts-Voice/dp/1590599063
3. http://www.amazon.in/The-Web-Application-Hackers-andbook
4. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106106146/ - "Privacy and Security in Online Social Networks"
5. http://scholarcommons.scu.edu/engl_176/2
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Interpret the Green IT fundamentals and Green Assets.
CO2 : Illustrate the Grid Frameworks and Green Compliance and to apply Green IT strategies.
CO3 : Identify the importance of Human happiness and Mental Health.
REFERENCES
1. Alin Gales, Michael Schaefer, Mike Ebbers, "Green Data Center: Steps for the Journey", Shoff/IBM Rebook, 2011.
2. John Lamb, "The Greening of IT", Pearson Education, 2009.
3. Jason Harris, "Green Computing and Green IT- Best Practices on Regulations andIndustry", Lulu.com, 2008.
4. Carl Speshocky, "Empowering Green Initiatives with IT", John Wiley and Sons, 2010.
5. Wu Chun Feng (Editor), "Green Computing: Large Scale energy efficiency", CRC Press, 2012.
WEB REFRENCES
1. http://conf.ncku.edu.tw/icot2013/ot.html
2. http://file.scirp.org/pdf/JSSM_2016101915182919.pdf
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO 1 : Understand of the key concepts, methods and tools for building future Engineers.
CO 2 : Develop techniques for establishing value of Financial Operations at Work Place.
CO 3 : Develop effective strategy for managing Projects at Work Place.
FOUNDATIONS OF MANAGEMENT 15
Management: Concept - Types of Business Organization - Contribution of F.W.Taylor and Henry Fayol - Organization
Chart, Structure and Process; Leadership, Traits, Styles; Current Trends in Management; Functional Areas of Management
- Marketing: Concepts, Segmentation, Targeting and Positioning (STP), User Interface (UI) and User Experience (UX) -
Business Development: Building Relationship through New Technology, Social Media and other Digital Avenues - HRM
- Concepts, Best Practices from Fortune 500 Companies.
FINANCIAL CONCEPTS FOR ENGINEERS 15
Short Term and Long Term of sources of finance - Cash Flow Statement - Working Capital Management - Crowd Funding
- Accounting Concepts and Principles - Profit and Loss Account - Balance Sheet.
PROJECT MANAGEMENT FOR ENGINEERS 15
Project Planning - Application of Gantt chart -Critical Milestones Chart- Tools for Tracking - Managing Time: Variance
Management and Earned Value - Managing Multiple Projects - Project Scheduling - Cost Management - Agile Project
Management - Lean Philosophy.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Harold Koontz and Heinz Weihrich, "Essentials of Management", Tata McGrawHill, 10th Edition, 2014.
2. Philip Kotlerand Kevin Lane Keller, "Marketing Management", Pearson Education, 15th Edition, 2016.
3. Gary Dessler and BijuVarkkey, "Human Resource Management", Pearson Education, 14th Edition, 2016.
4. Khan M.Y and Jain P.K, "Basic Financial Management", McGraw Hill, 3rd Edition, 2013.
5. M. Y. Khan and P. K. Jain, "Management Accounting: Text Problems and Cases", Tata McGraw Hill, 2013.
6. Russ J. Martinelli, Dragan Z. Milosevic, "Project Management Tool Box", Wiley Publications, 2016.
REFERENCES
1. Joseph L Massie, "Essentials of Management", Prentice Hall of India, 7th Edition, 2010.
2. Prasanna Chandra, "Fundamentals of Financial Management", Tata McGraw Hill, 8th Edition, 2012.
3. Pandey. I. M, " Financial Management", VikasPublishing House, 10th Edition, Reprint 2011.
4. S. N. Maheshwari, "Financial Accounting", Vikas Publishing House, 2012.
5. Clifford F. Gray, Erik W. Larson andGautam V. Desai, "Project Management", McGraw Hill, 6th Edition, 2014.
WEB REFERENCES
1. NPTEL Video - Introduction to Marketing: NOC16 Jan-Mar MG02
2. NPTEL Video - Principles of Management:KrassimirPetrov
3. NPTEL Video - Human Resource Management: Lec-7 Leadership Skills: Leadership and Management
4. NPTEL Video - Project Management Lectures
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO 1 : Understand the development of Entrepreneurship and the role of Entrepreneurial Institutions.
CO 2 : Apply the knowledge on Management of Technological Innovation and Startups.
CO3 : Develop Business Plan and explain operational implementations for Project Management.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Determine eigen values and eigenvectors and apply it in diagonalisation of matrices.
CO2 : Infer various aspects of differential geometry of curves.
CO3 : Find the extrema of functions of two variables.
CO4 : Determine area and volume using multiple integrals.
CO5 : Solve higher order linear ordinary differential equations that model engineering problems.
MATRICES 15
Characteristic equation - Eigenvalues and eigenvectors of a real matrix - Properties - Orthogonal transformation of a real
symmetric matrix to diagonal form - Quadratic form - Nature of quadratic forms - Reduction of quadratic form to canonical
form by orthogonal transformation.
DIFFERENTIAL CALCULUS 15
Curvature in cartesian co-ordinates - Centre and radius of curvature - Circle of curvature - Evolutes - Envelopes - Taylor's
expansion of functions of two variables - Jacobians - Maxima and Minima of functions of two variables - Method of
Lagrangian multipliers.
MULTIPLE INTEGRALS 15
Double integration in cartesian and polar co-ordinates - Change of order of integration in cartesian co-ordinates - Change
of variables from cartesian to polar coordinates - Triple integration in cartesian co-ordinates - Applications of multiple
integrals to find areas and volumes.
ORDINARY DIFFERENTIAL EQUATIONS 15
Solution of second and higher order linear differential equations with constant coefficients - Method ofvariation of
parameters - Cauchy's and Legendre's linear differential equations - Simultaneous first order linear differential equations
with constant coefficients.
Total Periods(45L+15T): 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. Veerarajan T., "Engineering Mathematics for first year", Tata McGraw Hill Publications, 2016.
2. Grewal B.S., "Higher Engineering Mathematics", 43rd Edition, Khanna Publications, 2014.
REFERENCES
1. Erwin Kreyszig, "Advanced Engineering Mathematics",10th Edition, Wiley India, 2016.
2. James Stewart, "Calculus, Early Transcendental", 7th edition, Cengage learning, 2015.
3. Ravish R. Singh and Mukul Bhatt, "Engineering Mathematics I & II", McGraw Hill Education Pvt Limited, 2016.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_ma06/course
CASE STUDIES
1. Mesh and nodal analysis for simple circuits.
2. Power transmission efficiency, minimizing the total power consumption.
3. Electric Circuits RL and RLC circuits.
4. Matrix nodal equations for a circuit.
5. Minimizing the error.
6. Computing average power in an electric circuit.
PREREQUISITE
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Apply Laplace transform techniques to solve ordinary differential equations.
CO2 : Find the analyticity of function of complex variables and interpret its transformations.
CO3 : Extend integration to the complex plane.
CO4 : Calculate grad, div and curl and establish identities connecting these equalities.
CO5 : Use Green's, Gauss and Stoke's theorems to simplify calculations of integrals and prove simple results.
LAPLACE TRANSFORMS 20
Transform of elementary functions -Properties - Transform of derivatives and integrals - Transform of unit step function,
Unit impulse function - Transform of periodic functions - Inverse Laplace transforms - Convolution theorem - Initial and
Final value theorems - Solution of linear second order ordinary differential equations with constant coefficients.
COMPLEX VARIABLES AND ITS APPLICATIONS 20
Analytic functions - Necessary and sufficient conditions- Cauchy - Riemann equations - Properties - Construction of
analytic functions - Conformal mapping: Bilinear transformation, w = z + c, cz, 1/z - Complex integration - Statement of
Cauchy's integral theorem - Cauchy's integral formula - Taylor's and Laurent's series expansions - Singular points -
Residues - Cauchy's residue theorem - Contour integration.
VECTOR CALCULUS 20
Gradient, Divergence and Curl - Directional derivative - Solenoidal and Irrotational vector fields - Vector integration -
Green's theorem in a plane, Gauss divergence theorem and Stoke's theorem - Simple applications involving cubes and
rectangular parallelopipeds.
Total Periods(45L+15T): 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. Veerarajan T, "Engineering Mathematics for first year", Tata McGraw Hill Publications, 2016.
2. Grewal B.S, "Higher Engineering Mathematics", 43rd Edition, Khanna Publications, 2014.
REFERENCES
1. Erwin Kreyszig, "Advanced Engineering Mathematics", 10th Edition, Wiley India, 2016.
2. Ravish R. Singh and Mukul Bhatt, "Engineering Mathematics I & II", McGraw Hill Education Pvt Limited, 2016.
3. Sastry S. S, "Engineering Mathematics Vol. I & II", PHI learning Pvt. Ltd, 4th Edition, 2014.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_ma06/course
CASE STUDIES:
1. Second order differential equation in Electric Circuits .
2. Contour Integrals in control theory.
3. Electro Magnetic field theory.
4. Transfer function of mechanical translation systems.
5. Linearizing a non linear function.
6. Image cloning.
7. Analysis and characterization of LTI systems using Laplace transform.
8. IIR system design using bilinear transformation.
PREREQUISITE
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Find the statistical measures that describe the distribution.
CO2 : Interpret the attributes of the population by studying the sample drawn from it.
CO3 : Apply Laplace transform techniques to solve second order ODE with constant coefficients.
CO4 : Transform a function in time domain to another function in the frequency domain through Fourier
Transform.
CO5 : Solve difference equations using Z transform.
REFERENCES
1. Erwin Kreyszig, "Advanced Engineering Mathematics", 9th Edition, Wiley India, 2014.
2. Ravish R. Singh and Mukul Bhatt, "Engineering Mathematics I & II", McGraw Hill Education Pvt Limited, 2016.
3. Grewal B.S., "Higher Engineering Mathematics", 43rd Edition, Khanna Publishers, 2014
4. Kandasamy P., Thilagavathy K., and Gunavathy K., "Engineering Mathematics'' Volume II, S. Chand & Company
ltd., 2014.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_ma06/course
CASE STUDIES
1. Analysis of statistical data by a census, computer network designs.
2. Sending signals over two way communication medium, analysis of HVAC.
3. Digital signal processing and image processing.
PREREQUISITE
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Find the analyticity of function of complex variables and interpret its transformations.
CO2 : Solve the problems using Cauchy's integral and residue theorems.
CO3 : Apply the concepts of vector calculus in determining area and volume.
CO4 : Formulate and solve problems involving functions of several variables in terms of PDE.
REFERENCES
1. Erwin Kreyszig, "Advanced Engineering Mathematics", 9th Edition, Wiley India, 2014.
2. Ravish R. Singh and Mukul Bhatt, "Engineering Mathematics I & II", McGraw Hill Education Pvt Limited, 2016.
3. Bali N. P and Manish Goyal, "Text book of Engineering Mathematics", 3rd Edition, Laxmi Publications (P) Ltd., 2015.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_ma06/course
CASE STUDIES
1. Bio signals.
2. Fluid mechanics.
3. Retinal Oxygen transport, hemodialyzer dynamics.
PREREQUISITES
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
16MA204 Laplace Transforms and Vector Calculus
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Formulate and solve the functions of several variables in terms of PDE.
CO2 : Construct the Fourier series expansion of a general periodic function.
CO3 : Apply Fourier series to solve boundary value problems.
CO4 : Transform a function using Fourier Transform.
CO5 : Solve difference equations using Z transform.
REFERENCES
1. Wylie C. Ray and Barrett Louis C., "Advanced Engineering Mathematics", 6th Edition, McGrawHill Inc., 2005.
2. Churchill R.V. and Brown J.W., "Fourier Series and Boundary Value Problems", 4th Edition, McGraw Hill Book Co.,
2005.
3. Simon Haykin and Barry Van Veen, "Signals and Systems", 2nd Edition, John Wiley and Sons, 2007.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_ma06/course
CASE STUDIES
1. Solving Equations for Transmission Lines.
2. Determination of Fourier series representation of continuous time and discrete time periodic signals.
3. Computation of Impulse response & Transfer function using Z Transform.
4. Electro Magnetic waves.
5. Fourier series representation of Half wave, Full wave rectifier output.
PREREQUISITES
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Formulate and solve problems involving functions of several variables in terms of PDE.
CO2 : Construct the Fourier series expansion of a general periodic function.
CO3 : Apply Fourier series to solve boundary value problems.
CO4 : Find numerical solutions of differential equations.
REFERENCES
1. Grewal B.S., "Higher Engineering Mathematics", 40th Edition, Khanna Publishers, 2008.
2. Wylie C. Ray and Barrett Louis C., "Advanced Engineering Mathematics", McGraw Hill Inc., 2010.
3. Curtis F. Gerald and Patrick O. Wheatley, "Applied Numerical Analysis", Pearson Education, 2012.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_ma06/course
CASE STUDY
Determination of Critical loads for Buckling a Column.
PREREQUISITES
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
16MA204 Laplace Transforms and Vector Calculus
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Form PDE and solve first and higher order PDE with constant coefficients.
CO2 : Compute the numerical solution of boundary value problems in partial differential equations using finite
difference method.
CO3 : Find Fourier constants in full and half range series.
CO4 : Use Fourier series to solve the 1D wave and heat equations, 2D Laplace's equations in cartesian
coordinates.
CO5 : Solve the Fourier transforms of functions of one variable.
REFERENCES
1. Veerarajan T., "Numerical Methods", Tata McGraw Hill Publications Co. Ltd., 2016.
2. Andrews L.A., and Shivamoggi B.K., "Integral Transforms for Engineers and Applied Mathematicians", Macmillen,
2006.
3. Churchill R.V. and Brown J.W., "Fourier Series and Boundary Value Problems", 4th Edition, McGrawHill Book Co.,
2005.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_ma06/course
PREREQUISITES
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
16MA204 Laplace Transforms and Vector Calculus
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Formulate and solve problems involving functions of several variables in terms of PDE.
CO2 : Find Fourier series solutions.
CO3 : Apply Fourier series to solve boundary value problems.
CO4 : Solve boundary value problems in partial differential equations.
REFERENCES
1. Grewal B.S., "Higher Engineering Mathematics", 40th Edition, Khanna Publishers, 2008.
2. Kandasamy P., Thilagavathy K., and Gunavathy K., "Engineering Mathematics'' Volume II, S. Chand & Company
Ltd., 2011.
3. Curtis F. Gerald and Patrick O. Wheatley, "Applied Numerical Analysis", Pearson Education, 2012.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_ma06/course
CASE STUDIES
1. Study of fluid flows.
2. One dimensional consolidation problems, structural dynamics of buildings.
3. Deflection of beams, Evaluation of settlement in buildings, Discharge or seepage rate of flow of hydraulic structures.
PREREQUISITES
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
16MA205 Statistics and Transforms
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Work on discrete structures using the basic concepts of sets.
CO2 : Identify and work on functions required in discrete structures.
CO3 : Apply the rules of mathematical logic for deriving logical conclusions of a given situation.
CO4 : Use the concepts of combinatorics to solve counting problems.
REFERENCES
1. Kenneth H. Rosen, "Discrete Mathematics and Its Applications", 4th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill,2008.
2. Trembly J.P. and Manohar R, "Discrete Mathematical Structures with Applications to Computer Science", 30th
Re-print, Tata McGrawHill Publishing Co. Ltd, 2007.
3. Lipschutz S. and Larson M. L., Schaum's "Outline of Theory and Problems of Boolean Algebra and Switching",
2nd Edition, PrenticeHall, 2005.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_ma01/course
CASE STUDIES
1. Graph traversal, database query design and processing.
2. Design of early computers and programming languages.
3. Analysis of algorithms and Optimization of algorithms.
PREREQUISITES
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Work on discrete structures using the basic concepts of sets.
CO2 : Apply the rules of mathematical logic for deriving logical conclusions of a given situation.
CO3 : Use the concepts of combinatorics to solve counting problems.
CO4 : Work on formal languages and turing machines which will be useful and essential in compiler design.
REFERENCES
1. Kenneth H.Rosen, "Discrete Mathematics and Its Applications", 7th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill, 2015.
2. Hopcroft and Ullman, "Introduction to Automata Theory, Languages and Computation", NarosaPublishing House,
2002.
3. Trembly J.P. and Manohar R, "Discrete Mathematical Structures with Applications to Computer Science", 30th
Re-print, Tata McGrawHill Pub. Co. Ltd, 2007.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_ma01/course
CASE STUDIES
1. Graph traversal, database query design and processing.
2. Analysis of algorithms, Optimization of Algorithms.
3. Communication protocol, artificial intelligence.
PREREQUISITES
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
16MA206 Complex Variables and Partial Differential Equations
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Find solutions of Linear equations.
CO2 : Interpret the interpolating function for a given data.
CO3 : Develop the concept of differentiation and integration numerically.
CO4 : Infer the solution of Differential Equations.
CASE STUDIES
1. Steady state behavior of biological linear systems.
2. Dynamic behavior of Biological systems.
3. Dynamics of membrane and nerve cell potentials.
PREREQUISITE
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Define a one dimensional random variable for a data and assess its distributions.
CO2 : Define a two dimensional random variable and find their interdependence.
CO3 : Classify a random process and summarize its properties.
CO4 : Find the spectral density of a random process.
RANDOM VARIABLES AND DISTRIBUTIONS 24
Random variable - Probability mass function - Probability density functions- Properties -Moments - Moment generating
functions and their properties.
Binomial, Poisson, Uniform, Exponential and Normal distributions- Functions of random variable.
TWO DIMENSIONAL RANDOM VARIABLE 12
Joint distributions - Marginal and conditional distributions - Transformation of random variables - Central limit theorem -
Covariance - Coefficient of correlation and regression lines.
RANDOM PROCESSES AND SPECTRAL DENSITIES 24
Stochastic processes - Classification - Stationary Processes, Wide sense stationary and Ergodic processes -Auto correlation
- Cross correlation - Properties - Markov, Binomial, Poisson and Sine wave processes.
Power spectral density - Cross spectral density - Properties - Wiener-Khintchine relation - Relationship between cross
power spectrum and cross correlation function - Linear time invariant system - System transfer function - Linear systems
with random inputs - Auto correlation and cross correlation functions of input and output.
Total Periods (45L +15T): 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. Veerarajan T., "Probability, Statistics and Random Processes", 2nd Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2016.
2. Ibe O.C., "Fundamentals of Applied Probability and Random Processes", 1st Indian Reprint, Elsevier, 2007.
REFERENCES
1. Peyton Z. Peebles and Bertram Emil Shi, "Probability Random Variables and Random Signal Principles", 4th Edition,
Tata McGraw-Hill Pubishers, 2015.
2. Sheldon M. Ross,"Probability Statistics for Engineering and Scientist", 6th Edition, Elsevier India Pvt Ltd Education,
2010.
3. Kandasamy P., Thilagavathy K.and GunavathyK.,''Probability, Statistics and Random Process" S.Chand & Co.,
2010.
WEB REFERENCE
https://online courses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_ma08/course
CASE STUDIES
1. To assess the performance of Digital modulation scheme-Binary phase shift keying.
2. The importance of Central limit theory in communication theory.
3. To assess the performance of Analog communication system-double sideband suppressed carrier.
PREREQUISITE
16MA207 Transforms and Partial Differential Equations
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Infer the outcome of a random experiment using probability techniques.
CO2 : Find the statistical measures that describe the distribution.
CO3 : Interpret the interdependence of two decision variables through regression.
CO4 : Interpret the attributes of the population by studying the sample drawn from it.
CO5 : Find numerical solutions of system of equations and Ordinary differential equations.
PROBABILITY DISTRIBUTIONS AND STATISTICS 24
Discrete and continuous distribution - Binomial distribution, Poisson distribution, Exponential distribution, Weibull
distribution and Normal distribution.
Measures of Central Tendency: Arithmetic Mean, Median, Mode and Standard deviation - Curve Fitting: Fitting of
straight line, Fitting of parabola and exponential curve by the principle of least square method - Karl Pearson's coefficient
of correlation and regression lines.
TESTING OF HYPOTHESIS 12
Testing of hypothesis - Large sample tests - Test of significance for single proportion, Difference of proportions, Single
mean and difference of means - Small sample tests: t- test for single mean and difference of means, F - test for variances.
NUMERICAL SOLUTIONS FOR LINEAR EQUATIONS AND ORDINARY DIFFERENTIAL
EQUATIONS 24
Solution of algebraic and transcendental equation - Regula Falsi method - Newton's method - Solution of linear system by
Gaussian elimination and Gauss Jordon methods - Iterative methods: Gauss Jacobi and GaussSeidel methods. Single step
methods: Taylor series method, Euler and modified Euler methods, Fourth order Runge Kutta method for solving first
order differential equations - Multistep methods: Milne's and Adam's predictor and corrector methods.
Total Periods (45L +15T): 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. VeerarajanT.,"Probability, Statistics and Random Processes", Tata McGrawHill, 2016.
2. Gerald C.F. and WheatleyP.O., "Applied Numerical Analysis", 6th Edition, Pearson Education Asia, 2010.
REFERENCES
1. Ross S., "A first Course in Probability", 5th Edition, Pearson Education, 2006.
2. Gupta S.C., and Kapur V.K., "Fundamentals of Mathematical Statistics", 9th Edition , Sultan Chand, 2010.
3. Kandasamy P., Thilagavathy K., and Gunavathy K., "Numerical Methods", S.Chand Co. Ltd., 2016.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_ma03/preview
CASE STUDIES
1. Power system stability.
2. Analysis of variances in circuits.
3. Load flow Analysis.
4. Error Analysis in measurement system.
5. Noise and Vibration measurements.
6. Discretization of I and II order systems using Runge Kutta method.
PREREQUISITE
16MA208 Partial Differential Equations and Numerical Methods
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Find the statistical measures that describe the distribution.
CO2 : Interpret the interdependence of two decision variables through regression.
CO3 : Infer the outcome of a random experiment using probability techniques.
CO4 : Interpret the attributes of the population by studying the sample drawn from it.
CO5 : Find the reliability of systems.
STATISTICS 15
Types of data, Data collection, Interpretation and Presentation of data, Frequency distribution - Measures of central
tendancy -Variance and Standard deviation - Moments - Correlation - Karl Pearson's coefficient of correlation - Regression
- Regression coefficients - Regression lines.
PROBABILITY 15
Random variable - Probability mass function - Probability density function - Properties - Moment generating functions-
Standard Distributions: Poisson, Exponential, Normal distributions and their properties.
SAMPLING THEORY 15
Testing of hypothesis - Large sample tests:Test of significance for single proportion, Difference of proportions, Single
mean and difference of means - Small sample tests: t- test for single mean and difference of means, F- test for variances, Chi
square test for goodness of fit and independence of attributes.
RELIABILITY 15
Definition of reliability, Failures, Classification of failures, Measures of reliability - Failure rate, Mean-time-to-failure
(MTTF), Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF), Reliability function, Reliability specifications - System reliability - Reliability
of series, parallel and standby systems.
Total Periods (45L +15T): 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. Hooda R. P., "Introduction to Statistics", Macmillan India Ltd, 2002.
2. Sheldon M. Ross, "Probability and Statistics for Engineers and Scientists", Elsevier India Private Ltd, 2010.
REFERENCES
1. Neil A. Weiss, "Introductory Statistics", Pearson Education, 2007.
2. Ronald E.Walpole, Raymond H. Myers and Sharon L. Myers, "Probability & Statistics for Engineers and Scientists",
Prentice Hall of India Private Ltd, 1998.
3. Gupta S.C. and Kapoor V.K., "Fundamentals of Mathematical Statistics", Sultan Chand & Sons, 2014.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_ma03/preview
CASE STUDIES
1. Formation of a linear regression equation for the prediction of surface roughness of a turned work piece.
2. Chi squared test for the thickness measurement of a mechanical parts for 'n' number of successive items.
PREREQUISITE
16MA210 Partial Differential Equations and Boundary Value Problems
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Test the hypothesis using small and large sampling and analyze the variance.
CO2 : Interpret the interdependence of two decision variables through regression.
CO3 : Find numerical solutions of differential equations.
CO4 : Develop the concept of differentiation and integration numerically.
STATISTICS 24
Testing of hypothesis - Large sample tests: Test of significance for single proportion, Difference of proportions, Single
mean and difference of means - Small sample tests: t- test for single mean and difference of means, F- test for variances, Chi
square test for goodness of fit and independence of attributes- Correlation and regression lines - ANOVA table for one
way and two way classification - Completely randomized design - Randomized block design - Latin Square design.
SOLUTION OF EQUATIONS AND INTERPOLATION 18
Solution of algebraic and transcendental equations - Regula Falsi method - Newton's method - Solution of linear system
by Gaussian elimination and Gauss Jordon methods - Inverse of a matrix by Gauss Jordon method - Iterative methods:
Gauss Jacobi and Gauss Seidel methods - Eigen value of a matrix by power method - Interpolation - Newton's forward and
backward interpolation - Lagrange's interpolation - Newton's Divided difference interpolation - Curve fitting and principle
of least squares.
INITIAL VALUE PROBLEMS, NUMERICAL DIFFERENTIATION AND INTEGRATION 18
Single step methods: Taylor series method, Euler and modified Euler methods, Fourth order Runge Kutta method for
solving first order equations - Multistep methods: Milne's and Adam's predictor and corrector methods.
Derivatives using Newton's forward and backward interpolation - Numerical integration by Trapezoidal and Simpson's
1/3 and 3/8 rules - Two and Three point Gaussian quadrature formula - Double integrals using Trapezoidal and Simpson's
rule.
Total Periods (45L +15T): 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. VeerarajanT.,"Probability, Statistics and Random Processes", 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw Hill,2008.
2. Gerald C.F. and WheatleyP.O.,"Applied Numerical Analysis", 7th Edition, Pearson Education Asia, 2007.
REFERENCES
1. Kandasamy P., Thilagavathy K., and Gunavathy K., "Numerical Methods", S.Chand Co. Ltd.,2010.
2. Veerarajan T., "Numerical Methods", Tata McGraw Hill Publishing Co.Ltd, 2011.
3. Sheldon M.Ross., "Introduction to Probability and Statistics for Engineers and Scientists", 5th Edition,2014.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_ma03/preview
CASE STUDIES
1. Environmental related problems.
2. Trial and error method for civil engineering problems.
3. Survey problems(area calculation).
PREREQUISITE
16MA209 Partial Differential Equations and Fourier Transforms
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Compute the solution of algebraic and transcendental equations and solve the systems of simultaneous
equations.
CO2 : Interpolate the data using forward and backward difference formula for equal intervals and divided
difference formula for unequal intervals.
CO3 : Determine the numerical differentiation and integration.
CO4 : Calculate the solutions of initial value problems for ordinary differential equations using single and multi
step methods.
CO5 : Describe the brachistochrone and isoperimetric problems mathematically and solve it.
NUMERICAL SOLUTION OF ALGEBRAIC AND TRANSCENDENTAL EQUATIONS 12
Linear interpolation methods -Method of False position- Newton's method - Solution of linear system by Gaussian
elimination and Gauss Jordon methods - Inverse of a matrix by Gauss Jordon method - Iterative methods: Gauss Jacobi
and Gauss Seidel methods - Eigenvalue of a matrix by power method.
NUMERICAL DIFFERENTIATION AND INTEGRATION 24
Newton's forward and backward interpolation - Lagrange's interpolation - Divided differences - Interpolating with a cubic
spline - Derivatives using Newton's forward and backward interpolation - Numerical integration by Trapezoidal and
Simpson's 1/3 and 3/8 rules - Two and Three point Gaussian quadrature formula - Double integrals using Trapezoidal and
Simpson's rule.
INITIAL VALUE PROBLEMS FOR ORDINARY DIFFERENTIAL EQUATIONS 12
Single step methods: Taylor series method - Euler and modified Euler methods - Fourth order
∞ Runge Kutta method for
solving first order equations - Multistep methods: Milne's and Adam's predictor and corrector methods.
CALCULUS OF VARIATIONS 12
Optimization of functional - Euler - Lagrange equations - First variation - Isoperimetric problems - Rayleigh - Ritz method.
Total Periods (45L +15T):60
TEXT BOOKS
1. Veerarajan T., "Numerical Methods", Tata McGraw Hill Publications Co. Ltd., 2016.
2. Grewal B.S., "Higher Engineering Mathematics", 43rd Edition, Khanna Publishers,2014.
REFERENCES
1. Gerald C.F. and Wheatley P.O., "Applied Numerical Analysis", 6th Edition, Pearson Education Asia, 2010.
2. Wylie C. Ray and Barrett Louis C., "Advanced Engineering Mathematics", 6th Edition, McGrawHill, Inc., 2005.
3. Kandasamy P., Thilagavathy K., and Gunavathy K, "Numerical Methods", S.Chand Co. Ltd., 2016.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_ma03/preview
CASE STUDIES
1. Fluid Flow Applications.
2. Gas Dynamics and Heat Transfer.
3. Fluid Flow Applications.
4. Control and Dynamic Systems, Approximate method of Vibrations.
PREREQUISITES
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
16MA205 Statistics and Transforms
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the knowledge of discrete distributions and solve problems in it.
CO2 : Illustrate the knowledge of continuous distributions and one dimensional random variables which can
describe real life phenomena.
CO3 : Use the concept of two dimensional random variables and apply it to determine correlation and regression.
CO4 : Identify and classify the types of random process and Markov process.
CO5 : Apply the basic characteristic features of queuing system and analyze the queueing models.
REFERENCES
1. Taha H. A., "Operations Research-An Introduction", 7th Edition, Pearson Education Edition Asia, 2011.
2. Allen A.O., "Probability, Statistics and Queuing Theory", Academic press, 2002.
3. Gross D. and Harris C.M., "Fundamentals of Queuing theory", 2nd Edition, John Wiley and Sons, 2005.
WEB REFERENCE
https://online courses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_ma08
CASE STUDIES
1. Signal modulation and demodulation, calculation of insurance risk.
2. Implications in communication theory.
3. Cryptography and crypt analysis.
4. Scheduling and resource sharing in computer operating systems and analysis of computer networks.
PREREQUISITE
16MA219 Probability and Queueing Theory
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Formulate and solve real life situations involving linear variables.
CO2 : Optimize transportation and assignment problems.
CO3 : Find integer solutions of Linear Programming Problem.
CO4 : Plan inventory situations.
CO5 : Construct and interpret project network.
LINEAR PROGRAMMING 12
Formulation of Linear Programming models - Graphical solution - Simplex method -Artificial Variable Techniques - Duality
- Primal-dual relationship - Dual Simplex method.
TRANSPORTATION AND ASSIGNMENT PROBLEMS 12
Transportation Problem - Standard transportation problem - Unbalanced transportation problem - Initial Basic feasible
solution by Vogel's Approximation Method - Optimal solution by MODI method - Assignment problem - Standard assignment
problem - Unbalanced assignment problem - Hungarian method - Travelling salesman problem.
INTEGER PROGRAMMING 12
Formulation of Integer Programming models - Gomory's all integer programming problem - Gomory's mixed integer
programming problem - Branch and bound technique.
INVENTORY MODELS 12
Inventory Models - EOQ models (with and without shortages) - EPQ models (with and without shortages) - EOQ with
price breaks - Quantity discounts models - Inventory problems with uncertain demand.
NETWORK SCHEDULING 12
Network and basic components - Rules of network construction - Time calculations in networks - Critical path method -
Project Evaluation and Review Technique - PERT calculations - Resource Analysis in Network Scheduling.
Total Periods (45L +15T): 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. Taha H.A., "Operation Research", 8th Edition, Prentice Hall of India,2011.
2. KantiSwarup,GuptaP.K. and Manmohan, "Operations Research", Sultan Chand & sons, 2010.
REFERENCES
1. Fredrick S. Hillier and Gerald J. Liebermann, "Introduction to Operations Research", 8th Edition,McGrawHill, 2011.
2. Anderson, "Quantitative Methods for Business", 10th Edition, Thomson Learning, 2009.
3. Sharma J.K., "Operations Research Theory and Applications", 3rd Edition, MacMillan Business Books, 2006.
WEB REFERENCE
https://online courses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_mg10
CASE STUDIES
1. Allocation of resources among competitive means, product replacement problem, diet problem.
2. Knapsack problem.
3. Binary Integer Programming for time tabling.
4. Enterprise resource planning.
5. Transportation logistics.
PHYSICS
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the principle and working of different types of Lasers with their applications.
CO2 : Outline the principle, structure, propagation and applications of Optical fibers.
CO3 : Explain the characteristics of magnetic materials used for storing data.
PHOTONICS 15
Lasers: Introduction - Characteristics of Laser - Principle - Types of lasers - CO2,Nd-YAG and Semiconductor laser -
Applications: 3D profiling - Computer peripherals - Material processing - Holography.
Fiber Optics: Introduction - Principle - Structure - Modes of Propagation -Joining of Fibers - Splicing - Losses in optical
fiber - attenuation, dispersion - Applications - Fiber optical communication - Fiber optic sensors.
MAGNETIC AND OPTICAL MATERIALS 15
Magnetic Materials:Introduction-Classification of magnetic materials - Quantum numbers - Magnetic moment - Classification
- dia, para, ferro and antiferromagnetic materials - Ferrites - Hard and soft magnetic materials - Magnetic recording
materials - Bubble memory - Magnetic principle in computer data storage devices.
Optical Materials: Introduction-Classification of optical materials - Absorption in metals, insulators and Semiconductors
- LED's - Organic LED's - Polymer light emitting materials - Plasma light emitting devices - LCD's - Optical data storage
techniques -DVD, Blue -ray disc and Holographic data storage.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Gaur R K and Gupta S L, "Engineering Physics", Dhanpat Rai Publications, 2013.
2. Avadhanalu M N, and Kshirsagar P G, "A Textbook of Engineering Physics", S. Chand & Company Ltd,2014.
REFERENCES
1. Charles Kittel, "Solid State Physics", John Wiley and Sons, 8th Edition, 2012.
2. Raghavan V, "Materials Science and Engineering - A first Course", President Hall of India, 5th Edition, 2004.
WEB REFERENCES
1. Laser: http://nptel.ac.in/syllabus/syllabus.php?subjectId=1151041
2. Optical Fiber: http://nptel.ac.in/syllabus/syllabus.php?subjectId=115103034
3. http://nptel.ac.in/course.php?disciplineId=115
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the applications of electrochemical cells and Fuel cells.
CO2 : Explain the properties and applications of engineering polymers.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Jain P C and Monica Jain, "Engineering Chemistry", 16th Edition, Dhanpat Rai publishing Co., 2015.
2. Ragunath L, "Engineering Chemistry", 1st Edition, Mc Graw Hill Education, 2016.
REFERENCES
1. Dara S S, "A text book of Engineering Chemistry", S.Chand & Co. Ltd., 2013
2. Shashi chawla, "A Textbook of Engineering chemistry", 12th Edition, Dhanpat rai publications, 2010.
3. Vairam S and Suba Ramesh "Engineering Chemistry", 2nd Edition, Wiley India Private Limited; 2013.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/122101001/downloads/lec-23.pdf
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/104105039
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Determine the rigidity and young’s modulus of a material.
CO2 : Estimate the efficiency of the solar cell and to study its characteristics.
CO3 : Determine the wavelength of laser and to determine the particle size.
CO4 : Demonstrate the Sputtering unit and study lattice parameters of materials using XRD.
CO5 : Calculate the acceptance angle and numerical aperture of the optical fibers.
CO6 : Determine the dielectric constant value of the given material.
CO7 : Estimate the energy band gap of a semiconductor.
CO8 : Estimate the energy loss in a magnetic material.
CO9 : Determine the thickness of the thin object and Thermal conductivity of bad conductor.
CO10 : Determine the co-efficient of viscosity of the given liquid.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Analyse the various water quality parameters quantitatively.
CO2 : Determine the strength of acid using pH meter.
CO3 : Estimate the mixture of acids by conductometric method.
CO4 : Estimate the elements present in alloys by EDTA method.
CO5 : Estimate the ferrous iron in solution using potentiometer.
CO6 : Estimate nickel in solution by spectrophotometry.
CO7 : Determine the efficiency of corrosion inhibitors.
CO8 : Analyse the anodizing of aluminium and thickness of the anodic film.
CO9 : Determine the molecular weight of polymers.
CO10 : Demonstrate the particle size analysis of Nanomaterials.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Outline the generation of laser light and classify the different optical fibers with their applications.
CO2 : Explain the characteristics of sound waves and the factors affecting the acoustics of buildings.
CO3 : Describe the elastic properties of matter.
CO4 : Summarize the properties of fluids and to measure the pressure using gauges.
CO5 : Interpretthe behaviour of gas mixture under varying pressure, temperature and volume.
REFERENCES
1. Rajput, R.K., "A Text book of Fluid Mechanics in SI Units", 7 th Edition, S.Chand and Company, 2007.
2. Younus.A.Cengel, and Michael A.Boles, "Thermodynamics", Tata McGraw Hill, 5th Edition, 2007.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/122107035/
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112104113/
3. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112104026/
4. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/115107095/
5. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/115107095/
6. https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_me16/preview
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Outline the generation of laser light and classify the different optical fibers with their applications.
CO2 : Explain the characteristics of sound waves and the factors affecting the acoustics of buildings.
CO3 : Gain the knowledge of crystal structures and crystal defects.
CO4 : Describe the elastic properties of matter.
CO5 : Summarize the properties of smart materials.
PHOTONICS AND ACOUSTICS 18
LASERS: Characteristics of Laser - Principle of spontaneous emission and stimulated emission- Types of lasers -
Principle, Construction, Working, Properties, Merits, Demerits and applications of CO2 andNd-YAG laser - Applications:
3D profiling - Material processing - Holography.
FIBER OPTICS: Principle- Structure - Modes of propagation - Classification based on materials and refractive index
profile - Photonic sensors - Temperature and Displacement measurement.
ACOUSTICS: Classification of sound - Characteristics of musical sound - Weber-Fechner law - Reverberation time -
Absorption coefficient and its determination - factors affecting acoustics of buildings - Remedies.
CRYSTAL PHYSICS 9
Introduction - Lattice - Bravais Lattice - Lattice Planes - Miller Indices - d-spacing in cubic lattice - Relation between miller
indices and d spacing of a cubic system - Cubical Crystal System - Types - SC, BCC,FCC and HCP structures - Calculation
of Co-ordination number, Number of atoms per unit cell - Atomic radius and Atomic Packing Factor - Crystal defects -
point, line and surface defects.
PROPERTIES OF MATTER 9
Concepts of stress and strain - Elastic limit - Hooke's law - Factor of safety - Lateral strain - Poisson's ratio -Types of
Elastic Moduliiand relationship between elastic constants - Non-linear Elastic Properties - Beyond the Elastic range -
Fracture -Yield Point - Yield Strength - Tensile Strength - Ductility - Hardness - Mohs hardness Scale - Toughness.
SMART MATERIALS 9
Introduction to Smart materials - Actuator and actuator materials - Piezoelectric and Electrostrictive material -
Magnetostrictive material - Shape memory alloys - Electro-rheological fluids - Electromagnetic actuation - Role of Actuators
and Actuator materials.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Gaur R K and Gupta S L, "Engineering Physics", Dhanpat Rai Publications, 2013
2. William D.Callister Jr, David G. Rethwisch "Materials Science and Engineering - An Introduction", 8th Edition,Wiley
India (P) Ltd., 2009.
REFERENCES
1. Brain Culshaw, "Smart Structure and Materials", 2nd Edition, Artech House, 2004.
2. Jayakumar S, "Engineering Physics", R K Publishers, 2003.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://ocw.mit.edu/courses/materials-science-and-engineering/
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/122107035/
3. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112104026/
4. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/115107095/
5. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/115107095/
6. https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_me16/preview
CURRICULUM AND SYLLABUS 77
16PH209 APPLIED PHYSICS 3003
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Demonstrate the principle and working of different types of Lasers including their applications.
CO2 : Explain the principle, structure, fabrication and classification of Optical fibers.
CO3 : Gain the knowledge of joining the optical fibers, attenuation, dispersion and application of optical fibers.
CO4 : Explain the elastic and plastic nature of the material.
CO5 : Apply the concept of generation, detection and application of Ultrasonic waves.
CO6 : Explain the methods for producing and measuring vacuum and Thermodynamics.
LASERS 9
Introduction - Characteristics of Laser - Einstein's Theory - Principle of spontaneous emission and stimulated emission -
Types of lasers - Principle - Construction - Working - Properties - Merits - Demerits and applications of CO2,Nd-YAG and
Semiconductor laser - Applications: 3D profiling - Computer peripherals - Material processing - Holography.
FIBER OPTICS 9
Introduction - Principle - Structure - Modes of propagation - Fabrication method - Crucible-crucible technique - Classification
based on modes of Propagation, materials and refractive index profile - Joining of Fibers - Splicing -Losses in optical fiber
- Attenuation, dispersion - Applications - Fiber optical communication - Fiber optic sensors - Temperature and Displacement
measurement.
PROPERTIES OF MATTER 9
Elasticity: Elastic and Plastic materials - Hooke's law - Elastic behavior of a material - Stress-Strain diagram - Factors
affecting elasticity - Three Moduli of Elasticity - Poisson's Ratio - Torsional Pendulum - Twisting couple on a cylinder -
Young's Modulus - Uniform bending - Non-uniform bending.
ULTRASONICS 6
Production - Magnetostriction generator - Piezoelectric generator - Detection - Properties - Acoustical Grating - Cavitation
- Applications - Drilling, Welding, Soldering and Cleaning - Non-Destructive Testing - Pulse Echo method - Ultrasonic
Imaging.
VACUUM TECHNOLOGY 6
Concepts of vacuum - Throughput, Pumping Speed, Effective Pumping Speed and Conductance - Types of Pumps -
Rotary - Diffusion - Turbo Molecular Pump - Operation of Pressure gauges - Pressure range - Measurement of Vacuum
using Pirani and Penning gauges - Working of a vacuum system.
THERMODYNAMICS 6
Introduction to Thermodynamics - Heat and Work - Law of conservation of energy - Zeroth and First Law of Thermodynamics
- Carnot Heat Engine.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Gaur R K and Gupta S L, "Engineering Physics", Dhanpat Rai Publications, 2013.
2. Avadhanalu M N and Kshirsagar P G, "A Textbook of Engineering Physics", S. Chand and Company Ltd, 2014.
REFERENCES
1. Marikani A, "Engineering Physics", PHI Learning Private Limited, 2013.
2. Rao V V, Ghosh T B and Chopra K L, "Vacuum Science and Technology", Allied Publishers Limited, 1998.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_ph01/preview
2. https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_ae04/preview
3. http://nptel.ac.in/course.php?disciplineId=115
4. http://www.physicsclassroom.com/class/thermal?
COURSE OUTCOMES
CO1 : Explain the basics of mechanics and their applications.
CO2 : Summarize the properties of fluids.
CO3 : Gain the knowledge of ionizing and non-ionizing radiations and their effects on biological system.
CO4 : Explain the concept ofgeneration, detection and application of Ultrasonic waves.
CO5 : Summarize crystal systems and crystal defects.
BASICS OF MECHANICS 12
Kinematics and Dynamics: Displacement, Velocity and Acceleration - Uniform Circular Motion, Relative Motion - Force,
Newton's Laws of Motion and Law of Gravitation - Principle of Superposition - Equilibrium of Forces - Linear Momentum,
Conservation of Linear Momentum - Impulse.
Work and Energy: Work done by a Constant Force and a Variable Force; Kinetic Energy and Work-Energy Theorem,
Potential Energy and Conservative Forces, Energy Diagrams; Elastic and Inelastic Collisions - Power.
Angular Motion: Angular Displacement, Angular Velocity and Angular Acceleration - Dynamics of Angular Motion -
Torque - Angular Momentum.
FLUIDS 9
Viscosity - Co-efficient of critical velocity - Poiseuille's formula for co-efficient of viscosity and its correction - Determination
of co-efficient of viscosity by capillary flow method - Comparison of viscosities - Oswald's viscometer - Viscosity of a
highly viscous liquid - Stoke's method for the Co-efficient of a highly viscous liquid - Variations of viscosity with
temperature and pressure - Viscosity of gases - Mayer's formula for the rate of flow of a gas through a capillary tube -
Rankine's method for the determination of viscosity of a gas.
ELECTRO MAGNETIC RADIATIONS 9
Radiation - Types of radiation - Ionization and Excitation - Interaction of radiation with matter - Linear energy transfer -
Attenuation -attenuation co-efficient - Biological effects of radiation - Direct and indirect effects: chronic and acute
effects - Biological effect of Microwave and RF wave - Thermal and non-thermal effects on whole body - Types of optical
radiations - UV, visible and IR - Optical properties of tissues - Applications of optical radiations in detection and treatment
of skin disorders - Medical applications of Lasers.
ULTRASONICS 6
Introduction - Production - Magnetostriction generator - Piezoelectric generator - Detection of ultrasonics - Properties
- Acoustical Grating - Cavitation- Non-Destructive Testing - Pulse echo method - ultrasonic imaging -Medical Applications.
CRYSTAL PHYSICS 9
Introduction - Lattice - Bravais Lattice - Lattice Planes - Miller Indices - d-spacing in cubic lattice - Relation between miller
indices and d spacing of a cubic system - Cubical Crystal System - Types - SC, BCC, FCC and HCP structures - Calculation
of Co-ordination number, Number of atoms per unit cell - Atomic radius and Atomic Packing Factor - Crystal defects -
Point, Line and Surface defects - Role of imperfection in electrical and optical properties.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Gaur R K and Gupta S L, "Engineering Physics", Dhanpat Rai Publications, 2013.
2. Herman Cember, Thomas E Johnson. "Introduction to Health Physics", 4th Edition, McGraw Hill, 2009.
REFERENCES
1. Murugesan R., "Properties of Matter and Acoustics", S.Chand and Company, 2005.
2. Avadhanalu M N, and Kshirsagar P G, "A Textbook of Engineering Physics", S.Chand & Company Ltd, 2014.
3. Johns and Cunningham, "The Physics of Radiology", 3rd Edition, Thomas, 1969.
PREREQUISITE
16PH207 Engineering Physics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the elements of Nanotechnology.
CO2 : Outline the various fabrication methods of nanomaterials.
CO3 : Summarize the various characterization techniques of nano structures and their applications.
CO4 : Relate the properties of smart and nano materials and their applications.
BASICS AND SCALE OF NANOTECHNOLOGY 12
Definition of a nanosystem - Dimensionality and size dependent phenomena - Surface to volume ratio - Fraction of surface
atoms - Surface energy and surface stress - surface defects - Properties at nanoscale: optical - mechanical - electronic and
magnetic properties.
CLASSIFICATION AND FABRICATION OF NANOSTRUCTURES 13
Classification based on dimensionality - Quantum Dots,Wells and Wires - Carbon based nano materials -buckyballs -
nanotubes - graphene-Top Down and Bottom Up Process:Metal Nanocrystals by Reduction - Solvothermal Synthesis -
Photochemical Synthesis - Sonochemical Routes - Chemical Vapor Deposition (CVD) - Metal Oxide Chemical Vapor
Deposition (MOCVD) - Ball Milling - Electrodeposition - Spray Pyrolysis - Flame Pyrolysis - DC/RF Magnetron Sputtering
- Molecular Beam Epitaxy (MBE).
CHARACTERIZATION TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS OF NANOSTRUCTURES 12
X Ray Diffraction (XRD) - Scanning Electron Microscopy (SEM) -Transmission Electron Microscope (TEM) - Atomic
Force Microscopy (AFM) - Optical: Ultaviolet Absorption and Photoluminescence Technique - Solar energy conversion
and catalysis - Applications: Sensors, Carbon nanotubes and fullerenes.
SMART MATERIALS 8
Introduction to Smart materials - Actuator and actuator materials - Piezoelectric and Electrostrictive material -
Magnetostrictive material - Shape memory alloys - Applications of SMA in Precision equipments for automobiles - SMA
- Phases - Shape memory effect - Pseudoelastic effect - Ni-Ti alloys.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Pradeep T., "A Textbook of Nanoscience and Nanotechnology", Tata McGraw Hill Education Pvt. Ltd., 2012.
2. Hari Singh Nalwa, "Nanostructured Materials and Nanotechnology", Academic Press, 2002.
REFERENCES
1. Nabok A., "Organic and Inorganic Nanostructures", Artech House, 2005.
2. Dupas C., Houdy P., Lahmani M., "Nanoscience: Nanotechnologies and Nanophysics", Springer, 2007.
3. Brain Culshaw, "Smart Structure and Materials", 2nd Edition, Artech House, 2004.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://www.understandingnano.com/nanomaterials.html
2. http://nanoyou.eu/attachments/188_Module-1-chapter-7-proofread.pdf
3. https://webdocs.cs.ualberta.ca/~database/MEMS/sma_mems/sma.html
PREREQUISITE
16PH209 Applied Physics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Recall the properties of semiconducting materials and functioning of semiconducting devices.
CO2 : Explain the fabrication techniques of Integrated circuits and the recent trends in Integrated Circuits
Technology.
CO3 : Explain the properties and applications of magnetic materials.
CO4 : Summarize the relations involved in dielectric materials and outline the properties, preparation and
applications of Nano materials.
SEMICONDUCTING MATERIALS 13
Elemental and compound semiconductors - Intrinsic and extrinsic semiconductors -Properties - Classical theory and
energy band theory - Motion in a magnetic field - parallel electric and magnetic field - Perpendicular electric and magnetic
field - Semiconductor Theory - Charge densities in semiconductors - Mobility and Conductivity - Drift and Diffusion
Current -Material preparation - Czochralski's technique and zone refining technique - Hall effect - Hall co-efficient in
extrinsic semiconductors, experimental determination of Hall co-efficient - Application of Hall effect - Semiconductor
devices - LED, Solar Cells, Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) and Strain Gauges.
INTEGRATED CIRCUIT FABRICATION 10
Classification of ICs - Manufacturing Process of Monolithic ICs - Silicon wafer preparation - Epitaxial growth - Oxidation
- Photolithography - Diffusion - Metallization - Circuit Probing - Encapsulation.
Construction of a monolithic bipolar transistor - PNP Transistors - Thick and Thin Film Technology - Recent Trends in IC
Technology.
MAGNETIC MATERIALS 9
Definition of fundamental terms - Material - Classification - Dia, Para, Ferro and ferri magnetic materials - Properties -
Heisenberg and Domain theory of ferromagnetism - Hysteresis - Hard and soft magnetic materials - Ferrites - structure,
preparation and applications - Magneto optical recording.
DIELECTRIC MATERIALS 7
Introduction to Dielectric materials- Electrical susceptibility - Dielectric constant - electronic, ionic, orientational and
space charge polarization - frequency and temperature dependence of polarization - Internal field - Dielectric loss -
Dielectric Strength - Factors influencing dielectric strength - dielectric breakdown- Capacitor materials - Ferroelectric
materials- Piezoelectrics- Pyroelectrics and Ferroelectrics - Properties and applications.
NANOPHASE MATERIALS 6
Nanophase materials: Fabrication Techniques - Top down process - Ball Milling - Bottom up process - PVD,CVD, Sputtering
- GMR - Nanodevices - Spin Valve, CNT - Fabrication , Laser ablation, Plasma arc method - Structure, Properties and
applications of CNT - Fullerenes - Properties and applications.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Charles Kittel, "Solid State Physics", John Wiley and Sons, 8th Edition, 2012.
2. Robert W. Kelsall, lan W. Hamley and Mark Geoghegan, "Nanoscale Science and Technology", John Wiley and
Sons Ltd, 2004.
3. Salivahanan S, "Electronic Devices and Circuits", Tata McGraw - Hill, 2008.
REFERENCES
1. W. R. Fahmer, "Nanotechnology and Nanoelectronics", Springer, 2006.
WEB REFERENCES
1. NPTEL Reference: Fundamentals of Electronic Materials and Devices - https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/
noc17_mm07/preview,
2. Nanomaterials - https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_mm05/preview
3. https://www.khanacademy.org/science/physics/magnetic-forces-and-magnetic-fields,
4. http://physics.info/dielectrics.
PREREQUISITE
16PH209 Applied Physics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Recall the properties of conducting materials including the factors influencing the conductivity.
CO2 : Discuss the materials used for highly loaded metal contacts and to understand the properties and
applications of semiconducting and magnetic materials.
CO3 : Explain the behavior of the dielectric material in the external electric field including various polarization
mechanisms and to understand the dielectric breakdown mechanism including the factors affecting the
dielectric strength.
CO4 : Classify the various insulating materials used in electrical apparatus.
CO5 : Illustrate the properties, preparation and applications of Nanomaterials.
CONDUCTING MATERIALS 9
Introduction - Review of metallic conduction on the basis of free electron theory - Fermi-Dirac distribution - Variation of
conductivity with temperature and composition - General properties and specifications of pure copper and aluminum -
Wiedemann Franz law - Fermi Energy - Contact potential - Materials and alloys for high conductivity - Characteristics of
brass and different types of bronzes - Different types of solders - Metals and alloys for different types of fuses - Fusing
current and fuse ratings - Materials used for highly loaded metal contacts, electrical carbon material, characteristics of
different carbon and graphite brushes - Materials of high resistivity - Alloys for use in electrical resistance, arc-lamps and
electric furnaces.
SEMICONDUCTING AND MAGNETIC MATERIALS 9
Semiconductors: Elemental and Compound semiconductors - Basic ideas of amorphous and organic semiconductors -
Direct and Indirect Band Gap Semiconductors.
Magnetic Material: Introduction - Classification - Ferromagnetism - Hysteresis curve - Ferromagnetic domains - Curie -
Weiss law - Hard and soft magnetic materials and applications - Ferrites - Magnetic materials used in electrical machines,
instruments and relays.
DIELECTRIC MATERIALS 9
Introduction - Microscopic displacement of atoms and molecules in an external DC electric field - Polarization and
dielectric constant - Dielectric susceptibility - Polarization mechanisms - Temperature and frequency dependence of
dielectric constant - Dielectric breakdown - Ferroelectric materials - Piezoelectrics - Pyroelectrics and ferroelectrics -
Dielectric materials as electrical insulators.
Dielectric breakdown - Mechanism of breakdown in gases, liquids and solids - Factors influencing dielectric strength
Capacitor materials.
INSULATING MATERIALS 9
Introduction - Good insulator properties and classification on temperature basis - Common insulator materials used in
electrical apparatus - Inorganic materials: Mica, glass, porcelain, asbestos - Organic materials: Paper, rubber, cotton, silk,
fibre, wood, plastics, Bakelite - Resins and varnishes - Liquid insulators; Transformer oil - Gaseous insulators: Air, SF6 and
hydrogen - Ageing of Insulators.
NANO MATERIALS 9
Introduction to Nano materials - Fabrication Techniques - Top down process - Ball milling, Lithography - Bottom up
process - PVD, CVD, Sputtering, Liquid phase - Sol-gel - GMR - Structure, properties and applications of CNT - Fullerenes
- Properties and applications.
Total Periods: 45
REFERENCES
1. Charles Kittel, "Solid State Physics", John Wiley and Sons, 8th Edition, 2012.
2. Raghavan V, "Materials Science and Engineering - A first Course", Prentice Hall of India, 5th Edition, 2004.
3. Jayakumar S, "Materials Science", R. K. Publishers, 2008.
4. Arumugam M, "Materials Science", Anuradha Publications, 2006.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://www.electrical4u.com/electrical-engineering-materials/
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112108150/pdf/Lecture_Notes/MLN_14.pdf
3. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/113106032/14
PREREQUISITE
16PH209 Applied Physics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Recall the electrical conductivity of metals and outline the properties of dielectric materials.
CO2 : Illustrate the detailed analysis of the smart material response of systems exhibiting shape memory effects
and to predict the linear and non-linear behavior of smart structures by sensors.
CO3 : Summarize the relations involved in dielectric materials and outline the properties of Nano materials.
CO4 : Explain the principles of nanoelectronics and to apply the concept for fabricating the Nano devices.
REFERENCES
1. Raghavan V, "Materials Science and Engineering-A first Course", Prentice Hall of India, 5th Edition, 2004.
2. Robert W. Kelsall, lan W. Hamley and Mark Geoghegan, "Nanoscale Science and Technology", John Wiley and
Sons Ltd, 2004.
3. Jayakumar S, "Materials Science", R.K.Publishers, 2008
4. Dally J.W and Riley W.F., "Experimental Stress Analysis", 3rd Edition, McGraw Hill Publications, 2005.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/course.php?disciplineId=115
2. http://lamp.tu-graz.ac.at/~hadley/nanoscience/lectures.html
PREREQUISITE
16BS201 Physical Science
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Infer the basic principles of Nanotechnology and its interdisciplinary behaviour.
CO2 : Illustrate the dual nature of matter waves and Schrodinger's wave equation.
CO3 : Appraise the functionality of primary devices at ultra-low dimensions.
CO4 : Relate the multidisciplinary nature of nanotechnology with computer science and fundamental electronics.
BASICS OF NANOTECHNOLOGY 9
Introduction - History - Macro, Micro, Meso and Nano Length Scales - Basic Principles of Nano Scale Materials - Surface
to Volume Ratio - Size Dependent Properties at Nanoscale - Classification of Nanostructures - Nanoscale and its significance
- Top-down and Bottom-up approaches.
QUANTUM PHYSICS 9
Inadequacies of Classical Mechanics - Duality nature of electromagnetic radiation - De Broglie hypothesis for matter
waves - Heisenberg's uncertainty principle -Schrödinger's wave equation - Particle confinement in 1D box (Infinite Square
well potential) - Bit and Qubit - Quantum dot cellular automata.
OPTICAL AND ELECTRICAL PROPERTIES 9
Introduction to physical properties of nanomaterials - Melting points and lattice constants - Surface Plasmon resonance
- Quantum size effects - Surface scattering - Quantum transport - Effect of microstructure.
NANOELECTRONICS 9
Quantum Mechanical Tunneling - Single Electron Box - Single Electron Devices and Transistors - Logic Circuits Using
Molecules - Nanowire Diodes, Transistors and Interconnects - Nanorobotics and Nanomanipulation.
APPLICATIONS 9
Flexible and Plastic Electronics - Carbon Nanotube Electronics - LEDs Based on Nanowires, Nanotubes and Nanorods -
Lasers Based on Nanodots and Nanowires - Nanocomputers - Wearable Technology - MEMS -NEMS based data storage.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Kelsall R.W, Hamley I.W, Geoghegan M, “Nanoscale Science & Technology”, 1st Edition, John. Wiley & Sons,
2005.
2. Cao G.Z, Wang Y, “Nanostructures & Nanomaterials: Synthesis, Properties & Applications”, 2nd Edition, World
Scientific Publishing, 2011.
3. Petty M. C., “Molecular Electronics: From Principles to Practice”, John Wiley & Sons, Ltd., 2007.
REFERENCES
1. Vishal Sahni et.al. "Nanocomputing: The future of computing", Tata McGraw - Hill Education, 2008.
2. Avadhanalu M N, and Kshirsagar P G, "A Textbook of Engineering Physics", S. Chand and Company Ltd, 2014.
3. Poole C.P, Owens FJ, “Introduction to Nanotechnology”, 1st Edition, John Wiley and Sons, 2011.
4. Pradeep T, “Nano: The essentials - Understanding Nanoscience and Technology”, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2007.
5. Nalwa H.S, “Nanostructured Materials & Nanotechnology”, Concise Edition, Academic Press, 2007.
6 Nielsen, Michael A.; Chuang, Isaac L. “Quantum Computation and Quantum Information”, Cambridge University
Press, 2010.
PREREQUISITE
16PH210 Biophysics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the structure-property relationship in biological and biomaterials.
CO2 : Clarify the types, properties and biomedical applications of metallic alloys, ceramics, polymers and
Composites.
CO3 : Describe the methods for surface modification of biomaterials.
CO4 : Characterize biomaterials with suitable analytical techniques.
CO5 : List the materials for tissue engineering and elucidate scaffold fabrication methods.
REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Park J.B., Bronzino.D.J."Biomaterials: Principles and applications" CRC Press, 2002.
2. Swaminathan Sethuraman, Umamaheshwari Krishnan, Anuradha Subramanaian , "Biomaterials and Nanotechnology
for Tissue Engineering", CRC Press,2016.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://www.doitpoms.ac.uk/tlplib/bones/bone_mechanical.php
2. https://www.nibib.nih.gov/science-education/science-topics/tissue-engineering-and-regenerative-medicine
3. http://www.uotechnology.edu.iq/appsciences/filesPDF/material/lectures/4c/8-Biochmical1.pdf
PREREQUISITE
16PH207 Engineering Physics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Identify the requirements of materials in aerospace application.
CO2 : Describe the various materials used in the manufacturing of aircraft.
CO3 : Outline the concept of corrosion and heat treatment processes.
CO4 : Explain the application of ceramics and composites in aerospace vehicle design.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Aerospace_materials
2. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Aircraft
3. nptel.ac.in/courses/101104010/
4. nptel.ac.in/courses/113105057/
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Calculate the size of the powder particle and determine the acceptance angle of optical fiber.
CO2 : Determine the velocity of the ultrasonic waves and acoustic impedance.
CO3 : Estimate co-efficient of viscosity of the given liquid and Young's Modulus of the bar.
CO4 : Determine the efficiency of a solar cell and its characteristics.
CO5 : Demonstrate Sputtering unit and study the lattice parameters of materials using XRD.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Particle size of the given powder using He-Ne laser and demonstration of particle size analyser.
2. Velocity of the Ultrasonic waves in the given liquid medium and to determine the acoustic impedence using
ultrasonic interferometer.
3. Co-efficient of Viscosity of the given liquid by Poiseuille's method.
4. Acceptance angle and Numerical Aperture (NA) of the given Optical fiber.
5. Young's Modulus of the given material of the rectangular bar using cantilever method.
6. Efficiency of a silicon cell (solar cell) and to study its characteristics.
7. Demonstration of Sputtering unit.
8. Determination of lattice parameters of crystalline materials - XRD pattern.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Correlate the properties of important polymers and nanomaterials with their industrial applications.
CO2 : Describe the applications of electrochemical and fuel cells.
CO3 : Outline the mechanism of various types of corrosion and their control methods.
CO4 : Summarize the various types of fuels and their production processes.
POLYMER CHEMISTRY 9
Polymer - Types- Nomenclature - Classification of polymers - Polymerization - Types - Mechanism of polymerization(free
radical mechanism) - Effect of polymer structure on properties of polymers - Weight average-number average-transition
temperature - polymer index - Engineering polymers: Teflon, ABS, PET, Polycarbonate -structure, preparation, properties
and uses - Compounding -Fabrication: Compression, Injection, Extrusion and Blow moulding.
NANOCHEMISTRY 7
Introduction - Nanomaterials - Properties of bulk and nano materials - Difference between bulk and nano materials -Size
dependent properties of particles, clusters, rods, wires and tubes - Carbon Nano Tubes - Applications-Nanomaterials -
Synthesis - Sol-gel - Hydro thermal - Applications.
ELECTROCHEMISTRY AND ENERGY STORAGE DEVICES 10
Electrode potential - Single electrode potential - Nernst equation - Problems - Types of electrodes - Reference electrodes
- Calomel and Glass electrodes - Electrochemical series - Significance-Electrochemical cells - Galvanic and concentration
cells. Batteries: Types - Primary and secondary batteries-Lead acid, Lithium and Nicad batteries - Maintenance and
hazards. Fuel cells: H2-O2 fuel cells and solid oxide fuel cells - Construction and working.
CORROSION CHEMISTRY AND CONTROL 9
Corrosion - Types of corrosion and mechanism - Thermodynamics of corrosion - Galvanic corrosion - Mechanism-
Factors influencing corrosion - Corrosion control - Design and cathodic protection methods - Metallic coatings -
Electroplating(Cr and Ni) and Electroless plating(Ni) - Organic coatings - Paints.
FUELS AND COMBUSTION 10
Fuels: Classifications - Properties - Calorific value - Determination - Bomb calorimeter - Solid fuels - Coal - Proximate and
ultimate analysis - Manufacture of metallurgical coke - Liquid fuels - Classifications - Petroleum - Straight run, cracked and
polymer petrol - Synthetic petrol - Fischer Tropsch process - Gaseous fuels - Classifications: Water gas, producer gas,
LPG and CNG - Biodiesel - Fuels for IC engines - Octane number - Cetane number.
Combustion: Combustion equations -Theoretical air requirements - Problems - Flue gas analysis - Orsat method.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Jain P C and Monica Jain, "Engineering Chemistry", 16th Edition, Dhanpat Rai Publishing Co., 2016.
2. Ragunath L., "Engineering Chemistry", 1st Edition, Mc Graw Hill Education, 2016.
REFERENCES
1. Dara S S., "A text book of Engineering Chemistry", 12th Edition, S.Chand & Co. Ltd., 2013
2. Shashi chawla, "A Textbook of Engineering chemistry", 3rd edition, Dhanpat Rai Publications, 2010.
3. Vairam S and Suba Ramesh, "Engineering Chemistry", 2nd Edition, Wiley India Private Limited, 2013. .
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/122101001/downloads/lec-23.pdf
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/104105039
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Demonstrate the water treatment methods for industrial and domestic use.
CO2 : Describe the applications of electrochemical cells and corrosion control methods.
CO3 : Explain the applications of important polymers and carbon nanotubes and outline the classification and
properties of various refractory materials and important lubricants.
CO4 : Explain the various instrumental methods of analysis and their applications.
WATER TREATMENT 9
Water Quality parameters: Alkalinity, Turbidity, Fluorides, Hardness - Units of hardness - Estimation of Hardness by
EDTA method - Disadvantages of hard water - Corrosion - Water softening and purification - Internal conditioning-
External conditioning - Zeolite process - Demineralization - Potable water - Domestic water treatment - Physical and
chemical methods of disinfection of water - Break point chlorination - Desalination - Reverse osmosis.
ELECTROCHEMISTRY AND CORROSION CHEMISTRY 9
Electrode potential - Single electrode potential - Nernst equation - Problems - Types of electrodes -Reference electrodes
- Calomel and Glass electrodes - Electrochemical cells - Electrochemical series - Applications.
Corrosion: Types of corrosion and mechanism - Thermodynamics of corrosion - Galvanic corrosion - Mechanism -Factors
influencing corrosion - Corrosion control - Design and cathodic protection methods.
HIGH POLYMERS 9
Introduction - Polymer structure - Nomenclature - Polymerization - Types - Preparation, properties and applications of
Standard polymers: Polyethylene, HDPE, Polypropylene, PVC, UPVC, CPVC and PMMA - Engineering polymers: Teflon,
Nylon - 6-6, ABS - Composites - Types - Polymer matrix composite - FRP.
ENGINEERING MATERIALS 9
Cements - Setting and hardening of cement - Special cements - Refractories - Classification - Properties - Manufacture of
alumina, magnesite and zirconia bricks - Cermets - Lubricants - Mechanism of lubrication - Liquid lubricants - Properties
- Solid lubricants: Graphite and molybdenum disulphide.
Nanomaterials - Introduction to nanochemistry - Carbon nanotubes - Types of carbon nanotubes - Applications.
ANALYTICAL TECHNIQUES 9
Beer-Lambert's law - UV-Visible spectroscopy and IR spectroscopy - Principle and Instrumentation - Estimation of iron by
colorimetry - Flame photometry - Principle - Instrumentation - Estimation of sodium by flame photometry - Atomic
absorption spectroscopy - Principle - Instrumentation - Estimation of nickel by atomic absorption spectroscopy.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Jain P C and Monica Jain, "Engineering Chemistry", 16th Edition, Dhanpat Rai Publishing Co., 2016.
2. Ragunath L., "Engineering Chemistry", 1st Edition, Mc Graw Hill Education, 2016.
REFERENCES
1. Dara S S., "A text book of Engineering Chemistry", 12th Edition, S.Chand & Co. Ltd., 2013
2. Shashi chawla, "A Textbook of Engineering chemistry", 3rd edition, Dhanpat Rai publications, 2010.
3. Rajput R.K, "Engineering materials", S. Chand & Co. publications Ltd, 2006.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/122101001/downloads/lec-23.pdf
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/122101001/downloads/lec-25.pdf
3. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/104105039
CURRICULUM AND SYLLABUS 93
16CH205 APPLIED CHEMISTRY 3003
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the applications of electrochemical cells and fuel cells.
CO2 : Explain the mechanism of various types of corrosion and control methods.
CO3 : Explain the properties and applications of engineering polymers and nanomaterials.
CO4 : Outline the various grades of solvents used for cleaning electronics.
CO5 : Explain the various instrumental methods of analysis and their applications.
ELECTROCHEMISTRY AND ENERGY STORAGE DEVICES 12
Electrolytic cells - Electrochemical cells - Reversible and irreversible cells - EMF measurement - Weston Cadmium standard
cell - Electrodes -Single electrode potential - Determination - Nernst equation - Electrochemical series - Types of
electrodes - Silver chloride electrode - Reference electrodes - Calomel electrode - Glass electrode - Measurement of pH.
Batteries: Types - Construction, working and applications of alkaline and Lead acid batteries - Modern batteries - Zinc air
battery and Lithium batteries - Battery maintenance and hazard - Fuel cells - Types - Construction, working and applications
of H2-O2 fuel cells and solid oxide fuel cell.
CORROSION CHEMISTRY AND CONTROL 9
Corrosion - Types - Chemical corrosion - Electrochemical corrosion - Galvanic corrosion - Mechanism - Factors influencing
corrosion - Corrosion control - Design and cathodic protection methods - Metallic coatings - Electroplating (Cr and Ni)
and Electroless plating (Ni) - Corrosion inhibitors - Types.
ENGINEERING POLYMERS AND NANO MATERIALS 10
Polymer - Introduction - Nomenclature - Polymerization - Types - Standard polymers: Polyethylene, polypropylene, PVC,
PMMA - Engineering polymers: Teflon, Nylon6-6, ABS, PET - Speciality polymers: Polycarbonate, Kevlar - Electronic
polymers: Polyacetylene, polythiophene - structure, preparation, properties and uses - Composites - Types - Polymer
matrix composite - FRP
Nanomaterials - Introduction to Nanochemistry - Nanomaterials - Synthesis - Sol-gel - Hydro thermal - Applications.
CHEMICALS FOR CLEANING ELECTRONICS 5
Cleaning of electronics - Various solvents used - Electronic grades - Semiconductor grades - Specifications - Advantages
and disadvantages.
ANALYTICAL TECHNIQUES 9
Beer-Lambert's law - UV-Visible spectroscopy and IR spectroscopy: Principle and Instrumentation - Estimation of iron by
colorimetry - Flame photometry - Principle - Instrumentation - Estimation of sodium by flame photometry - Atomic
absorption spectroscopy - Principle - Instrumentation - Estimation of nickel by atomic absorption spectroscopy.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Jain P C & Monica Jain, "Engineering Chemistry", 16th Edition, Dhanpat Rai Publishing Co., 2015.
2. Ragunath L, "Engineering Chemistry", 1st Edition, McGraw Hill Education, 2016.
REFERENCES
1. Dara S S, "A text book of Engineering Chemistry", 12th Edition, S.Chand & Co. Ltd., 2013.
2. Shashi Chawla "A Textbook of Engineering chemistry", 3rd Edition, Dhanpat Rai Publications, 2010.
3. Vairam S & Suba Ramesh, "Engineering Chemistry", 2nd Edition, Wiley India Private Limited, 2013.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/122101001/downloads/lec-23.pdf
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/104105039
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Infer the internal structure of earth composition and symmetry elements of important crystallographic
systems.
CO2 : Identify the physical properties of rock forming minerals and various types of rocks.
CO3 : Recognize the classification of geological structures.
CO4 : Recognize seismicity of the world, the role of plate tectonics and the measurement of earthquake.
PHYSICAL GEOLOGY 10
Introduction to role of geology in civil engineering- Various core and applied branches of geology - Internal structure of
earth composition - Introduction to plate tectonics- Continental drifting - Weathering and types - Work of river, wind, sea
and ground water.
MINERALOGY 10
Elementary knowledge on symmetry elements of important Crystallographic systems - Physical properties of common
rock forming minerals - Physical Properties of minerals: Quartz family, Feldspar
family,Augite,Hornblende,Biotite,Muscvite,Calcite,Garnet - Physical and Engineering properties of clay minerals -
Elementary knowledge on Ore minerals - Coal and Petroleum.
PETROLOGY 7
Classification of rocks and their distinctive properties - Description - Occurrence- Distribution - Engineering Properties
of Igneous rocks: Granite, Syenite, Diorite, Gabbro, Pegmatite, dolerite and Basalt - Sedimentary rocks: Sandstone,
Limestone, shale, conglomerate and Breccia - Metamorphic rocks : Quartzite, Marble, Slate, Phyllite, Gneiss and Schist.
STRUCTURAL GEOLOGY 7
Attitude of beds - Introduction to Geological maps and their importance in civil engineering projects - Uses of Clinometer
and Brunton compass in Geological mapping - Gnesis - Classification of geological structures; Folds, faults and joints .
ELEMENTS OF SEISMOLOGY 11
Causes and effects of earthquake -Elastic rebound theory - Indian Seismicity -Epicentre - Hypocentre - Primary, shear and
Rayleigh waves - seismogram - Magnitude - Richter's scale, Surface wave and Moment magnitude scale - Mercalli
Intensity Scale .
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Parbin Singh A., "Text Book of Engineering and General Geology", 8th Edition, S.K.Kataria and Sons, 2015.
2. Garg S.K., "Physical and Engineering Geology", 3rd Edition, Khanna Publishers, 2015.
REFERENCES
1. Dugal S.K., "Engineering Geology", McGraw Hill Education(India) (P)Ltd. 2014.
2. Blyth F.G.M., "A Geology for Engineers", 2nd Edition, Arnold, 2016.
3. Reddy D.V., "Engineering Geology", 2nd Edition, Vikas Publishing House Pvt Ltd., 2017.
WEB REFERENCE
NPTEL Course on Engineering Geology http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105105106/
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the body planes and organization of tissues.
CO2 : Explain the components and functions of cardiovascular, nervous, respiratory, digestive, excretory and
Sensory system.
NERVOUS AND SENSORY SYSTEM 15
Origin of anatomical names - Prefixes and suffixes -Anatomical positions and body planes - Electrical activities - Membrane
potential - Action potential - Organization of tissues - Structure and functions of nervous system - Brain and spinal cord
- Functions of CNS - Nerve conduction and synapse - Reflex action- Somatic and autonomic nervous system - Physiology
of vision, hearing, integumentary, olfactory systems - Taste buds.
CARDIO VASCULAR AND RESPIRATORY SYSTEM 20
Composition of blood - Structureof circulatory system - Heart -Cardiac cycle- Blood pressure - Feedback control for blood
pressure - Nervous control of heart - Cardiac output - Coronary, pulmonary and peripheral circulation. Structure of
respiratory system - Trachea - Lungs - Physiological aspects of respiration - Exchange of gases - Regulation of respiration
-Lung volume and vital capacities of the lungs- Disturbance of respiration function - Pulmonary function tests.
DIGESTIVE AND EXCRETORY SYSTEM 10
Digestive system - Organization of GI system - Functions of liver and pancreas, digestion and absorption process -
Movement of food stuff in GI tract - Structure of Kidney and Nephron - Mechanism of urine formation - Urine reflex.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Anne Waugh and Allison Grant, Ross and Wilson "Anatomy and Physiology in health and illness", 12th Edition,
Churchill Livingstone Elsevier, 2014.
2. John E Hall, Guyton and Hall, "Text book of Medical Physiology", 13th Edition, Saunders, 2013.
3. William F.Ganong, "Review of Medical Physiology", 22nd Edition, Mc Graw Hill,2010.
REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Elaine.N. Marieb, "Essentials of human Anatomy and Physiology", 8th Edition, Pearson Education, 2007.
2. Gillian Pocock, Christopher D. Richards, "The human Body - An Introduction for Biomedical and Health Sciences",
Oxford University Press, 2009.
3. Sarada Subramanyam, Madhavan Kutty K. and Singh H.D., "Text Book of Human Physiology" S.Chand and
Company, 1996.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Elucidate the structure and functions of subcellular organelles and biomolecules.
CO2 : Describe metabolism on liver, muscle, heart and brain.
CO3 : Describe the procedures for assessment of functions of liver and kidney.
CO4 : Explain the principles of biochemical techniques.
BIOMOLECULES 15
Biochemistry of living cell - Structural features of eukaryotic and prokaryotic cells - Functions of cell organelles - Sub
cellular fractionation using differential centrifugation - Classification, structure and functions of carbohydrates, lipids,
proteins and nucleic acids - Enzymes - Classification, kinetics, inhibition, assay of enzymes - Diagnostic enzymes -
Hormones - Chemical nature, general mode of action - Assay of hormones.
METABOLISM 15
Metabolism of carbohydrates, lipids and proteins in major organs - liver, muscle, heart and brain - Inherited metabolic
disorders of carbohydrate, lipid and protein metabolism. Metabolic Integration in conditions like Diabetes, starvation.
Gene expression and its regulation.
CLINICAL BIOCHEMISTRY 15
Principles and applications of chromatography, electrophoresis, spectroscopic techniques. Organ analysis: Assessment
of kidney and liver functions. Blood gas analysis. Regulation of acid-base balance. Measurement of electrolytes. Uses of
radioisotopes in biology and medicine.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Michael M. Cox and David L. Nelson, "Lehninger Principles of Biochemistry", W. H. Freeman and Company,
6th Edition, 2012.
2. Keith Wilson and Walker, "Principles and Techniques of Biochemistry and Molecular Biology", 7th Edition,
Cambridge University Press, 2010.
REFERENCES
1. Reginald H. Garrett and Charles M. Grisham, "Biochemistry", Brooks Cole Publishers, 5th Edition, 2012.
2. Robert K. Murray and Victor W. Rodwell," Harper's Illustrated Biochemistry, Lange Medical Books, 29th Edition,
2012.
3. Donald Voet, Judith G. Voet and Charlotte W. Pratt, "Fundamentals of Biochemistry", John Wiley and Sons,
4th Edition, 2010.
PREREQUISITES
16BM203 Biochemistry
16BM202 Human Anatomy and Physiology
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the alterations in cardiovascular, respiratory, gastrointestinal, kidney, urinary tract, nervous system
functions and hematology.
CO2 : Describe the basis of disorders of cardiovascular, respiratory, gastrointestinal systems, kidney and urinary
tract, nervous system.
CO3 : Explain the diagnosis of disorders of cardiovascular, respiratory, gastrointestinal systems, kidney and
urinary tract, nervous system.
CO4 : Explain the molecular basis of micro and macro vascular complications of diabetes.
CO5 : Describe the molecular mechanisms of microbial pathogenesis and the laboratory diagnosis ofInfectious
diseases.
DISORDERS OF CARDIOVASCULAR AND RESPIRATORY SYSTEM 15
Alterations in circulatory and respiratory functions - Diagnosis of cardiovascular disorders - ECG, non invasive cardiac
imaging, diagnostic cardiac catheterization and coronary angiography; disorders of rhythm, heart. Coronary and peripheral
vascular disease - Therapeuticapproaches - Atherosclerosis - Hematologic alterations and hematopoietic disorders -
Hypertension and its management - Diagnosis of respiratory disease - Procedures, chest imaging - Diseases of the
respiratory system: asthma, bronchiectasis, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease, interstitial lung diseases, disorders
of pleura, mediastinum, ventilation - Sleep apnea - Therapeutic approaches.
DISORDERS OF GASTROINTESTINAL SYSTEM, KIDNEY AND URINARY TRACT 12
Alterations in gastrointestinal, renal systems and urinary tract function - Gastrointestinal endoscopy - Diseases of the
esophagus and peptic ulcer - Acute appendicitis and peritonitis - Liver and Biliary tract disease - Evaluation of liver
function, hepatitis, fatty liver, cirrhosis and its complications - Diseases of the gall bladder, bile ducts, pancreas. Disorders
of the kidney and urinary tract - Acute kidney Injury, chronic kidney disease, dialysis in the treatment of renal failure -
Glomerular, tubulointerstitial diseases - Nephrolithiasis.
DISORDERS OF NERVOUS SYSTEM 7
Nervous system dysfunction - Diagnosis of neurologic disorders - Neuroimaging, electrodiagnostic studies of nervous
system disorders - EEG, evoked potentials and EMG - Biology of neurologic diseases - Diseases of the central nervous
system, Nerve and muscle disorders - Diseases of the senses.
DIABETES MELLITUS 5
Type I and Type II Diabetes mellitus - Molecular basis of diabetic complications - Microvascular and Macrovascular
complications - Diabetic neuropathy, retinopathy and nephropathy - Management of diabetes mellitus.
INFECTIOUS DISEASES 6
Molecular mechanisms of microbial pathogenesis, genomics and infectious disease, immunization principles and vaccine
use - Bacterial, viral, fungal pathogens and diseases.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOK
1. Kasper, Fauci, Haucer, Longo, Jameson, Loscalzo Harrison's "Principle of Internal Medicine", 19th Edition, McGraw
Hill Education, 2012.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Identify the biomolecules present in a given sample by qualitative analysis.
CO2 : Determine the concentration of biomolecules in the biological samples.
CO3 : Measure the activities of enzymes and study their properties.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
Preparation of buffer and measurement of pH, qualitative and quantitative analysis of carbohydrates, lipids, proteins and
nucleic acids - Thin layer chromatography of lipids - Chromatography of protein hydrolysates - Enzyme kinetics - assay
of enzyme activity, study of effect of substrate and enzyme concentration, effect of pH, temperature and inhibitors.
REFERENCES
1. S.Sadasivam and A. Manickam , "Biochemical Methods", New Age International Publishers, 2nd Edition,2005.
2. Arti Nigam and ArchanaAyyagari, "Lab manual in Biochemistry, Immunology & Biotechnology", Tata McGraw
Hill,, 2008.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO 1 : Identify parts of cardiovascular and skeletal system.
CO 2 : Measure blood pressure, respiration rate and acquire ECG.
CO 3 : Perform tests to assess vision and hearing.
EXPERIMENTS
Identification of functional parts of the cardiovascular and skeletal systems - Blood groups - Blood cell counts and
Hemoglobin - Measurement of blood pressure - Measurement of respiration parameters - Acquisition of biosignals: ECG
- Testing of vision and color blindness - Testing of hearing and recording of audiogram.
REFERENCE
Charles Henry Stowell, "A Handbook of Simple Experiments in Physiology", Burdett & Co, 2006.
PREREQUISITE
16BM202 Human Anatomy and Physiology
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Perform the procedures for assay of biomarkers for assessment of organ functions.
CO2 : Infer Histopathological conditions through microscopic observations.
CO3 : Culture and identify bacterial pathogens.
EXPERIMENTS
Preparation of serum and assay of biomarkers - Observation of histopathological slides - Pure culture techniques for
bacterial pathogens - Biochemical Tests for identification of bacteria - Antibiogram.
TEXT BOOK
Kasper, Fauci, Haucer, Longo, Jameson, Loscalzo Harrison's, "Principle of Internal Medicine", 19th Edition,Tata
McGraw Hill Education, 2012.
REFERENCE
Underwood JCE, "General and Systematic Pathology", Churchill Livingstone, 5th Edition, 2009.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the vectorial and scalar representation of forces and moments.
CO2 : Determine the components of a force and resultant of a system of forces.
CO3 : Determine the support reactions on a structure and connection forces in trusses.
CO4 : Evaluate various forces considering frictional forces.
CO5 : Calculate the moment of inertia of laminas.
CO6 : Solve kinematics and Kinetics by applying their fundamental concepts
REFERENCES
1. Palanichamy M.S and Nagan S., "Engineering Mechanics - Statics & Dynamics", Tata McGraw-Hill, 2011.
2. Kottiswaran N., "Engineering Mechanics", Balaji Publication (P) Ltd, 2015.
3. Rajasekaran S and Sankarasubramanian G., "Fundamentals of Engineering Mechanics", Vikas Publishing House
Pvt. Ltd., 2013.
WEB REFERENCE
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112103108/
PRE-REQUISITES
16PH207 Engineering Physics
16CH203 Engineering Chemistry
16PH211 Nano Materials
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, Students will be able to
CO1 : Describe phase diagrams and phase transformations of metals.
CO2 : Outline the heat-treatment processes.
CO3 : Identify the suitable materials for engineering applications.
CO4 : Explain the testing of materials to determine mechanical properties.
PHASE DIAGRAMS 12
Gibb's phase rule - Binary isomorphous alloy systems - Non-equilibrium cooling - Binary eutectic system - Eutectoid,
peritectic and monotectic reaction - Phase diagrams with intermediate phases and compounds - Iron - carbon diagram
- Ternary phase diagrams - Development of microstructures.
HEAT TREATMENT OF STEELS 9
TTT & CCT diagram: Principles, purpose - Classification of heat treatment processes: Annealing, normalizing, stress
relieving, hardening, tempering - Overview of heat treatment of non ferrous materials - Surface Treatment: Carburizing,
vacuum carburizing, nitriding, plasma nitriding, carbonitriding, flame and induction hardening.
METALLIC MATERIALS 6
Ferrous Materials - Steels - Classification of Steels - Effect of alloying additions on steel - Stainless steels - Maraging
Steels - HSLA - Cast Iron and its types - An overview of non-Ferrous materials.
MATERIALS TESTING 18
Deformation Mechanisms: Dislocations - Edge and Screw - Mechanisms of plastic deformation - Slip and twinning -
Hardness Testing: ASTM Standards and specification - Brinell hardness testing - Rockwell hardness testing - Vickers
hardness testing and knoop hardness testing - Nano indentation - Tension Testing: ASTM Standards and specification,
Testing procedures - Determination of tensile properties - Impact Testing: Izod and Charpy Impacts tests - Ductile to
Brittle Transition Temperature (DBTT) - Fatigue and Creep Testing:ASTM Standards and specification - Introduction
- Stress cycles - S-N curves - Factors affecting fatigue - Introduction to creep, creep testing and stress rupture testing.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Sidney H.Avner, "Introduction to Physical Metallurgy", 2nd Edition, Tata McGraw Hill Publishing Co. Ltd., 2010.
2. Raghvan V., "Physical Metallurgy- Principles and Practice", 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd, 2006.
REFERENCES
1. Dieter George. E., "Mechanical Metallurgy ", 2nd Edition, McGraw Hill, 2001.
2. Rajan.T.V, Sharma.C.P. and Ashok Sharma., "Heat Treatment - Principles and Techniques", 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall
of India, 2004.
3. Vijendra Singh, "Physical Metallurgy", Standard Publishers Distributors, 2010.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/113105023/
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/113105024/
PRE-REQUISITE
16PH207 Engineering Physics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO 1 : Appraise the fundamental concepts of Thermodynamics.
CO 2 : Apply the First Law of Thermodynamics to Flow and Non-Flow systems.
CO 3 : Apply the Second Law of Thermodynamics to various thermal systems.
CO 4 : Outline the properties of pure substances.
CO 5 : Choose the properties of Steam and analyze Rankine Cycle.
CO 6 : Identify Thermodynamic relations for thermal systems.
LAWS OF THERMODYNAMICS 30
Microscopic and Macroscopic approaches - Concept of Continuum - Thermodynamic Systems - Property - State and
Process - Point and Path Functions - Thermodynamic Equilibrium - Quasi Static Process - Work and Heat Concept of
Temperature - Zeroth Law of Thermodynamics. First Law of Thermodynamics: Statement - Internal Energy - Specific Heat
Capacities -Enthalpy- Application to Non - Flow Systems - Steady Flow Energy Equations - Application to various flow
systems.
Second Law of Thermodynamics: Statements and their equivalence - Cyclic Heat Engine - Refrigerator and Heat Pump -
Reversible and Irreversible Processes-Carnot Cycle and Carnot Theorem - Clausius Inequality - Clausius Theorem -
Entropy - Principle of increase of entropy - Entropy generation - Available Energy - Availability and Irreversibility -Second
Law Efficiency - Third law of Thermodynamics.
PROPERTIES OF PURE SUBSTANCES 20
Thermodynamic properties of pure substances in solid, liquid and vapor phases - Phase Rule -P-V,P-T, T-V, T-S,H-S
diagrams - P-V-T surfaces - Thermodynamic properties of steam - Steam formation - Use of Steam Tables Mollier Diagram
- Determination of Dryness fraction - Rankine cycle - Modified Rankine Cycle - Methods to improve efficiency of Rankine
cycle - Reheat and Regenerative cycles - Binary Vapour Cycle.
THERMODYNAMIC RELATIONSHIPS 10
Exact differentials - Maxwell Relations - TdS Equations - Specific heat relations - Clausius Clapeyron Equation Joule
Thomson Coefficient.
Total Periods: 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. Yunus.A.Cengel, and Michael A.Boles, "Thermodynamics", 8th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill, 2014.
2. Nag.P.K, "Engineering Thermodynamics", 5th Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2013.
REFERENCES
1. VanWylen G.J, Sontag R.E. "Classical Thermodynamics", 3rd Edition, Wiley Eastern, 1987.
2. Arora C.P, "Thermodynamics", 12th Reprint, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2007.
3. Natarajan E., "Engineering Thermodynamics - Fundamentals and Applications", 2nd Edition, Anuragam Publications,
2014.
DATA BOOK
Kothandaraman C.P., Steam Tables, 4th Edition, New Age International, 2015.
WEB REFERENCE
http://www.nptel.ac.in/downloads/112108148/
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, Students will be able to
CO1 : Plan the layout of domestic water service connection using PVC pipes.
CO2 : Make the required fitment in wood and metallic pieces using appropriate tools.
CO3 : Recall meal joining and basic manufacturing processes.
CO4 : Demonstrate wiring layout and measure the electrical parameters and outline the concept of electrical
safety.
CO5 : Demonstrate basic electronic circuits in PCB and outline the concepts of electronic circuits.
CO6 : Install OS and its drivers from scratch.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
CIVIL ENGINEERING
1. Study of plumbing components such as valves, taps, couplings, unions, reducers, elbows and adhesives.
2. Hands-on-exercise: Basic pipe connections.
3. Safety aspects in plumbing.
4. Study of home plumbing.
5. Cutting and Threading of Pipes.
6. Study on purpose of different pipe material.
7. Making pipe connection for motor and turbine.
8. Measuring and marking practice of G.I. pipes - connection to service line.
9. Demonstration on making of domestic water service connection using mixed pipes.
10. Demonstration of domestic water service connection.
MECHANICAL ENGINEERING
1. Making a fitting joint: V joint / square joint.
2. Making a carpentry joint: T joint/ Dove Tail joint.
3. Weld Joints of Lap joint / T joint.
4. Rivet of joints of sheet metal.
5. Demonstration on Foundry and Smithy practices.
6. Demonstrate the basic machining operations.
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
1. Measurement of electrical quantities: Voltage, current, power and power factor in RLC circuit.
2. Fluorescent lamp wiring.
3. Staircase wiring.
4. Residential house wiring using switches, fuse, lamp and energy meter.
5. Measurement of earth resistance, winding resistance and insulation resistance.
6. Study of Indian Electricity rules and safety.
ELECTRONICS ENGINEERING
1. Study of operating procedures of CRO, DSOs, Multimeters etc.,
2. Resistor colour coding and measurement of parameters of square wave and sine wave signals (peak-peak, RMS,
period and frequency).
3. Study of logic gates.
4. Soldering practices using general purpose PCB.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, Students will be able to
CO1 : Recall the BIS conventions and construct the plane geometric entities like conics, special curves.
CO2 : Project orthographic views of points and straight lines.
CO3 : Draw orthographic projections of solids and the sections of solids.
CO4 : Develop the surfaces of the simple solids.
CO5 : Draw the isometric views and projections of simple solids.
CO6 : Convert the isometric projection to orthographic projections.
CO7 : Make basic engineering drawings using drafting software.
INTRODUCTION 3
Drawing Instruments - Drawing Sheet size and Layout - BIS conventions and specifications - Lettering - Geometrical
Constructions and Dimensioning - Scales: Reducing Scale and Enlarging Scale.
PLANE GEOMETRY 4
Curves used in Engineering Practices: Construction of Conics by eccentricity method - Cycloidal Curves - Involutes of
Polygons and Circle - Construction of tangent and normal at a point on the curves.
SOLID GEOMETRY 22
Orthographic Projection: Principles of Orthographic projection - First angle projection - Conventional representation
Projection of Points and Straight Lines: Projection of points, Projection of straight lines inclined to both the reference
planes by rotating line method - Determination of True length and True inclinations.
Projection of Solids: Projection of simple solids like Prisms, Pyramids, Cylinder and Cone with the axis inclined to one
reference plane and parallel to other plane.
Section of Solids and Development of Lateral Surfaces: Section of Solids in Simple Position when the cutting plane is
inclined to one of the reference planes and perpendicular to the other - Obtaining True Shape of section, Development of
lateral surfaces of simple and truncated solids - Prisms, pyramids, cylinders and cones.
PICTORIAL PROJECTIONS 10
Isometric Projections: Principles, views of Simple Solids and Truncated Solids - Prisms, Pyramids, Cylinders, Cones and
Sphere.
Conversion from Pictorial Projection to Orthographic Projection: Visualization concepts - Layout of views - Simple objects
in three dimensions and obtaining orthographic projection.
COMPUTER AIDED DRAFTING 21
1. Introduction to software - Layout of software, standard tool bars/Menus, coordinate systems and reference
planes - selection of drawing size and scale - Title block.
2. Commands and Creation of points, lines, planes and dimensioning methods.
3. Drawing, viewing and editing 2D and 3D Drawings and creating texts.
4. Orthographic projections of simple solids.
5. Drafting of Section of solids and development of solids.
6. Isometric projection of simple solids and truncated solids.
7. Conversion from pictorial projection to orthographic projection.
Note: Exercises should be practiced by using drawing instruments and drafting software.
Total Periods: 60
REFERENCES
1. Bhatt N.D. and Panchal V.M., "Engineering Drawing", 50th Edition, Charotar Publishing House, 2010.
2. Kumar M.S., "Engineering Graphics", D.D. Publications, 2007.
3. Dhananjay A Jolhe, "Engineering Drawing with an Introduction to AutoCAD", McGraw Hill Education, 2007.
WEB REFERENCE
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105104148/
PREREQUISITE
16ME256 Engineering Graphics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, Students will be able to
CO1 : Represent the geometric features and parts conventionally.
CO2 : Select fits and tolerances required for the assembly parts to meet the functional requirements and
represent them in drawings using appropriate symbols.
CO3 : Read the industrial drawings and interpret the dimensions and manufacturing details.
CO4 : Draw the views of typical sub assemblies with conventional representation.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Recall the BIS conventions and construct the plane geometric entities like conics, special curves.
CO2 : Project orthographic views of points and straight lines.
CO3 : Draw orthographic projections of solids and the sections of solids.
CO4 : Develop the surfaces of the simple solids.
CO5 : Draw the isometric views and projections of simple solids.
CO6 : Convert the isometric projection to orthographic projections.
INTRODUCTION 2
Drawing Instruments - Drawing Sheet size and Layout - BIS conventions and specifications - Lettering - Geometrical
Constructions and Dimensioning, Scales - Reducing Scale and Enlarging Scale.
PLANE GEOMETRY 3
Curves used in Engineering Practices: Construction of Conics by eccentricity method - Cycloidal Curves - Involutes of
Circle, Square - Construction of tangent and normal at a point on the curves.
SOLID GEOMETRY 12
ORTHOGRAPHIC PROJECTION
Principles of Orthographic projection - First angle projection - Conventional representation.
PROJECTION OF POINTS AND STRAIGHT LINES
Projection of points, Projection of straight lines inclined to both the reference planes by rotating line method - Determination
of True length and True inclinations.
PROJECTION OF SOLIDS
Projection of simple solids like Prisms, Pyramids, Cylinder and Cone with the axis inclined to one reference plane and
parallel to other plane.
SECTION OF SOLIDS AND DEVELOPMENT OF LATERAL SURFACES
Section of Solids in Simple Position when the cutting plane is inclined to one of the reference planes and perpendicular to
the other, Development of lateral surfaces of simple and truncated solids - Prisms, pyramids, cylinders and cones.
PICTORIAL PROJECTIONS 10
ISOMETRIC PROJECTIONS
Principles, views of Simple Solids and Truncated Solids - Prisms, Pyramids, Cylinders, Cones.
CONVERSION FROM PICTORIAL PROJECTION TO ORTHOGRAPHIC PROJECTION
Visualization concepts - Layout of views - Simple objects in three dimensions and obtaining orthographic projection.
COMPUTER AIDED DRAFTING 18
1. Introduction to software - Layout of software, standard tool bars/ Menus, coordinate systems and reference
planes - selection of drawing size and scale - Title block.
2. Commands and Creation of points, lines, planes and dimensioning methods.
3. Drawing, viewing and editing 2D Drawings and creating texts.
4. Orthographic projections of simple solids.
5. Drafting of Section of solids and development of solids.
6. Isometric projection of simple solids and truncated solids and convert to orthographic views.
Total Periods: 45
REFERENCES
1. Bhatt, N.D. and Panchal V.M., "Engineering Drawing", 50th Edition,Charotar Publishing House, 2010.
2. Natarajan, K.V., "A Text book of Engineering Graphics", Dhanalakshmi Publishers, Chennai, 2009.
3. Kumar, M.S., "Engineering Graphics", D.D. Publications, 2007.
4. Annaiah, M.H., "Computer Aided Engineering Drawing", New Age International Publishers, 2009.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illuminate the properties, tests of bricks, cement and aggregate.
CO2 : Describe the types of foundations and categorize the masonry construction.
CO3 : Recognize the plastering, Proofing, and understand the vertical techniques and equipments used in
Construction.
CONSTRUCTION MATERIALS 9
Brick: Manufacturing, properties, classification and tests - Stones: Quarrying, dressing and properties - Aggregates-
Classification and properties - Cement: Manufacturing, properties, types and tests - Alternate civil engineering materials
- Steels - Types, properties.
CONSTRUCTION PRACTICES 10
Foundation - Types - Brick masonry -Stone masonry - Types - Mortar- Types- - Flooring -Types- Roofing- Pitched roof-
Types- Flat roof- Types- Plastering- Flooring -Types- Modern Construction practices.
SERVICE REQUIREMENTS 8
Painting - Distempering - White washing - Fire Protection - Thermal insulation - Ventilation and air conditioning - Acoustics
and Sound insulation - Damp proofing - Termite proofing.
VERTICAL TRANSPORTATION 9
Staircases - Types - Staircase planning and geometric rules -Construction practice- Lift: Types - basic Components - Lift
well construction - Safety rules- Escalators and walk ways - Basic concept and Construction practice. Lift with and
without head room - Ramps.
CONSTRUCTION EQUIPMENT 9
Selection of equipment for earth work - Types of earthwork Equipment- Equipment for earth moving operations-Equipment
for foundation and pile driving- Equipment for compaction, batching, mixing, and concreting- Equipment for material
handling and erection of structures- Equipment for dredging , trenching, tunnelling, Tower crane.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Robert L Peurifoy and William B Ledbetter., " Construction Planning, Equipment and Methods ", 6th Edition,
McGraw Hill, 2010.
2. Arora S P and Bindra S P., " A text book of Building Construction: Including Engineering Materials for Engineering
Students", 5th Edition, Dhanpat Rai and Sons, 2012.
REFERENCES
1. Rajput R K., "Engineering Materials", 5th Edition, S.Chand & Co, 2008.
2. Punmia B.C., "Building Construction", Laxmi Publications Pvt. Ltd., 2012.
3. Bindra and Arora, "Building Materials and Construction", Dhanpat Rai and Sons, 2013.
4. Gurcharn Singh., "HandBook of Civil Engineering", 12th Edition, Standard publishers & distributors, 2012.
WEB REFERENCE
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105102088/ nptel-aic/ building materials and construction -intro.pdf
PREREQUISITE
16ME205 Engineering Mechanics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the concepts of the stress, strain and Changes in dimensions and volume, Relationship between
elastic constants.
CO2 : Construct the Shear force and Bending Moment due to lateral loads on beams.
CO3 : Recognize the torsion on shafts and shear stress distribution of various sections and apply it to closed
coiled helical spring.
CO4 : Compute the deflection of beams using different methods.
CO5 : Summarize the principal stresses, principal planes and its angles and thin cylindrical and spherical
Shells.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On the successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the basic concepts, properties of fluid and to infer fluid Statics.
CO2 : Recognize fluid kinematics and examine the equation of motion of dynamics flow.
CO3 : Examine the losses in different types of pipe flows and summarize the concepts of boundary layer.
CO4 : Compute the flow using dimensional and model analysis.
FLUID STATICS 10
Fluid - Definition, Difference between solid and fluid - Units and dimensions - Properties of fluids : Viscosity, Compressibility,
Vapour pressure, Capillarity and Surface tension. Fluid statics: Pressure - Pascal's law - Relationship between Pressures
- Pressure measurements by manometers - Hydrostatic forces on plane and curved surface - Buoyancy - Stability of
floating and submerged bodies, Relative Equilibrium.
FLUID KINEMATICS 7
Fluid Kinematics: Types of flow - Velocity field and acceleration - Continuity equation for one and three dimensional flow
-Equation of streamline -Stream function - Velocity potential function - Flow Nets and their utility - Circulation stagnation
point - Separation of flow.
DYNAMICS OF FLOW 10
Equations of motion - Euler's equation along a streamline - Bernoulli's equation - Applications :Venturimeter, Orifice meter,
Pitot tube- Energy correction factor- Momentum correction factors- Linear momentum equation - Moment of momentus
equation and application - Introduction to Computational Fluid Dynamics -Electromagnetic flow meter, ultrasonic flow
meter.
FLUID MEASUREMENTS AND PIPE FLOWS 10
Laminar flow - Reynolds experiments and Reynolds number -Viscous flow through pipes and between parallel plates -
Hagen Poiseulle's equation - Turbulent flow - Darcy Welsbach formula - Moody diagram-Flow through pipes - Major and
minor losses - Pipes in series and in parallel - Total Energy and Hydraulic energy gradient line - Power transmission -
Laminar and turbulent boundary layers, boundary layer separation and methods of control.
DIMENSIONAL AND MODEL ANALYSIS 8
Dimensional analysis - Rayleigh's method - Buckingham's π-Theorem - Similitude and models - Scale effect and distorted
models.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Subramanya. K, Fluid Mechanics & Hydraulic Machines, 4th Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill Education, 2016.
2. P.N.Modi and S.M.Seth., "Hydraulics and Fluid Mechanics", 18th Edition, Rajsons Publications (P) Ltd., 2015.
REFERENCES
1. Frank M. White, Fluid Mechanics, 7th Edition, McGraw-Hill Higher Education, 2010.
2. Bansal R.K., "Fluid Mechanics and Hydraulic Machines", 9th Edition, Laxmi Publications (P) Ltd., 2015. 3.
Yunus A. Cengel and John M. Cimbala, "Fluid Mechanics" Fundamentals and Applications, Tata McGraw Hill
Publishing Company Ltd, 2010.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105103095
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112104118
3. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/11210517
PREREQUISITE
16CE205 Fluid Mechanics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO 1 : Explain the importance of Hydrologic cycle, the measurement and estimation of rainfall data.
CO 2 : Study the importance of runoff and its computation in the hydrologic design.
CO 3 : Estimate flood and drought.
CO 4 : Identify the Hydraulically Most Efficient Open Channel Section.
CO 5 : Calculate the force exerted by jet and compute the efficiency of different types of pumps and turbines.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105101002/7
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105101002/8
3. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105101002/9
4. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105107059
5. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105103096 ?
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Summarize the different materials used for construction.
CO2 : Demonstrate the basic testing procedures for materials.
CO3 : Arrange the different types of bonds in brick masonry.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:
1. TESTS ON CEMENT: Fineness - Initial and Final setting time -Specific gravity -Soundness -Standard consistency-
Compressive strength
2. TESTS ON FLY ASH: Fineness - Initial and Final setting time -Specific gravity -Soundness -Standard consistency-
Compressive strength
3. TESTS ON BRICKS: Compressive strength -Water absorption and Efflorescence test - Soundness -Hardness test
4. TESTS ON FLYASH BRICKS: Compressive strength -Water absorption and Efflorescence test-Soundness-Hardness
test
5. ARRANGEMENT OF BONDS IN BRICK MASONRY: English Bond- Flemish Bond- Zig Zag Bond- Rat-Trap Bond
PREREQUISITE
16ME256 Engineering Graphics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of this course, students will be able to
CO1 : Show the residential building with load bearing wall (RCC roof) and RCC framed Structures.
CO2 : Sketch the various types of commercial building and educational buildings.
CO3 : Demonstrate the industrial building and perspective view for small buildings.
CO4 : Plan of Electrical wiring for residential building.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
Fundamental commands of AutoCAD (2D&3D) Software to draft the building drawings
Building drawing in accordance with IS: 962- 1989 Code of practice for Architectural and Building drawing for the
following using Auto CAD:
1. Study of vastu concepts for building plan 2. Study of building regulations
3. Setting out of Simple Building and Draw the joinery details : Doors, windows
4. Plan and elevation of different types of Staircases
5. Residential building
6. Commercial building
(i) Office building
(ii) Shopping complex
7. Educational building
8. Industrial building
9. Perspective view for small buildings
10. Plan of Electrical wiring and plumbing layout for residential building
TEXT BOOKS
1. Shah M.G, Kale C.M and Patki S.Y., "Building Drawing with an Integrated Approach to Built Environment", 5th
Edition,Tata McGraw Hill Publishers Limited, 2015.
2. Verma B.P., "Civil Engineering Drawing", 11th Edition, Khanna Publishers, 2014.
WEB REFERENCE
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112102101/nptel.aic/building drawing -intro.pdf
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Evaluate the concepts of Bernoulli's theorem and compute the rate of flow.
CO2 : Examine the major and minor losses in pipes and Estimate the stability of floating bodies.
CO3 : Recognize the flow over notches and weirs.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Verification of Bernoulli's theorem.
2. Determination of Coefficient of discharge of given Orifice meter.
3. Determination of Coefficient of discharge of given Venturi meter.
4. Measurement of air velocity using by Pitot tube assembly.
5. Determination of Friction factor for a given set of pipes.
6. Determination of minor losses in the given set of pipes.
7. Calculation of the rate of flow using Rota meter.
8. Determination of Coefficient of discharge, velocity and Contraction of Orifice.
9. Determination of rate of flow through Mouthpiece.
10. Determination of Meta centric height using Ship Model.
11. Flow over Weirs and Notches.
12. Demonstration of laminar and turbulent flows using Reynold's apparatus.
PREREQUISTIES
16ME205 Engineering Mechanics
16CE204 Solid Mechanics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the basic concepts of Brinell hardness number & Rockwell hardness number for various
specimens.
CO2 : Identify the Impact energy of the specimen using Charpy impact and Izod impact test.
CO3 : Demonstrate the Shear stress, rigidity modulus and stiffness of the given helical spring by conducting
Tension & Compression test on spring.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Plot the relationship between stress and strain in Tension test on mild steel.
2. Brinell, Rockwell and Vicker's Hardness tests.
3. Izod and Charpy Impact test
4. Evaluation of Tension and Compression strength of springs.
5. Determine the young's modulus, bending stress of a simply supported beam with central point load and UDL using
deflection test.
6. Verify Maxwell reciprocal theorem.
7. Test involving torsion to obtain the torque vs. angle of twist and hence the Modulus of rigidity.
8. Determine the shear strength (ultimate shear stress) of the mild steel specimen by using double shear Method.
WEB REFERENCE
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105105108/nptel.aic/Strength of materials -intro.pdf
PREREQUISITES
16CE205 Fluid Mechanics
16CE253 Fluid Mechanics Laboratory
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Outline the flow measurement and loss of specific energy in open channel.
CO2 : Sketch the surface profile of a Free and Forced vortex flow and predict the errors in pressure Gauges.
CO3 : Estimate the performance characteristics curves of pumps and turbines.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Determination of conjugate depth and loss of specific energy in a hydraulic jump.
2. Determination of Coefficient of discharge by Venturi flume.
3. Impact of jet vanes.
4. Determination of surface profile of a Free and Forced vortex Flow.
5. Calibration of Pressure Gauges
6. Performance Characteristics of Centrifugal pump
7. Performance Characteristics of Reciprocating pump
8. Performance Characteristics of Jet Pump
9. Performance Characteristics of Submersible pump
10. Performance Characteristics of Gear pump
11. Performance Characteristics of Turgo Impulse turbine
12. Performance Characteristics of Pelton Wheel turbine
13. Performance Characteristics of Francis turbine
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the concepts of basic electrical and electronics used in the aircraft.
CO2 : Illustrate the operation of motor, generator and batteries.
CO3 : Explain the operation of power supply unit and distribution of power in the aircraft.
CO4 : Discuss the various controls and transducers.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Mike Tooley and David Wyatt, "Aircraft Electrical and Electronic Systems", 1st Edition, Elsevier Ltd. 2009.
2. Scott Kenney, "Fundamentals of Aircraft Electronics", 1st Edition, Avotek Information Resources, 2013.
REFERENCES
1. "Aircraft Wiring and Electrical Installation", 1st Edition, Avotek Information Resources, 2005.
2. Thomas K.Eismain "Aircraft electrical and electronics systems", 6th Edition, McGraw-Hill Education, 2013.
PREREQUISITE
16PH207 Engineering Physics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to,
CO1 : Describe the properties of fluids.
CO2 : Apply the governing equations of fluids.
CO3 : Describe viscous flow and flow losses.
FLUID STATICS 15
Types of substances and their significance- Units and dimensions - Properties of fluids - Density, Specific weight,
Specific volume, Specific gravity, Temperature, Viscosity, Compressibility, Vapor pressure, Capillary and Surface tension,
etc.,-Concept of fluid static pressure, absolute and gauge pressures - Pressure measurements by manometers - Numerical
problems.
FLUID DYNAMICS 19
Types of flow -Velocity field and acceleration - Continuity equation- Flow visualization - Lines of flow - Navier Stokes
Equation - Equation of streamline -Stream function - Velocity potential function- Equations of motion - Euler's equation
along a streamline - Bernoulli's equation - Applications -Venturi meter, Orifice meter, Pitot tube - Numerical Problems.
VISCOUS FLOW 11
Laminar flow between parallel plates - laminar flow through circular tubes (Hage Poiseuille's Equation) - Flow through
pipes (Darcy Weishback equation) - Chezy's Formula - Minor Losses and Major losses - Flow losses - Numerical Problems.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Frank M.White, "Fluid Mechanics", 8th Edition, Mc Graw Hill Publications,2015.
2. Dr.Modi. P.N & Dr. Seth. S.M., "Fluid Mechanics Hydraulics and Hydraulic Machines", 20th Edition, Rajsons
publications Pvt. Ltd., 2015.
REFERENCES
1. K.L.Kumar, "Engineering Fluid Mechanics", 8th Reprint Editon, S.Chand & Co., 2014.
2. Cohen Kundu, P. K., Cohen, I. M., and Dowling, D. R., "Fluid Mechanics", 5th Edition, Academic Press, 2012.
3. Bansal.R.K, "Fluid Mechanics and Hydraulics Machines", 5th Edition,Laxmi publications (P) Ltd, 1995.
4. Streeter.V.L, and Wylie.E.B, "FluidMechanics", 9th Edition, Mc Graw-Hill, 1998.
WEB REFERENCES
1. NPTEL Course: nptel.ac.in/courses/112105183/.
2. NPTEL Course: http://www.nptelvideos.in/2012/11/fluid-mechanics.html.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain basic concepts and the applications relevant to first and second law of thermodynamics.
CO2 : Describe entropy and availability concepts and compare different air cycles.
CO3 : Explain thermodynamics of one-dimensional flows and air compressor.
REFERENCES
1. Radhakrishnan E., "Fundamentals of Engineering Thermodynamics", 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall, 2006.
2. Mayhew A. and Rogers B., "Engineering Thermodynamics", E.L.B.S Edition, Longman Green & Co. Ltd., 2004.
3. Van Wylen G. J. and Sonntag R. E., "Fundamentals of Classical Thermodynamics", 6th Edition, S.I.Version, 2003.
4. Oates, G.C., "Aero thermodynamics of Aircraft Engine Components", AIAA Education Series, 1985.
5. Ganesan.V., "Gas Turbines", 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill Education, 2010.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112105123/4.
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112101097/.
PREREQUISITES
16AE204 Aircraft Electrical and Electronics
16MA204 Laplace Transforms and Vector Calculus
16MA209 Partial Differential Equations and Transform
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the modeling of physical systems using transfer function and study the basic fundamentals of
(feedback) control systems.
CO2 : Determine the time domain responses of first and second-order systems to different inputs.
CO3 : Determine the stability of a closed-loop control system and apply root-locus technique control systems.
CO4 : Determine the frequency domain responses of first and second-order systems using bode plot.
INTRODUCTION 9
Historical review - Open loop and closed loop - Effects of feedback - Transfer function - Block diagram representation of
control systems, Reduction of block diagrams -Signal flow graph representations - Control systems applications in
aircrafts, missiles, spacecrafts.
MODEL REPRESENTATIONS 10
Mathematical models of physical systems - Simple pneumatic, hydraulic and thermal systems - Mechanical system -
Electrical system - Analogies introduction to state space - Concept of state variables and state models, derivation of state
models from block diagram with reference to aircraft models.
TIME RESPONSE AND STEADY STATE ERRORS 10
Response of systems to different inputs, Step input, impulse, ramp, parabolic and sinusoidal inputs - Time response of
first and second order systems - Steady state errors and error constants of unity feedback circuit - Automatic controls
systems - Introduction to P, PI, PID controllers.
CONCEPT OF STABILITY 8
Characteristic equation, location of roots in S-plane-Concept of stability -Routh-Hurwitz criteria of stability - Relative
stability-Nyquist stability Criterion-Root locus Techniques - Construction of root locus.
FREQUENCY RESPONSE AND APPLICATIONS 8
Frequency response - Correlation between time and frequency response - Gain and phase margins - Bode plot method -
Applications of Aircrafts Flight control systems.
Total Periods:45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Katsuhiko Ogata, "Modern Control Engineering", 5th Edition, Pearson,2010.
2. Pallet, E.H.J. "Automatic Flight Control", 2nd Edition, Shroff Publishers, 2004.
REFERENCES
1. Gene F. Franklin, J. D. Powell, Abbas E, "Feedback Control of Dynamic Systems, 6th Edition, Pearson, 2009.
2. Norman S. Nise, "Control Systems Engineering", 4th Edition, John Wiley, 2004.
3. Richard C. Dorf, Robert H. Bishop, "Modern control systems", 11th Edition, Prentice Hall, 2008.
4. Rao V. Dukkipati., "Analysis and design of control systems using MATLAB", New Age International Publishers,
2006.
5. Roger Pratt, "Flight control systems", Institution of Electrical Engineers, 2000.
PREREQUISITES
16AE203 Aviation Development
16AE204 Aircraft Electrical and Electronics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the number systems and logic gates.
CO2 : Design of Combinational and sequential circuits such as adders, subtractors, counters and shift registers.
CO3 : Describe AVR RISC Controller architecture.
CO4 : Develop program for interfacing devices with Microcontroller kit.
DIGITAL ELECTRONICS 15
Introduction to logic gates: Boolean Algebra Theorems - De Morgan's theorem - Logic Gates-Design procedure of
Combinational circuits: Adders- Subtractors - Design of sequential circuits with state diagram, State table, State minimization
and State assignment- Asynchronous/Ripple counters- Shift registers- Conversion of Analog to Digital and Digital to
Analog.
AVR RISC MICROCONTROLLER ARCHITECTURE 15
AVR RISC microcontroller Architecture: AVR Architecture overview - Memories - I/O Ports - Timers/Counters - USART -
ADC.
INTERFACING WITH MICROCONTROLLER 15
Getting started with ARDUINO IDE -C Language Basics-Functions-Arrays and strings-Input and Output-Programs using
ARDUINO-Interfacing ARDUINO with Sensors: Pressure, Temperature, Speed - Bluetooth and Ethernet.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Morris Mano M, "Digital Design", 4th Edition, Pearson Education, 2008.
2. Programming and Interfacing ATMEL's AVRs, Thomas Grace, 1st Edition, Cengage Learning, 2016.
3. Simon Monk, "Programming Arduino, Getting Started with Sketches",McGraw Hill Education TAB, 2012.
REFERENCES
1. Alan B.Marcovitz, "Introduction to Logic Design", 2nd Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2005.
2. Richard H. Barnett,Sarah CoxLarry O'Cull" Embedded C Programming and the Atmel AVR, 2nd Edition, Cengage
Learning, 2003.
3. Data Sheet of Atmega328.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/117106086/1.
2. www.nptel.aurdiono
3. www.arduino.cc
PREREQUISITE
16PH207 Engineering Physics
COURSE OUTCOME
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Perform experiments relevant to concepts of Engineering Mechanics.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Verification of Lami's Theorem and Polygon law of forces.
2. Determination of Beam support reactions
3. Verification of the law of moments using Bell Crank Lever.
4. Experiment on Plane truss.
5. Determination of centre of gravity of lamina.
6. Determination of Moment of Inertia of flywheel and Compound Pendulum.
7. Experiment on Friction.
8. Experiment on dynamic equilibrium
9. Experiment on projectile motion
REFERENCES
1. Gaur R K and Gupta S L, "Engineering Physics", 3rd Edition, Dhanpat Rai Publications, 2013.
2. William D.Callister Jr, David G. Rethwisch "Materials Science and Engineering - An Introduction", 8th Edition,
Wiley, 2009.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112103109/.
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/Webcourse-contents/IIT-KANPUR/engg_mechanics/ui/TableofContents.
PREREQUISITE
16AE203 Aviation Development
COURSE OUTCOME
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Demonstrate knowledge on paper modeling, RC simulator and parametric modeling.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
AERO MODELING
1. Preparation and launching of paper models
2. Fabrication of NACA airfoils using thin plywood
3. Fabrication of Wing, Fuselage and Tail
4. Preparation and launching of water rocket
RC SIMULATOR
1. Taxing, Ground Roll and Take off of a Radio Controlled Airplane
2. Trimming of airplane to steady and level flight
3. Landing of airplane.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Sketch and project the layouts of aircraft components.
CO2 : Assemble the components and draft the models.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
SKETCHES AND LAYOUTS
1. Plane Geometry: Construction of plane figures and curves.
2. Projections: point and lines
3. Solid Geometry: orthographic views.
4. Layout of typical aircraft wing.
5. Layout of typical fuselage structure.
PREREQUISITES
16PH207 Engineering Physics
16PH217 Aircraft Materials and Processes
16AE206 Mechanics of Fluids
16AE207 Thermodynamics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Demonstrate the basic experiments on fluid mechanics.
CO2 : Demonstrate the basic experiments on Strength of Materials.
CO3 : Demonstrate the basic experiments on Thermodynamics.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
FLUID MECHANICS
1. Determination of Coefficient of discharge of Venturi meter
2. Determination of Coefficient of discharge of Orifice meter
3. Determination of friction factor for flow through pipes
4. Experiments on flow losses in pipes
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
5. Construction of Stress-Strain diagrams
6. Brinell and Rockwell Hardness tests
7. Izod and Charpy Impact tests
8. Determination of Tension and Compression strength of springs
THERMODYNAMICS
9. Plot the valve and port timing diagram
10. Determination of brake thermal efficiency of a 4 stroke engine.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the construction and operation of DC machines.
CO2 : Explain the construction and operation of transformers.
CO3 : Describe the construction, operational details of induction motors and its applications.
CO4 : Understand the concepts of special machines and its applications.
DC MACHINES 11
Construction of DC machines - Principle of operation of DC generators - EMF equation - Types of DC generators and their
characteristics - Principle of operation of DC motors - Types of DC motors and their characteristics - Starters - Speed
control of DC motors - DC machine application.
TRANSFORMERS 9
Construction and principle of operation of single phase transformer - EMF equation - Types - transformer on no-load and
load - Equivalent circuit - Open circuit and short circuit tests - Auto transformer.
INDUCTION MOTORS 12
Construction and principle of operation of 3-phase induction motor - Types - Slip - Torque characteristics - Starting
methods - Speed control methods - Single-phase induction motor: Construction and principle of operation,types -
Applications.
SPECIAL MACHINES AND ITS APPLICATIONS 13
Stepper motors - Types- Synchronous motor - Reluctance motor and hysteresis motor - Switched Reluctance Motor
(SRM) - Universal motor - Linear Induction Motor (LIM) - Brushless DC (BLDC) Motor, DC and AC servomotor.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Gupta J.B, "Theory and Performance of Electrical Machines", 14th Edition, S.K.Kataria and Sons, 2009.
2. Kothari D.P. and Nagrath I.J., "Electric Machines", 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill Education Pvt. Ltd., 2004.
REFERENCES
1. Theraja B.L., "Electrical Technology Vol. II AC/DC Machines", 2nd Edition, S. Chand and Company Ltd., 2008.
2. Mehta V.K. and Rohit Mehta, "Principles of Power System", 3rd Edition, S.Chand and Company Ltd., 2006.
3. Mittle. V.N. and Arvind Mittle, "Basic Electrical Engineering", 2nd Edition, Tata McGraw Hill Education Pvt. Ltd.,
2007.
PREREQUISITE
16PH209 Applied Physics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : State the different SI units and standards of measurement, measure electrical and non electrical parameters.
CO2 : Explain the functional block diagram of digital instruments and special instruments with applications.
CO3 : Illustrate the VI source code using VI programming.
CO4 : Model and Construct VI codes in Virtual Environment with real time sensor interfacing on NI DAQ card.
PREREQUISITES
16EI204 Digital Logic Circuits
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the internal architecture, addressing modes and the instruction sets of 8051.
CO2 : Develop program for On -chip peripherals and real world application program for interfacing ADC, DAC,
LCD, matrix key board and Stepper motor with 8051 using assembly language and C .
CO3 : Explain the ARM programming model and its processor architecture.
CO4 : Describe 32 bit and 16 bit ARM instructions .
CO5 : Develop embedded C programming for ARM Architecture.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Develop Assembly language program to perform arithmetic and logical operation for 8051.
CO2 : Develop C program for 8051 on chip peripherals.
CO3 : Develop interfacing programs for 8051 microcontroller using Embedded C.
CO4 : Develop real time interfacing programs for ARM controller in Embedded C.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
8051 PROGRAMMING
ASSEMBLY LANGUAGE PROGRAMMING
1. To perform Arithmetic Operations
2. Sorting of an array
EMBEDDED C PROGRAMMING
1. On-chip Timers of 8051 in Interrupt Mode and Polling Mode.
2. On-chip Serial Port (UART) to establish communication between a PC and an 8051 Microcontroller.
3. Interfacing of LCD
4. Interfacing of Temperature Sensor through an external ADC
5. Interfacing Motors (DC Motor, Stepper Motor) with 8051 Microcontroller.
PREREQUISITES
16EI201 Electric Circuits and Electron Devices
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Interpret the inter-relationship between two port network parameters, perform interconnection of two port
networks and construct ladder and lattice networks.
CO2 : Obtain network functions of two port networks and interpret the properties of driving point and transfer
functions.
CO3 : Synthesize RL, RC and LC driving point impedance and admittance functions.
CO4 : Obtain and analyze the transient response of RL, RC and RLC circuits.
CO5 : Determine the current, voltage and power in three phase ac circuits.
NETWORK SYNTHESIS 10
Realization concept - Hurwitz property - Positive real function - Properties - Synthesis of RL, RC and LC, driving point
impedance and admittance functions using Foster and Cauer forms.
TRANSIENT ANALYSIS 10
Source free and forced responses of RL, RC & RLC circuits with DC and sinusoidal excitation.
THREE PHASE CIRCUITS 13
Star delta connections - Phasor diagram - Solution of three phase balanced circuits and unbalanced circuits - Three phase
power measurement using watt meter method.
Total Periods: 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. John Bird, "Electric Circuit Theory and Technology", 4th Edition, Newnes Publication, 2010.
2. Van Valkenburg M. E., "Network Analysis", 3rd Edition, Prentice Hall of India, 2011.
REFERENCES
1. Sudhakar A and Shyammohan, "Circuits and Networks Analysis and Synthesis", 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw Hill
Publication, 2007.
2. Van Valkenburg M.E., "Introduction to Modern Network Synthesis", Wiley Eastern Limited, 1999.
3. Jagan N.C. and Lakshminarayanan C., "Network Analysis", B.S. Publications, 2008.
4. Chakrabati A, "Circuits Theory (Analysis and synthesis)", Dhanpath Rai & Sons, New Delhi, 1999.
5. Suresh Kumar K.S., "Electric Circuits and Networks", Pearson Education, 2009.
6. J. David Irvin, "Basic Engineering Circuit Analysis",10th Edition, John Wiley and Sons Publisher, (E-Book).
PREREQUISITES
16PH209 Applied Physics
16MA204 Laplace Transforms and Vector Calculus
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand the concepts of Electrostatics and applications.
CO2 : Understand the concepts of Magnetostatics and applications.
CO3 : Applying Divergence and Stoke's theorem and basic laws of EMF to explain Maxwell's equations.
CO4 : Explain Electrodynamic Fields and wave propagation.
REFERENCES
1. Joseph A. Edminister, "Theory and Problems of Electromagnetics", Schaum Series, 2nd Edition, McGraw Hill, 2006.
2. Mathew N. O. Sadiku, "Elements of Electromagnetics", 4th Edition, Oxford University Press, 2006.
3. John D. Kraus, "Electromagnetics", 5th Edition, McGraw Hill, 1999.
4. Kraus and Fleish, "Electromagnetics with Applications", 5th Edition, McGraw Hill International Editions, 1999.
5. David K Cheng, "Field and Wave Electromagnetics", 2nd Edition, Pearson Education, 2004.
WEB REFERENCE
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/108101090
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO 1 : Demonstratethe construction, working principle and applications of electrical machines and transformers.
CO 2 : Explain the number systems, logic gates and combinational circuits.
CO 3 : Design sequential circuits.
CO 4 : Explain counters and shift registers.
CO 5 : Describe the internal architecture, addressing modes and the instruction sets of 8051.
CO 6 : Develop basic programs with 8051 microcontroller.
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING 15
Ohm's Law - Kirchoff's Law - Series and Parallel Connections, Star - Delta Transformations.
Dc Motor - Construction And Principle Of Operation - Different Types - EMF Equation - Significance of Back EMF -
Speed, Torque, Speed-Torque Characteristics - Output Power - Efficiency. Ac motor: Three phase induction motor -
Principle of operation - Types - Slip - Speed - Torque Characteristic - Speed control - Introduction to alternators.
Transformers: Construction and operation of single phase transformer.
ELECTRONICS ENGINEERING 12
Introduction to Logic Gates: Boolean Algebra Theorems - De Morgan's Theorem - Logic Gates- combinational circuits: -
Adders- Subtractors -Design of Sequential Circuits with state Diagram, State table, State minimization and State assignment-
Asynchronous / Ripple Counters-Shift Registers.
THE 8051 ARCHITECTURE, INSTRUCTION SET AND PROGRAMMING 18
8051 Microcontroller Hardware - Input/output pins - Counters and Timers - Serial Data Input/output -Interrupts - 8051
Addressing Modes - Arithmetic Instructions - Logical Instructions - Single bit Instructions - Simple programs - 8051
interfacing to a stepper motor.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Kothari D.P., & Nagrath I.J., "Electric Machines", 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill Education Private Limited, 2004.
2. Morris Mano M, "Digital Design", 4th Edition, Pearson Education, 2008.
3. Kenneth J.Ayala, "The Microcontroller Architecture - Programming & Applications", 3rd Edition, Cengage Learning,
2004.
REFERENCES
1. Gupta J.B., "Theory and Performance of Electrical Machines", 14th Edition, S.K.Kataria and Sons, 2009.
2. Theraja, B.L., "A Text Books of Electrical Technology ", S.S.Chand and Co., 1998.
3. Gupta J.B., "Theory and Performance of Electrical Machines", 14th Edition, S.K.Kataria and Sons, 2009.
4. Muhammad Ali Mazidi, Jamice Gillispit Mazidi, "The 8051 micro controller and Embedded System", 2nd Edition,
Pearson Education, 2006.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Summarize the basic laws and apply them to solve the Electric circuits.
CO2 : Outline the principle and operation of DC machines.
CO3 : Outline the principle and operation of AC machines and transformers.
CO4 : Illustrate the different types of measuring instruments and sensors.
CO5 : Demonstrate the various electrical safety systems and importance of illumination.
ELECTRIC CIRCUITS 10
Introduction to DC and AC circuits - Active and Passive elements - Ohm's law - Kirchhoff's law - Voltage and Current
relations for R,L,C - Generation of AC - Average and RMS values - Power and Power factor - Introduction to three phase
systems - Types of connections, relationship between line and phase values.
ELECTRICAL MACHINES AND TRANSFORMERS 10
Working principle, construction and applications of DC machines and AC machines - Introduction to three phase induction
motors.
Construction and Principle of operation of Transformers- Single phase and Three phase transformers.
MEASURING INSTRUMENTS AND SENSORS 10
Basic principles and classification of instruments- Moving coil and moving iron instruments- Measurement of single
phase and three phase power- Energy meter - Vibration measurement - Piezo electric transducers - Humidity and moisture
measurement.
Satellite Imaging and sensing sensor, light sensor - Fiber-optic based radiation measurement.
ELECTRICAL SAFETY, WIRING 8
Safety measures in Electrical systems - Types of wiring - Service mains, Meter and Distribution Board - Basic principles of
Earthing - Measurement of Earth resistance - Types of earthing - Protective devices: Fuses, MCB, ELCB.
ILLUMINATION 7
Energy efficient lamps - Types of lamps - Requirements of good lighting - Design of illumination schemes.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. R.Muthusubramanian, S.Salivahanan and K.A.Muraleedharan, "Basic Electrical, Electronics and Computer
Engineering", 2nd Edition, Tata McGraw-HillEducation Publishing Company, 2006.
2. Bhattacharya S.K., "Basic Electrical and Electronics Engineering", 1st Edition, Pearson education, 2011.
REFERENCES
1. Kothari D.P., &Nagrath I.J., "Electric Machines", 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill Education Private Limited, 2004.
2. Gupta J.B., "Theory and Performance of Electrical Machines", 14th Edition, S.K.Kataria and Sons, 2009.
3. SawhneyA.K. "A course in Electrical & Electronic Measurements & Instrumentation", DhanpatRai & Sons, 2004.
4. Smarajt Ghosh, "Fundamentals of Electrical and Electronics Engineering", 2nd Edition, PHI Learning, 2007.
5. Gupta. J.B., "Utilization of Electric Power and Electric Traction", 10th Edition, S.K. Kataria and Sons.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Verify laws and network theorems and interpret the results.
CO2 : Determine the frequency and transient responses of series and parallel RL, RC and RLC circuits and
interpret the results.
CO3 : Simulate the device characteristics with PSPICE/Multisim.
CO4 : Design electrical and electronic applications by using the components.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Measurement of resistance, inductance and capacitance.
2. Verification of Circuit Laws and Network Theorems.
3. Characteristics of BJT, UJT and MOSFET.
4. Electric Circuit Simulation Using PSPICE and Multisim.
i. Steady-state analysis of DC circuits.
ii. Steady-state analysis of single and three phase AC coupled circuits.
iii. Transient analysis of RL, RC and RLC Circuits.
iv. Frequency Response of circuits A) Series Resonance B) Parallel Resonance.
5. Applications.
i. Design of mobile charger.
ii. Design of Regulated Power Supply.
iii. Design of Voltage Doubler circuit.
iv. PCB design and testing of Simple Circuits.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Verify laws and theorems by digital simulation.
CO2 : Obtain the voltage, current and power in different branches of DC circuits by digital simulation.
CO3 : Obtain the active power, reactive power, apparent power and power factor of single phase and three phase
AC circuits by digital simulation.
CO4 : Study the transient and frequency response of circuits by digital simulation.
CO5 : Obtain and analyze the output of diode bridge rectifier and zener voltage regulator by digital simulation.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Simulation of simple electric circuits.
2. Circuit Laws and Network Theorems.
3. Transient response of electric circuits.
4. Frequency response of RLC resonance circuits.
5. Power and power factor of single phase and three phase AC circuits.
6. Diode bridge rectifiers.
7. Zener voltage regulator.
8. Relay driver circuits using Transistor, and MOSFET.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Verify Electric circuit laws and interpret the results.
CO2 : Choose the appropriate speed control method for DC motors, Induction motors and to obtain their
Performance characteristics.
CO3 : Perform load test on single phase induction motors and interpret the results.
CO4 : Demonstrate simple combinational and Sequential logic circuits.
CO5 : Develop programs using 8051 instruction set.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Verification of Ohm's Law and Kirchhoff's Law.
2. Load test on DC shunt motor.
3. Speed control of DC shunt motor.
4. Load test on single phase Induction motor.
5. Speed control of three phase slip ring Induction motor.
6. Combinational Circuit Experiments.
a. Adder
b. Subtractor
7. Sequential Circuit.
a. Ripple Counter
b. Shift register
8. Eight Bit Architecture - using 8051 Instruction set.
9. Sorting of Array - using 8051 Instruction set.
10. Interfacing Stepper Motor 8051.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Determine the current and voltage by applying laws for DC circuits.
CO2 : Apply network theorems for analyzing DC Circuits.
CO3 : Compute impedance, admittance, power and power factor of AC circuits.
CO4 : Analyze the resonant and coupled circuits.
CO5 : Interpret the device characteristics and its applications.
DC CIRCUIT ANALYSIS 15
Charge, current, voltage, power and energy- Ideal voltage and current sources - Independent sources- Dependent
sources- Circuits elements - Voltage and current division in series and parallel circuits - Network analysis using Mesh and
nodal analysis - Source transformation- Star delta transformation- Circuit theorems: Thevenin, Norton, Superposition,
Reciprocity and Maximum Power transfer theorem.
AC CIRCUIT ANALYSIS 15
Sinusoidal voltage and current- RMS value- Form factor -Phasor representation of sinusoidal voltage-Current, Voltage-
Current relationship in R,L and C Circuits-Impedance and admittance- Power factor concepts in RL , RC and RLC circuits-
Impedance combination- Real power-Reactive power, complex power, apparent power-Analysis of simple series and
parallel circuits, concepts of three phase circuits.
RESONANCE AND COUPLED CIRCUITS 10
Series and Parallel Circuits - Half power frequencies-Bandwidth and Q Factor of Resonant circuits - Self and Mutual
Inductance - Dot Convention-Coefficient of coupling - Sinusoidal steady state analysisof coupled Circuits - Transient
analysis of Electric Circuits.
DEVICE CHARACTERISTICS 20
Diodes - Characteristics, design of regulated power supply- BJT: Characteristics and h-parameters for CE, CB, CC
configurations - Biasing circuits and types - Transistor as a switch - Transistor amplifier circuits- Characteristics and
applications of UJT, SCR, DIAC, TRIAC, JFET, MOSFET and IGBT.
Total Periods: 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. John Bird, “Electric Circuit Theory and Technology”, 4th Edition, Newnes Publication, 2010.
2. Robert. L. Boylestad, Louis Nashalskey, "Electronic Devices and Circuits", 11th Edition, Pearson Education, 2015.
REFERENCES
1. Joseph A.Edminister, MahmoodNahri, "Electric Circuits", Schaum's Series, 5th Edition, McGrawHill Publications.,
2010.
2. William H.Hayt, Jack E.Kemmerly and Steven M.Durbin, "Engineering Circuit Analysis", 8th Edition, McGrawHill
Publications, 2013.
3. Charles. K. Alexander, Mathew. N.O.Sadiku, "Fundamentals of Electric Circuits", 5th Edition, Mc GrawHill
Publications, 2013.
4. Salivahanan.S, Suresh Kumar.N and Vallavaraj.A, "Electronic Devices and Circuits", 3rd Edition, McGrawHill
Publications, 2012.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17-ee02/preview
2. www.vidyathiplus.in/2011/11electronic-device-and-circuits-edc.html/
3. nptel.ac.in/courses/117106108
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Identify air standard cycles.
CO2 : Explain the working of internal combustion engines
CO3 : Analyse the heat processes in engineering applications.
CO4 : Summarize the properties of fluid.
CO5 : Appraise the dynamics of flow.
CO6 : Describe performance of hydraulic machines.
PREREQUISITE
16EI201 Electric Circuits and Electron Devices.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the construction, principle of operation of DC machines.
CO2 : Discuss the construction and operation of transformer.
CO3 : Outline the features of induction machines and synchronous machines.
CO4 : Discuss the construction, principle of operation of induction motors.
CO5 : Understand the construction, principle of operation of special electrical machines.
DC MACHINES 14
DC Machines: Constructional features - Principle of operation - Types - EMF and torque equations- Characteristics of
different types of DC generators and motors - Starting, braking and speed control of DC motors.
TRANSFORMERS 14
Transformers: Principle, theory of an ideal transformer - EMF equation - Constructional details of core and shell type
transformers - Open circuit and short circuit test - Equivalent circuit and efficiency - Auto transformers.
AC MACHINES 18
Induction Machines: Construction and principle of operation - Types- Torque equation - Slip-Torque characteristics-
Equivalent circuit and efficiency - Starting, braking and speed control methods.
Synchronous Machines: Construction - Type - EMF equation and phasor diagram - Working principle of synchronous
motors - Starting method - V curves - Hunting.
FRACTIONAL HORSEPOWER MACHINES 14
Single phase induction motor - Double field revolving theory - Equivalent circuit - Starting methods of single phase
induction motors - Special machines: Servomotors, reluctance and hysteresis motor, repulsing motor, stepper motors,
linear induction motors and brushless DC motor.
Total Periods: 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. Deshpande, "Electrical Machines", 3rd Edition, Prentice Hall India Pvt. Ltd., 2009.
2. Gupta J.B, "Theory and performance of Electrical Machines",14th Edition, Kataria and sons, 2010.
REFERENCES
1. Kothari D.P., Nagrath I.J., "Electric Machine",4th Edition, McGraw Hill Publications, 2016.
2. Bhattacharya S.K, "Electrical Machines", 3rd Edition, McGraw Hill Publications, 2009.
3. Theraja. B.L, "Electrical Technology", Vol II, S.Chand and Co. Ltd., 2008.
WEB REFERENCES
1. nptel.ac.in/courses/108105017
2. nptel.ac.in/courses/108106072
PREREQUISITE
16EI201 Electric Circuits and Electron Devices.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Simplify the Boolean expressions.
CO2 : Design the combinational logic circuits.
CO3 : Design synchronous and asynchronous sequential logic circuits.
CO4 : Explain the concepts of logic families
CO5 : Distinguish the features of memory devices.
CO6 : Implement the combinational circuits using programmable logic devices and HDL.
BOOLEAN FUNCTIONS 5
Review of number systems - Boolean algebra - Minimization of Boolean expressions - Canonical and standard forms -
Digital logic gates - NAND and NOR based logic -Gate level minimization.
COMBINATIONAL LOGIC CIRCUIT 10
Analysis and design of combinational logic circuits: Arithmetic units - Decoders - Encoders - Multiplexers - Demultiplexers
- Code converters - Parity circuits - Comparators - Applications of combinational logic circuits.
SEQUENTIAL LOGIC CIRCUIT 10
Latches - Flip-flops - Analysis of clocked sequential circuit - Sequential circuit design - Shift registers - Synchronous
counters - Asynchronous counters.
ASYNCHRONOUS SEQUENTIAL LOGIC CIRCUIT AND DIGITAL LOGIC FAMILIES 10
Analysis of asynchronous and design procedure for fundamental mode circuits - Races - Hazards - Digital IC specification
terminology - Transistor and transistor logic - Complementary metal oxide semiconductor logic.
MEMORY, PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC DEVICES AND HDL 10
Memory: RAM architecture - Types of RAM - ROM architecture - Types of ROM - Programmable logic devices: Concepts
of PLA, PAL, FPGA - Implementation of combinational logic using PLA and PAL - HDL :Preface to Verilog programming-
Combinational logic circuits.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Morris Mano, "Digital Design", 12th Edition, Pearson Education Ltd., 2012.
2. Charles H.Roth, "Fundamentals of Logic design", 7th Edition, Thomson Learning, 2014.
3. Doald P.leach, Albert Paul malvino and Goutam Saha , "Digital Principles and Application, 7th Edition, McGraw Hill
Publications, 2011.
REFERENCES
1. Mandal S.K., "Digital Principles and System Design", McGraw Hill Publications, 2013.
2. David J.Comer, "Digital Logic and State Machine Design", 3rd Edition, Oxford University Press, 2008.
3. Michael D.Ciletti, " Advanced Digital Design with Verilog HDL", Reprint, Prentice Hall of India Pvt.,Ltd.,2005.
4. Anil K.Maini, "Digital Electronics Principles, Devices and Applications", 3rd Edition, John Wiley and Sons Ltd.,
2007.
5. Salivahanan S and Arivazhagan S., "Digital Circuits and Design", 3rd Edition, Vikas Publishing House, 2009.
WEB REFERENCES
1. nptel.ac.in/courses/106108099/digital%20systems.pdf
2. nptel.ac.in/courses/117106086/1
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the fundamentals of Electric Circuits and to solve Circuits using Network Theorems.
CO2 : Explain the features of PN Junction Diode, Transistor and to describe the operational characteristics and
its applications.
CO3 : Gain knowledge on special Semiconductor Devices and its application.
ELECTRIC CIRCUITS AND NETWORK THEOREMS 20
Introduction to Circuits and Components (R,L,C) - Star Delta Transformation - Delta Star Transformation- Introduction to
AC and DC circuits - Sinusoidal Voltage and Current - RMS value - Form Factor - Kirchoff's Laws - Network Theorems -
Thevenin - Norton - Superposition - Maximum Power Transfer - Reciprocity Theorem.
FUNDAMENTALS OF SEMICONDUCTOR AND DIODE THEORY 15
Review of Intrinsic and Extrinsic Semiconductors - PN Junction Diode-Power Supply Circuit - Zener Diode -Voltage
Regulator - BJT construction and working principle - BJT configurations - JFET construction and working - MOSFET
construction and working - Characteristics and its applications.
SPECIAL PURPOSE SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES 10
Tunnel Diodes - Varactor Diode - SCR - UJT - DIAC - TRIAC - Photodiode - Phototransistor - Applications.
Total Periods: 45
TEXTBOOKS
1. Joseph A. Edminister, Mahmood Nahvi, " Electric Circuits", Schaum's Series,5th Edition,McGraw Hill Publications,
2010.
2. Salivahanan.S, Suresh Kumar. N and Vallavaraj. A, "Electronic Devices and Circuits", 3rd Edition, McGraw Hill
Publications, 2012.
REFERENCES
1. Charles K. Alexander, Mathew N.O. Sadiku, "Fundamentals of Electric Circuits", 5th Edition, McGraw Hill
Publications,2013.
2. Jacob Millman, Christos C.Halkias, "Electronic Devices and Circuits", 3rd Edition, McGraw Hill Publications, 2012.
3. Sudharkar.A and Shyam Mohan. S.P, "Circuits and Network Analysis and Synthesis", 4th Edition, McGraw Hill
Publications, 2010.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17-ee02/preview
2. www.vidyathiplus.in/2011/11electronic-device-and-circuits-edc.html/
3. nptel.ac.in/courses/117106108
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand the concepts of measurement systems.
CO2 : Select an appropriate meter for the given applications.
CO3 : Design and analyse bridge circuits for measurement of resistance and impedance.
CO4 : Analyse the characteristics of transducers used for measuring physical parameters.
CO5 : Identify and select suitable measurement instruments for measuring parameters like strain, pressure,
motion, light radiations, heat and temperature.
CO6 : Explain electronic sensors used in modern applications.
MEASUREMENT SYSTEMS 10
Basics of measurements - Units and standards - Errors in measurements - Error correction methods - Statistical analysis of
error data - Review of analog meters - Digital Multimeter - Digital Storage oscilloscope.
MEASUREMENT OF RESISTANCE AND IMPEDANCE 10
Principle, construction and working of D'arsonval galvanometer and vibration galvanometer - Wheatstone bridge, Kelvin
bridge, Schering bridge, Maxwell's bridge, Hay's bridge, Anderson bridge.
CLASSIFICATION OF TRANSDUCERS 10
Characteristics of transducers -Selection of transducers -Resistance transducers: Resistance potentiometer - Strain gauge -
Resistance thermometer - Thermistor - Hot-wire anemometer - Piezoresistive Sensor and Humidity Sensor - Inductance
transducers: LVD - Induction potentiometer - Variable Reluctance Transducers - Capacitance Transducers -Thermo
Electric Sensors: Thermocouple.
APPLICATIONS OF SENSORS 15
Motion Sensors: Capacitor plate sensor - Inductive sensors - LVDT Accelerometer - Rotation sensors - Rotary encoders -
Light Radiation: Photo sensors - Fiber-optic applications - Light transducer - Solid-state transducers and liquid crystal
devices -Electronic Sensors: Proximity detectors - Ultrasonic - Photo Beam Detectors - Hall Effect Sensors - Doppler
Detectors - Liquid Level Detectors, Flow Sensors, Smoke Sensors.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Sawhney A.K, "A Course in Electrical and Electronic Measurements and Instrumentation", 19th Edition, Dhanpat
Rai and Co., 2011.
2. Vijayachitra S., "Transducers Engineering", 1st Edition, Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd., 2016.
REFERENCES
1. Doebelin E.O and Manik D.N., "Measurement Systems - Applications and Design", Special Indian Edition, Tata
McGraw Hill Education Pvt. Ltd., 2007.
2. Patranabis D., "Sensors and Transducers", 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd., 2010.
3. Murthy D.V.S., "Transducers and Instrumentation", 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd., 2010.
WEB REFERENCES
1. nptel.ac.in/courses/108105064/34
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112103174/3
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Verify laws and network theorems.
CO2 : Obtain the characteristics of semiconductor devices
CO3 : Simulate the device characteristics and circuit analysis using software tools.
CO4 : Design simple application circuits using electrical and electronic components.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Measurement of resistance, inductance and capacitance using electronic test meters.
2. Verification of Circuit Laws and Network Theorems.
3. Characteristics of BJT, UJT, MOSFET and IGBT.
4. Measurement of resistance and inductance of a choke coil.
5. Electric Circuit Simulation Using MATLAB
i. Basics functions of MATLAB.
ii. Steady-state analysis of circuits: Solution of algebraic equation.
iii. Introduction to Simulink and Simulation of RL, RC and RLC Circuits.
6. Electric Circuit Simulation Using PSPICE and Multisim.
7. Steady-state analysis of DC circuits.
8. Steady-state analysis of single and three phase AC coupled circuits.
9. Transient analysis of RL, RC and RLC Circuits.
10. Frequency Response of circuits
A) Series Resonance B) Parallel Resonance
11. Applications
i. Design of mobile charger.
ii. Design of Regulated Power Supply.
iii. PCB design and testing of Simple Circuits.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Design and Implement combinational logic circuits using gates.
CO2 : Design and Implement synchronous sequential logic circuits.
CO3 : Design and Implement asynchronous sequential logic circuits.
CO4 : Simulate digital circuits using software packages.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Design and implementation of combinational logic circuits.
2. Design and implementation of synchronous sequential circuits.
3. Design and implementation of asynchronous sequential circuits.
4. Verification of NAND gate with CMOS logic.
5. Simulation of combinational logic circuit using Verilog.
6. Realization of Boolean functions using programming techniques using software packages.
7. Design of digital clock.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course,students will be able to
CO1 : Verify Network Theorems and interpret the Results.
CO2 : Determine frequency response of Series, Parallel RLC Circuits and characteristics of SemiConductor
Diodes, Interpret the results.
CO3 : Obtain the performance parameters graphically for BJT, FET and Power Control Devices Experimentally.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Verification of Network Theorems.
2. Frequency response of series and parallel resonance circuits.
3. PN Junction Diode and Zener Diode Characteristics and applications.
4. BJT - Configuration and Characteristics.
5. FET - Configuration and Characteristics.
6. Characteristics of power control device.
7. Design of power supply circuit using electronic components.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, the students will be able to
CO1 : Analyse the characteristics of transducers.
CO2 : Design of Signal conditioning unit for measuring Physical Quantities.
CO3 : Simulate the Resistance and Impedance measurement using ELVIS Kit.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Measurement of Linear Displacement using LVDT.
2. Hall Effect Transducer for Electrical measurement.
3. Analyze the static characteristics of RTD.
4. Analyze the dynamic characteristics of RTD.
5. Analyze the characteristics ofCapacitive Transducer.
6. Design of Bridge Circuit for the measurement of Resistance and Impedance.
7. Design a Signal conditioning for the measurement of Strain.
8. Design a Signal Conditioning Circuit for a Temperature Sensor using Bridge Circuit.
9. Design of Burglar Alarm Circuit using LDR.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Elucidate the recent advancements in the fields of biomedical computing, biomechanics, tissue engineering.
CO2 : Realize the knowledge about the various career opportunities in the fields of biomedical engineering.
WEB REFERENCES
1. www.embs.org
2. www.bmes.org
3. www.tissue engineering international & regenerative medicine society.org
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand the operation, characteristics and applications of semiconductor diodes.
CO2 : Gain knowledge on working principle of transistors (BJT and FET) and its applications.
CO3 : Gain working knowledge on devices with its applications.
REFERENCES
1. Thomas L Floyd, "Electronic devices conventional current version", 9th Edition, Pearson Education, India, 2016.
2. Donald.A. Neamen, "Semiconductor Physics and Devices basic principles", 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw Hill, 2012.
3. Salivahanan.S, Suresh Kumar.N and Vallavaraj.A, "Electronic Devices and Circuits", 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw
Hill, 2012.
4. Mital G.K. and Gupta M, "Electronic Devices and Circuits", 22nd Edition, Khanna Publisher, 1999.
PREREQUISITE
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Determine the current and voltage by applying laws and network theorems.
CO2 : Reduce the complex circuits to simple circuits using reduction techniques and star delta transformations.
CO3 : Reduce the complex circuits to simple circuits and apply mesh and nodal analysis to compute the current
and voltage magnitudes in different branches of the given circuit.
CO4 : Compute impedance, admittance and Obtain the transient response of series and parallel AC circuits and
frequency response of AC circuits.
CO5 : Explain the operational amplifiers and its applications.
REFERENCES
1. William H.Hayt, Jack E.Kemmerly and Steven M.Durbin, "Engineering Circuit Analysis", 8th Edition, Tata McGraw-
Hill Education ,2013.
2. Charles. K. Alexander, Mathew.N.O.Sadiku, "Fundamentals of Electric Circuits", 5th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill
Education,2013.
3. John Bird, "Electric Circuit Theory and Technology", 4th Edition, Newnes Publication, 2010.
PREREQUISITE
16BM203 Biochemistry
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO 1 : List the biological databases and their information content.
CO 2 : Retrieve data from biological and medical databases.
CO 3 : Analyze gene sequences for coding and non coding regions, regulatory elements
CO 4 : Analyze protein sequences, predict structure and functions.
EXERCISES
Biological databases - DNA, RNA, proteins - Primary and secondary databases - Sequences and structure databases -
Databasesof model organisms - Databases of medical literature - Data retrieval - Data analysis - Tools and applications:
Sequence analysis - DNA - genes, exons, promoters and enhancers, terminal elements, phylogenetic analysis secondary
and tertiary structure prediction - Proteins - Sequence analysis and structure prediction - Homology Modeling, threading
and ab initio prediction.
REFERENCES
1. Mount DW, "Bioinformatics Sequence and Genome analysis", Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, 2010.
2. Hooman Rashidi, Lukas K. Buehler, "Bioinformatics Basics: Applications in Biological Science and Medicine", 2nd
Edition, CRC Press/Taylor & Francis Group, 2015.
3. Andreas D. Baxevanis (Ed), B. F. Francis Ouellette (Ed), "Bioinformatics: A Practical Guide to the Analysis of
Genes and Proteins", 3rd Edition, John Wiley & Sons, 2014.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Measure signal parameters using oscilloscopes.
CO2 : Construct and test the operation of semiconductor diodes and BJT characteristics experimentally.
CO3 : Obtain the performance parameters for JFET, MOSFET, UJT and power control device (SCR, DIAC,
TRIAC) experimentally.
CO4 : Construct, test and obtain experimental characteristics of Photodiode and Photo- transistor.
CO5 : To verify the characteristics of circuits using simulation tool.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Measurement of Voltage, frequency and phase angle using CRO and DSO.
2. PN Junction Diode and Zener Diode Characteristics and applications.
3. BJT - Configuration and Characteristics.
4. FET and MOSFET- Configuration and Characteristics.
5. UJT Characteristics and application.
6. Characteristics of power control devices (SCR, DIAC, and TRIAC).
7. Characteristics of Photodiode, Phototransistor and optocoupler.
8. Simulation Study on Diode, BJT and verify the same with virtual lab.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Identify the importance of Computers in all Fields.
CO2 : Classify the IOT and Mobile Applications.
CO3 : Understand the applications of Data Science and HPC.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://www.slideshare.net/midhiraj/application-of-computer-in-chemical-industry-53941767
2. http://www.sciencedirect.com/science/article/pii/S1319157816300799
3. https://www.aspsys.com/solutions/hpc-applications
4. http://www.sciencedirect.com/science/article/pii/S0273117716304689
5. http://www.sciencedirect.com/science/article/pii/S1389128610001568
6. http://www.sciencedirect.com/science/article/pii/S0167739X14002519
7. http://www.sciencedirect.com/science/article/pii/S1574013715300435
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, the student will be able to
CO1 : Classify Data Types and cite their significance.
CO2 : Select appropriate decision–making and looping constructs in Programming
CO3 : Apply Modularization Techniques for problem solving through Programming.
CO4 : Summarize Input / Output processing by manipulating Files.
INTRODUCTION TO COMPUTING 8
Fundamentals of Computing – Historical perspective – Early Computers – Computing Machine – Problems –
Pseudo Code and Flowcharts – Memory – Number System Representation and Conversion – Variables – Values –
Instructions – Programs.
INTRODUCTION TO C 17
The Language of C – Phases of developing a running Computer Program in C – Data concepts in C – Constants –
Variables – Expressions – Operators and Operator precedence in C – Statements – Declarations – Input/Output
Statements – Compound Statements – Selection Statements – Conditions – Logical Operators, Precedence’s –
Repetitive Statements – While Construct – Do–While Construct – For Construct – Arrays – Multidimensional
Arrays and Matrices.
Total Periods: 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. H. M. Deitel, P. J. Deitel, “C: How to Program”, 7th Edition, Pearson Education, 2010.
2. Kernighan and Ritchie, “The C Programming Language”, 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall, 1988.
REFERENCES
1. R. G. Dromey, “How to Solve it by Computer”, Pearson, 1982.
2. A.R. Bradley, “Programming for Engineers”, Springer, 2011.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106105085/4
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106104128/
3. http://www.nptelvideos.in/2012/11/programming-and-data-structure.html
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand the basic concepts of Oop in C++, Class, Overloading, Inheritance and Polymorphism.
CO2 : Interpret the basics of Java, Interface, Packages, String handling and Exception handling.
CO3 : Apply the concepts of multithreading in different applications, I/O Streams.
CO4 : Construct programs using the concepts of Applet in AWT Control, Event handling, Swing concepts and
Java database connectivity.
OOP WITH C++ 12
An Overview of C++ - Advantageof OOP - Object and Class - Arrays - Pointers - Function Overloading – Operator
Overloading - Constructors - Inheritance - Method Overriding - Abstract class - Encapsulation - Runtime Polymorphism-
Templates.
BASICS OF JAVA, STRING HANDLING, INPUT AND OUTPUT 12
History and Features of Java - JDK, JRE and JVM - Variable and Data Types - Keywords and Operators - Java Array -Java
inheritance - Interfaces and Packages - String: String Comparison - String Concatenation - Substring - String Bufferclass
- File I/O Stream - ByteArray I/O Stream - Sequence I/O Stream - Buffered I/O Stream - File Writer and Reader - DataI/O
Stream.
MULTITHREADING AND EXCEPTION HANDLING 8
Multithreading - Life Cycle of a Thread - Creating Thread - Thread Priority - Thread Synchronization - Inter-thread
Communication - Exception Handling: Try and Catch Block - Multiple Catch Block - Nested try - Finally block –Throw and
Throws keyword.
APPLET, AWT, SWING AND JDBC 13
Applet Life Cycle - Graphics in Applet - Displaying image in Applet - Jappletclass - Parameter in Applet and AWT
Controls - Event Handling - Event classes and Listener Interfaces - Adapter classes - Basics of Swing: Jbutton class -
JradioButton - JtextAreaclass - LayoutManagers: BorderLayout - GridLayout - FlowLayout - BoxLayout - CardLayout -
JDBC: JDBC Drivers - Steps to Connect to the database - Statements.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Herbert Schildt, “C++: The Complete Reference”, 5th Edition, Tata McGraw- Hill, 2012.
2. Herbert Schildt, “The Complete Reference Java”, 9th Edition, Tata McGraw- Hill, 2016.
REFERENCES
1. E. Balaguruswamy, “Object Oriented Programming with C++”, 6th Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2013
2. E. Balaguruswamy, “Programming with Java”, 4th Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2007
3. Deitel H M and Deitel P J, “JAVA - How to Program”, 7th Edition, Prentice Hall of India / Pearson Education,
2007.
4. Steven Holzner et al, “Java 2 Programming”, Dream Tech Press, 2009.
5. Bernard Van Haecke, “JDBC 3 Java Database Connectivity”, Wiley-DreamTech Press India Pvt. Ltd., Edition,
2002.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, student will be able to
CO1 : Classify data types and cite their significance.
CO2 : Choose appropriate decision–making and looping constructs in programming.
CO3 : Apply modularization techniques for problem solving through programming.
CO4 : Administer input/output processing by manipulating files.
INTRODUCTION TO COMPUTING 6
Fundamentals of Computing – Historical perspective – Early computers – Computing machine – Problems – Pseudocode
and flowcharts – Memory – Number System Representation and Conversion - Variables – Values – Instructions –
Programs.
INTRODUCTION TO C 14
The language of C – Phases of developing a running computer program in C – Data types – Constants – Variables –
Expressions – Operators and Operator precedence in C – Statements – Declarations – Input/Output Statements – Compound
Statements – Selection Statements – Conditions – Logical Operators – Repetitive statements – While construct – Do-
while Construct – For construct - Arrays – Multidimensional Arrays and Matrices.
MODULAR PROGRAMMING 6
Functions: Prototype declaration – Function definition – Function call: Passing arguments to a function – Call by value
– Call by reference – Scope of variable names – Recursive function calls.
MORE DATA TYPES IN C 19
Pointers: Pointer variables – Declaring and dereferencing pointer variables – Pointer Arithmetic – Examples – Accessing
arrays through pointers – Pointer types – Pointers and strings – String operations in C – Structures in C – Motivation –
Examples – Declaration and use – Operations on structures – Passing structures as function arguments – Type defining
structures – Self–referential structures – File input/output in C – Streams – Input/output and error streams – Opening,
closing and reading from files – Programming for command line arguments.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Deitel H.M., and Deitel P.J., “C: How to program”, 7th Edition, Pearson Education, 2010.
2. Kernighan and Ritchie, “The C Programming Language”, 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall, 1988.
REFERENCES
1. Dromey R.G., “How to Solve It by Computer”, Pearson, 1982
2. Bradley A.R., “Programming for Engineers”, Springer, 2011
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106105085/4
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106104128/
3. http://www.nptelvideos.in/2012/11/programming-and-data-structure.html
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate various linear and non-linear data structures.
CO2 : Make use of Sorting Techniques in the design of software development.
CO3 : Choose appropriate searching and indexing techniques for better application development.
REFERENCES
1. Ellis Horowitz and Sartaj Sahni, "Fundamentals of Data Structures", 2nd Edition, GalgotiaBook Source, Gurgaon,
1976
2. Aho AV., Hopcroft J.E., and Ullman J.D., "Data Structures and Algorithms", 1st Edition, Pearson Education, 2009
3. Gilberg R.F., Forouzan B.A., "Data Structures", 2nd Edition, Publisher Thomson India Edition, 2005.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106105085/
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106103069/
3. https://itunes.apple.com/us/course/data-structures/id546468797
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Use the basic commands and features of the drafting software to create geometric models.
CO2 : Construct orthographic views from the geometric models.
CO3 : Explain the fundamentals of electric circuit's signals using Simulation software.
CO4 : Experiment with open source simulation software's for code generation from flowcharts, pseudo code
and Visual patterns.
AUTOCAD
1. Study of capabilities of Drafting and Modeling software - Coordinate systems (absolute, relative, polar) - Creation
of simple geometrical entities.
2. Drawing of a Title Block with necessary text and projection symbol.
3. Drawing of front view and top view of simple solids like prism, pyramid, cylinder, and cone dimensioning.
MATLAB
1. Matrices and Vectors
2. Arithmetic Operators
3. Functions and Graphics
a. Elementary Functions
b. Linear Algebra
c. Differential Equations
d. Fourier Transformations
4. Generation of basic signals
5. Filtering of a signal
6. Simulink
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, student will be able to
CO1 : Interpret and apply the Commands in Linux.
CO2 : Select appropriate Decision making and Looping constructs in Programming.
CO3 : Construct Programs using Derived Data Type.
CO4 : Apply Modularization Techniques for problem solving through Programming.
CO5 : Summarize Input / Output processing by manipulating Files.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. I/O Statements, Operators and Expressions.
2. Decision making and Looping.
3. Functions and Recursion.
4. Pointers.
5. Arrays.
6. String Manipulation.
7. Structures and Union
8. Files.
9. Command Line Arguments
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Develop programs using concepts of Object Oriented Programming.
CO2 : Develop programs using Control structures and Inheritance.
CO3 : Develop various java applications and GUI programming concepts.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Simple programs in C++ basic concepts
2. Simple programs in Java to demonstrate the usage of Control structures.
3. Real time application programs to illustrate the use of Inheritance.
4. Demonstration of Exception handling.
5. Simple real time application programs to illustrate the use of Packages.
6. Simple real time application programs to illustrate the use of Multi Threads.
7. Demonstration of the use of Text fields, Buttons, Scrollbar, Choice, List and Check box using Swing Technology
8. Demonstration of the use of various Layouts like Flow Layout, Border Layout, Grid layout, Gridbag layout and
card layout
·• Creation of applets incorporating the following features:
·• Color palette creation with matrix of buttons.
·• Setting of background and foreground of the control text area by selecting a color from colorpalette.
·• Selection of foreground or background use check box control as radio buttons.
·• Setting of background images.
9. Creation of Menu and Menu Bar
10. Illustration of File operations.
11. Programs using JDBC Connectivity.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Interpret and apply the commands in Linux.
CO2 : Choose appropriate decision-making and looping constructs in programming.
CO3 : Develop programs using derived data type.
CO4 : Apply modularization techniques for problem solving through programming.
CO5 : Administer input/output processing by manipulating files.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. I/O Statements, Operators and Expressions.
2. Decision making and Looping.
3. Functions and Recursion.
4. Pointers.
5. Arrays.
6. String Manipulation.
7. Structures and Union.
8. Files.
9. Command Line Arguments.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Experiment with the simulation of Arrays, Stack, Queues and Lists.
CO2 : Interpret the implementation of Binary Trees and Hashing.
CO3 : Simulate Graph representations and its traversals.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Implementation of Sorting and Searching using Array ADT
· Insertion Sort
· Quick Sort
· Merge Sort
· Linear and Binary Search
2. Implementation of the following ADTs
· List
· Stack
· Queue
· Tree
3. Implementation of hashing techniques
· Separate Chaining
· Open Addressing
· Extensible Hashing
4. Implementation of Graph Traversals
· Breadth First Search
· Depth First Search
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Interpret the evolution and services of IT.
CO2 : Identify the concepts of web evolution and computing techniques.
CO3 : Analyze the cutting edge applications and trends in mobile technology.
CO4 : Show the technologies behind anytime/anywhere connectivity and smart decision making using analytics.
CO5 : Infer the concepts of analytics.
CO6 : Identify recent trends and security issues in IT.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://www.deepdotweb.com/marketplace-directory/listing/evolution-marketplace
2. www.iot-now.com/tag/url
3. www.informationvine.com/Answers
4. www.gartner.com
5. https://www.nap.edu/read/11896/chapter/5
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the commands in LINUX.
CO2 : Apply various constructs for a given problem.
CO3 : Analyze and use functions and pointers to solve the given problems.
CO4 : Solve the problems using arrays and structures.
CO5 : Apply file concept to solve the problems.
CO6 : Illustrate about Runtime Environment.
Introduction to Linux Operating System - Basic Commands of Linux -Structure of C Program - Data types, Operators
and Expressions - Formatted Input and Output Statements - Control Flow Statements - Functions and Program Structure
- Recursion Functions - Pointers - Arrays and Strings - Structures - Unions - Standard Input and Output - File Access -
Runtime Environment
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Brian W. Kernighan and Dennis M. Ritchie,"The C Programming Language", 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall of India,
2012.
2. Paul L. Anderson and Gail C. Anderson, "Advanced C Tips and Techniques", Howard Wams & Company Hayden
Books, 2nd Edition, PHI, 2012.
3. Richard Stones, NeilMathew, "Beginning Linux Programming", 4th Edition, Wiley India Pvt.Ltd, 2008.
REFERENCES
1. Yashwant Kanetkar, "Let us C", 13th Edition, BPB publishers, 2014.
2. Herbert Schildt, "C: The Complete Reference", 4th Edition, Osborne/McGraw-Hill, 2000.
3. David Hasking, "C Programming in Linux", 1st Edition, Ventus Publishing APs, 2009.
4. Mark G.Sobell, "A Practical guide to Linux Commands, Editor and Shell programming", 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall
PTR Publication, 2010.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106104074/
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106104128//
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the basics of Python environment, data types and operations.
CO2 : Develop simple Python scripts using control statements and data types.
CO3 : Construct object oriented programs using functions.
CO4 : Outline the concepts of inheritance and polymorphism.
CO5 : Apply overloading concepts in various applications.
CO6 : Outline the concept of handling the exception through handlers.
INTRODUCTION TO PYTHON 15
Python Features - Python Interpreter - Program Execution - The Interactive Prompt - Python Data Types and Operations:
Python Object Types, Numeric Types - String - Lists and Dictionaries - Tuples- Files - Statements and Syntax -Python
Statements - While and For Loops - Iterations and Comprehensions - Simple Programs using Python Data Types and
Statements.
OBJECT ORIENTED CONCEPTS IN PYTHON 15
Introduction - Objects and Classes - Creating Python Classes - Inheritance: Basic Inheritance, Multiple Inheritance -
Polymorphism-Abstract Base Classes-Functions - Python Built - In Functions-def Statements -def Executes at Runtime -
Definitions and Calls - Intersecting Sequences -Scopes and Nested Functions -Argument - Passing Basics.
OVERLOADING AND EXCEPTIONS 15
Operator Overloading - The Basics- Indexing and Slicing- Index Iteration-Iterable Objects- Membership- Attribute Access-
Object Destruction- Exceptions - Exception Basics-Catching Exceptions- Raising Exceptions- UserDefined Exceptions-
The try/except/else Statement- The try/finally Statement- Unified try/except/finally- The Raise Statement- Exception
Objects- Nesting Exception.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Dusty Phillips, "Python 3 - Object Oriented Programming", 2nd Edition, Packet Publishing Ltd. 2015.
2. Mark Lutz, "Learning Python", 5th Edition, O'Reilly Publishing, 2013.
REFERENCES
1. Joshua Welsh, "Python for Beginners: The Ultimate Guide to Python Programming; Learn Python FAST!",
CreateSpace Independent Publishing Platform, 2016.
2. Leonardo Gorman, "Python for Beginners: A Simple and Concise Guide to Learn Coding Fast", CreateSpace
Independent Publishing Platform, 1st edition, 2016.
3. Martin Laredo, "Python Programming For Beginners: Crash Course", CreateSpace Independent Publishing Platform,
2016.
WEB REFERENCES
1. nptel.ac.in/courses/117106113/34
2. python-course.eu/course.php
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Identify the basic concepts of Java language.
CO2 : Construct Java programs for interface, inheritance, packages and multithreading.
CO3 : Construct GUI applications using Applet, AWT and Swing.
CO4 : Develop Java applications using JDBC.
CO5 : Develop Java applications using collection framework classes and I/O classes.
CO6 : Develop Java application using files and client/server concepts.
REFERENCES
1. Y.Daniel Liang, "Introduction to Java Programming: Brief Version", 10th Edition, Pearson, 2014.
2. Elliote Harold Rusty, "Java Network Programming", 4th Edition, O'Reilly Media, 2013.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106105084/28
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106105084/29
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Analyze and apply appropriate decision-making and looping constructs in C programs.
CO2 : Develop programs using derived data types & user defined data types and files.
CO3 : Implement basic commands of Linux in C language.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Study of basic commands of Linux.
2. I/O Statements, Operators and Expressions.
3. Decision Making and Looping.
4. Functions and Recursion.
5. Pointers.
6. Arrays.
7. String Manipulation.
8. Emulate basic commands of Linux using C.
9. Structures and Union.
10. Files.
11. Command line arguments.
WEB REFERENCE
1. http://cse02-iiith.vlabs.ac.in/(Computer programming lab)
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Develop Python script using data structures, control statements and functions.
CO2 : Create Python script using classes, objects and inheritance.
CO3 : Apply the concept of exception handling and overloading.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Shell Scripting, GUI Environment.
2. Python Programming Basics.
3. Lists, Dictionaries, Tuples, Range, Strings.
4. Control Statements - if, while, for.
5. Built-In Functions.
6. Objects, Classes, Constructors and Destructors.
7. Function and Modules.
8. Overloading.
9. Inheritance.
10. Polymorphism.
11. Exception handling.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Construct simple Java programs using control structures, classes, methods, arrays, string, interface,
inheritance, packages and multithreading; Test control structures using JUnit.
CO2 : Use Applet, AWT and Swing components to construct interactive Java applications.
CO3 : Develop Java application using database connectivity, collection framework classes and apply the
concepts of socket programming to create client/server applications.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Control Structures and test them using JUnit.
2. Classes and Methods.
3. Arrays and String.
4. Exception handling.
5. Inheritance.
6. Interfaces.
7. Packages.
8. Multithreading.
9. Applet and AWT.
10. Database connectivity using JDBC.
11. Java Collection Framework.
12. Client/Server applications using TCP/IP and UDP.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106105084/28
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106105084/29
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course,students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the air transport commercial practices and uses.
CO2 : Explain themanagement perspectives.
CO3 : Explain about the economical strategy of airline industry.
CO4 : Describe the scheduling procedures based on various factors.
AVIATION INDUSTRY & AIRLINE MANAGEMENT 15
Development of air transportation - Comparison with other modes of transport - Role of IATA and ICAO - The general
aviation industry airline - Factors affecting general aviation - uses of aircraft - Airport: Airline management and Organization
- Levels of management, functions of management, Principles of Organization planning the Organization - Chart, Staff
departments and line departments.
AIRLINE ECONOMICS 15
Forecasting: purposes, methods - Airline pricing: pricing and demand, types of passenger fares, pricing process, airline
costs, pricing and output determination - Aircraft selection process: Technical aspects, Fleet rationalization, Fleet
commonality, Factors affecting choice of fleet, Fleet planning process.
PRINCIPLES OF AIRLINES SCHEDULING 15
Equipment maintenance - Flight operations and crew scheduling - Ground operations and facility limitations - Equipments
and types of schedule - Hub & spoke scheduling - Aircraft reliability - Maintenance schedule and its determination -
Aircraft scheduling with reference to engineering.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. L Alexander T Wells,"Air Transportation", 7th Edition,Wadsworth Publishing Company, 2011.
2. Fedric J.H. "Airport Management",Digitized Edition,Richard D. Irwing,2007.
REFERENCES
1. Gene Kropf "Airline Procedures", Himalayan Book house, 1949.
2. Wilson & Bryon "Air Transportation". Himalayan Book house , 2006.
3. Philip Locklin D "Economics of Transportation", Richard D. Irwing, 1972.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the basic necessity of air traffic control services and its operations.
CO2 : Illustrate the functions of radar and various air traffic service responsibilities.
CO3 : Interpret the aerodrome design requirements in runway markings and lighting systems.
CO4 : Describe the significance of visual aids used in airports.
BASIC CONCEPTS 15
Objectives of ATS - Parts of ATC service- VFR and IFR operations - Classification of ATS air spaces in India and overseas
airport- Altimeter setting procedures- Varies kinds of separation- Vertical lateral and longitudinal separations based on
time / distance - RNAV and RNP -ATC clearances -Flight plans - Position report.
ATC SERVICES 15
Radar service -Identification procedures using primary/secondary radar -Use of radar in area and approach control
services - Assurance control and coordination between radar / non radar control - Emergency service - Flight information
and advisory service -Alerting service - Co-ordination and emergency procedures - Rules of the air.
AERODROME PHYSICAL DATA AND NAVIGATION SERVICES 15
Aerodrome data-Aerodrome reference code - Aerodrome reference point - Aerodrome elevation - Aerodrome reference
temperature - Instrument runway physical Characteristics: length of primary and secondary runway- Visual aids for
navigation-Wind direction indicator - Landing direction indicator- Various markings-general requirements -Various lighting
systems - Aerodrome beacon, Identification beacon - VASI and PAPI - Visual aids for denoting obstacles.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Nolan M S, "Fundamentals of Air Traffic Control" 5th Edition, CENGAGE Learning, 2010.
2. DGCA, "Aircraft Manual" (India) Volume I & II", The Sterling book house, 2016.
REFERENCES
1. AAI, "Manual of air traffic services",4th Edition, Part-I, 2015.
2. ICAO 9157 Document, "Aerodrome Design Manual ",1st Edition,Part-VI, 2016.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of thecourse, students will be able to
CO1 : Recognize the use of various types of permanent fastening and sheet metal maintenance and repair.
CO2 : Explain the primary defects to be noted and procedure to rectify the same.
CO3 : Describe the problems in aircraft systems and maintenance.
CO4 : Describe the safety precautions and practices.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Kroes, Watkins and Delp, "Aircraft Maintenance and Repair" 3rd Edition, McGraw-Hill, 1992.
2. Harry A Kinnison, "Aviation Maintenance Management, 2nd Edition, McGraw-Hill,2004.
REFERENCES
1. Larry Reithmeir, "Aircraft Repair Manual", Palamar Books, 1992.
2. Brimm D.J. Bogges H.E, "Aircraft Maintenance", Pitman Publications, 1940.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the nutritional value of the food intake.
CO2 : Familiar with recorders used in hospitals.
CO3 : Differentiate diagnostic & therapeutic devices.
CO4 : Explain the technology behind the working of the medical devices.
INTRODUCTION TO HEALTH 15
Introduction to health science. Carbohydrates, Vitamins, Minerals, Proteins. Blood and Body Fluids. Maintaining acid
base balance. Major food adulterants - Effects on health - Significance. Adverse effects of tobacco and alcohol consumption.
Types and Origin of Biosignals. Range of values of life saving parameters. Cause and effects - Blood Pressure, cardiac
failure, diabetes. Increase of cholesterol level. Respiratory problems. Cancer. Viral, bacterial, fungal infections.
BASIC BIOMEDICAL MEASURING DEVICES 15
Measurement of blood pressure-Direct & Indirect methods. Cardiac output, cardiac rate, heart sound. Respiratory rate,
Lung volumes and capacities.Temperature sensors. Pulse Oximeters. Blood cell counters. Blood glucose monitors-Multi
Para monitor, Concept of Biotelemetry. Smart Home Technologies.
BIOMEDICAL IMAGING AND THERAPEUTIC DEVICES 15
X-Ray, CT, MRI, Ultrasound Scanning-Principle, Image Interpretation, Limitations. Hemodialysis:principle,
dialyzingmembrane, instrumentation. Defibrillators, pacemakers.Biomaterials: stent, heart valves, concept of targeted
drug delivery.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Joseph J.carr and John M. Brown, "Introduction to Biomedical Equipment Technology", John Wiley &Sons, 1997.
2. Khandpur R.S, "Handbook of Biomedical Instrumentation", 3rd edition,Tata McGraw-Hill, 2014.
3. Carolyn D. Berdanier, Johanna T. Dwyer, David Heber. "Handbook of Nutrition and Food", 3rd Edition, CRC Press,
2013.
REFERENCES
1. John G. Webster, "Medical Instrumentation Application and Design", John Wiley &Sons, 1998.
2. Leslie Cromwell, Fred J.Weibell, Erich A. Pfeiffer, "Bio-Medical Instrumentation and Measurements", 2nd Edition,
Pearson Education, 2005.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Classify materials used for implant applications
CO2 : Indicate their structure property relationships and tissue response to the materials used.
CO3 : Describe the properties of metallic alloys and ceramic materials, polymer, composite materials as suitable
for biomedical applications.
CO4 : Categorize the materials for soft and hard tissue replacements.
CO5 : Describe the concepts of tissue engineering.
REFERENCES
1. Park J.B., Bronzino.D.J, "Biomaterials: Principles and applications", CRC Press, 2002.
2. Qizhi Chen George Thouas, "Biomaterials - A basic introduction", CRC Press, 2012.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Demonstrate understanding of the underlying technology principles of a telemedicine system (TMS).
CO2 : Explain the architecture of telemedicine systems.
CO3 : Demonstrate awareness of the main approaches to providing remote solutions to deliver patient care.
CO4 : Evaluate the process and business considerations when defining and implementing a TMS in the remote
medical care context.
INTRODUCTION TO TELEMEDICINE 9
Definitions of telemedicine - History of telemedicine - Organs and forms of telemedicine - Evolutionand benefits of
telemedicine - Impactof telemedicine on healthcare delivery - Issuesin telemedicine - Typeof digital information (audio,
video, still images, text and data).
ARCHITECTURE OF TELEMEDICINE SYSTEMS 9
Telemedicine as a system - Criticalsub-systems of telemedicine - Regulatory sub-system - Optionalsub-system of
telemedicine - Telecommunicationsapproach - Elementsof telecommunications systems - POTS, Wireless System.
Modalities of telecommunications systems (e-health) - Wireless Communication and Satellite Communications - VSAT
based dedicated videoconferencing system - Mobileapplications of telemedicine (m-health).
COMPUTER AND NETWORKING TECHNOLOGIES FOR TELEMEDICINE 9
Internet based telemedicine practices - WWW approach - Applied web browser for healthcare practice - PCbased audio
and video conferencing. Types of network topologies - LAN, WAN and Body Sensor - Personal Area Network (Adhoc
network) - 3 tier architecture model.
DATA AND INFORMATION STANDARDS IN TELEMEDICINE 9
Role of standards in healthcare - HealthLevel Seven (HL7) - Digital Imaging and Communication in Medicine (DICOM),
Logical Observation Identifiers Names and Codes (LOINC), Systematized Nomenclature of Medicine - Clinical Terms
(SNOMED). Adoption of Information Systems. Standards in Healthcare - Ethicaland legal aspects of telemedicine,
confidentiality of data, and the law, patient rights and consent-Security /access to medical records, reimbursements.
Values to the patient, clinician, and health care organization training, cost, administration, challenges to successful
implementation - Healthcare Management Information Systems.
CLINICAL AND TECHNICAL ASPECTS OF TELEMEDICINE 9
Applications of telemedicine - Perspectives of clinicians - Telemedicine and diagnostic imaging (teleradiology) - Telemedicine
and monitoring of physiological parameters (telehealth) - Telemedicine and surgery (telesurgery). Diffusion of IT Innovations
in Healthcare - Healthcare Status, Delivery Systems & Issues in Developing Countries like India - Future of Healthcare -
Challenges and Future Trends including Opportunities for rural and emergency /disaster healthcare projects.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Olga Ferrer Roca, M.Sosa Iudicissa (editors), "Hand Book of Telemedicine", IOS Press, 2002.
2. Norris A.C, "Essentials of Telemedicine and Telecare", John Wiley & Sons, 2002.
REFERENCES
1. Wootton R, Craig J, Patterson V, "Introduction to Telemedicine", Royal Society of Medicine Press Ltd, 2ndEdition,
2006.
2. Maheu M.M., Whitten. P. Allen, "E-Health, Telehealth, and Telemedicine", Jossy-Bass, 2001.
3. Latifi R, "Current Principles and Practices of Telemedicine and e-Health", IOHS Press, 2008.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of this course, students will be able to
CO 1 : Illustrate the importance of ozone in environment and explain the effects of green house gases in the
atmosphere.
CO 2 : Summarize the components of atmosphere, concepts of lapse rate and behaviour of atmosphere.
CO 3 : Assess the impacts of climate change on various sectors and recall the initiatives taken, to suppress the
climate change.
CO 4 : Solve the problem of global warming with the new technologies available, in their respective domains.
REFERENCES
1. J.M. Wallace and P.V. Hobbs,"Atmospheric Science", Elsevier / Academic Press 2006.
2. Jan C. van Dam, "Impacts of Climate Change and Climate Variability on Hydrological Regimes", Cambridge University
Press, 2003.
WEB REFERENCE
http://www.nptelvideos.com/lecture.php?id=850
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of this course, students will be able to
CO 1 : Distinguish between Hazard, Risk, Vulnerability and Disaster; explain disaster management cycle.
CO 2 : Identify the causes and effects of Natural and Manmade disaster.
CO 3 : Predict the amount of disaster that can occur and give solution after the occurrence of disaster.
CO 4 : Explain the techniques through which disaster can be mitigated.
INTRODUCTION TO DISASTER 9
Meaning, Nature, Importance of Hazard, Risk, Vulnerability and Disaster-Dimensions & Scope of Disaster Management
- India's Key Hazards -Vulnerabilities - National disaster management framework - Disaster Management Cycle.
NATURAL DISASTER 9
Natural Disasters- Meaning and nature of natural disaster: Floods, drought, cyclone, earthquakes, landslides, avalanches,
volcanic eruptions, Heat and cold waves, their types and effects- Climatic change: global warming, Sea level rise, ozone
depletion.
ANTHROPOGENIC DISASTER 9
Man Made Disasters: Nuclear disasters, chemical disasters, biological disasters, building fire, coal fire, forest fire, oil fire,
air pollution, water pollution, deforestation and industrial waste water pollution.
DISASTER MANAGEMENT 10
Pre- disaster stage (preparedness) - Preparing hazard zonation maps, Predictability/ forecasting and warning - Preparing
disaster preparedness plan -Land use zoning - Preparedness through Information, education - Emergency Stage - Rescue
training for search & operation - Immediate relief - Assessment surveys - Post Disaster stage - Rehabilitation - Social
Aspect - Economic Aspect and Environmental Aspect.
DISASTER MITIGATION 8
Meteorological observatory - Seismological observatory - Hydrology Laboratory and Industrial Safety inspectorate -
Technology in Disaster Management -Emergency Management Systems (EMS) in the Disaster Management Cycle -
Remote Sensing and Geographic Information Systems (GIS) in Disaster Management.
Total Hours: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Sharma.S.R, "Disaster management", A P H Publishers, 2011
2. VenuGopalRao.K, "Geoinformatics for Disaster Management", Manglam Publishers and Distributors, 2010.
REFERENCES
1. Singh.R.B, "Natural Hazards and Disaster Management: Vulnerability andMitigation", Rawat Publications, 2006.
2. Gupta.H.K, "Disaster Management", University Press, 2003.
3. Gupta.M.C, "Manuals on Natural Disaster management in India", National Centre for Disaster Management, IIPA,
New Delhi, 2001.
WEB REFERENCE
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/122102006/mod2/4.htm
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of this course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the sources, effects & remedies of water and air pollution.
CO2 : Summarize the concepts of air quality sampling and monitoring.
CO3 : Describe the concepts of Noise pollution and their standards.
CO4 : Categorize the different types of solid waste and its disposal techniques.
CO5 : Explain the effects of E-waste and the processing technologies of E-waste.
REFERENCE
Birdie G.S and Birdie J.S., "Water Supply and Sanitary Engineering", 9th Edition, Dhanpat Rai and Sons, 2011.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105106119/
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105102089/8
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of this course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the basic concepts and components of GIS.
CO2 : Illustrate techniques used for storage of spatial data and data compression.
CO3 : Explain the techniques of data input and topology.
CO4 : Summarize the concepts of spatial data quality and data standards.
CO5 : Outline the practices used for input, management and output of spatial data.
FUNDAMENTALS OF GIS 9
Introduction to GIS - Basic spatial concepts - Coordinate Systems -GIS and Information Systems - Definitions - History of
GIS - Components of GIS: Hardware, Software, Data, People, Methods - Proprietary and open source Software - Types of
data - Spatial, Attribute data- Types of attributes - Scales/ levels of measurements.
SPATIAL DATA MODELS 9
Database Structures - Relational, Object Oriented - Entities - ER diagram - Data models - Conceptual, logical and physical
models - Spatial data models - Raster Data Structures - Raster Data Compression - Vector Data Structures - Raster vs
Vector Models- TIN and GRID data models.
DATA INPUT AND TOPOLOGY 9
Scanner - Raster Data Input - Raster Data File Formats - Georeferencing - Vector Data Input -Digitiser - Datum Projection
and reprojection -Coordinate Transformation - Topology - Adjacency, connectivity and containment - Topological
Consistency - Non topological file formats -Attribute Data linking - Linking External Databases - GPS Data Integration.
DATA QUALITY AND STANDARDS 9
Data quality - Basic aspects - completeness, logical consistency, positional accuracy, temporal accuracy, thematic
accuracy and lineage - Metadata - GIS Standards - Interoperability - OGC - Spatial Data Infrastructure.
DATA MANAGEMENT AND OUTPUT 9
Import/Export - Data Management functions- Raster to Vector and Vector to Raster Conversion - Data Output - Map
Compilation - Chart/Graphs - Multimedia - Enterprise vs. Desktop GIS- Distributed GIS-Demonstration for Generation of
Map using QGIS.
Total Hours: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Kang-Tsung Chang, Introduction to Geographic Information Systems, 2nd Edition, Mc-Graw Hill Publishing, 2011.
2. Ian Heywood, Sarah Cornelius, Steve Carver, Srinivasa Raju, -An Introduction Geographical Information Systems,
2nd Edition, Pearson Education, 2007.
REFERENCE
C.P. Lo Albert K.W. Yeung, Concepts and Techniques of Geographic Information Systems, Prentice-Hall India
Publishers, 2006.
WEB REFERENCE
http://www.nptelvideos.in/2012/11/modern-surveying-techniques.html
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand the basic functionalities of Data Mining Techniques.
CO2 : Apply Data Analytics algorithms to the analysis of Business problems.
CO3 : Apply Algorithms to build Machine Intelligence.
CO4 : Describe Big Data Analytics Tools.
CO5 : Use statistical methods and Visualization to quickly explore Data.
DATA MINING 9
Relation To Statistics - Databases - Data Mining Functionalities - Steps in Data Mining Process - Architecture of Typical
Data Mining Systems - Classification Of Data Mining Systems - Overview Of Data Mining Techniques.
PREDICTIVE MODELING 12
Mining Association Rules in Large Databases - Classification and Prediction: Issues Regarding Classification and Prediction
- Classification by Decision Tree Induction - Bayesian Classification - Other Classification Methods -Prediction - Clusters
Analysis: Types Of Data In Cluster Analysis - Categorization Of Major Clustering Methods.
OVERVIEW OF BIG DATA ANALYTICS 12
Introduction to Big Data - Big Data Analytics Applications - Time Series Analysis - Introduction to Map Reduce / Hadoop
TECHNOLOGIES AND TOOLS FOR DATA ANALYTICS 12
Data visualization techniques using R Tool: Histograms - Box plots - Scatter plots - Time series - Spatial Data - Spark -
Introduction to Exploratory Data Mining - Association Rule Mining-Clustering and Classification Techniques using
WEKA Tool
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Jiawei Han, Micheline Kamber, "Data Mining: Concepts and Techniques", Morgan Kaufmann Publishers, 2011
2. Cathy O'Neil and Rachel Schutt,"Doing Data Science, Straight Talk from the Frontline", O'Reilly, 2014.
REFERENCES
1. AnandRajaraman and Jeffrey David Ullman, "Mining of Massive Datasets", Cambridge University Press, 2011.
2. Joel Grus, "Data Science from Scratch", Copyright c 2015
3. Tom White, "Hadoop: The Definitive Guide", OReilly Media, 4thEdition, 2015.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Interpret Java programs using Object Oriented Concepts.
CO2 : Design Simple Java Applications involving GUI and Threading.
CO3 : Develop Network based Java Programs with Java Database Connectivity.
INTRODUCTION TO JAVA 9
Object Oriented Language: Overview - JAVA Environment - Comparing JAVA, C and C++ - Keywords and Operators -
Identifiers - Literal - Expressions - Control Statements - Arrays and Strings - Command Line Arguments - Data Members
- Methods - Overloading Constructors - Class Assignment - This - Static members and methods - Final - Super keyword
- Exception Handling.
INHERITANCE, PACKAGES AND THREADS 9
Abstract Classes - Inheritance: Types - Single - Multilevel - Hierarchical - Interfaces: Defining - Implementing - Packages:
Introduction - Importing packages - Implementation - Multithreaded Programming: Thread model - Creating a Thread -
Thread Priority - Synchronization - Inter Thread Communication.
AWT AND APPLET 9
HTML: Introduction - Webpage Design - Basic Tags - Simple Programs - Applet: Lifecycle - Simple Applet Display - Labels
- Text fields - Buttons - Combo Boxes - Passing Parameters to Applet - AWT: Windows Fundamentals - AWT Controls -
Event Handling: Sources of Events - Event Delegation Model - Event Classes - Event Listener Interfaces - AWT Classes
- Working with Graphics - Working with Color - Working with Font - Layout Managers - Menu Bars and Menus.
JAVA COLLECTION FRAMEWORK AND DATABASE CONNECTIVITY 9
Java Collection Framework: Vector - List - TreeSet - HashSet - Enumeration - Autoboxing - Annotations - JDBC: Architecture
- JDBC Connectivity - Drivers - Setting up a Database - Setting up Tables - Establishing Connection - Getting Data From
a Table - Select - Update - Record Sets - Prepared Statements - Callable Statements.
INPUT/OUTPUT STREAMS AND NETWORKING BASICS
9
Input Output: I/O Classes and Interfaces - The Character Stream - BufferedReader and BufferedWriter - Serialization - Files
- Java and Net: Stream Classes - Socket - InetAddress - URL Connection - TCP/IP Sockets - Datagrams - Simple Client/
Server Program.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOK
Herbert Schildt, "The Complete Reference Java", 7th Edition, Tata McGraw- Hill, 2011.
REFERENCE
E. Balaguruswamy,"Programming with Java", 4th Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2007.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Review the Basic Functional Units, Addressing modes and Machine Instructions of a Computer.
CO2 : Analyze the Memory types used in Systems, working of External Devices and Standard I/O Interfaces.
CO3 : Infer the Basic Processing Unit and Execution of Instructions.
BASIC STRUCTURE OF COMPUTERS 9
Computer Types - Functional Units - Basic Operational Concepts - Bus Structures - Performance - Processor Clock - Basic
Performance Equation - Clock Rate - Performance Measurement.
MACHINE INSTRUCTIONS AND PROGRAMS 9
Memory Location and Addresses - Memory Operations - Instructions and Instruction Sequencing - Addressing Modes
- Assembly Language - Basic Input and Output Operations - Stacks and Queues - Subroutines - Additional Instructions
- Encoding of Machine Instructions.
INPUT/OUTPUT ORGANIZATION 9
Accessing I/O Devices - Interrupts - Interrupt Hardware - Enabling and Disabling Interrupts - Handling Multiple Devices
- Controlling Device Requests - Exceptions - Direct Memory Access - Buses - Interface Circuits - Standard I/O Interfaces
- PCI Bus, SCSI Bus and USB.
MEMORY SYSTEM 9
Basic Concepts - Semiconductor RAM Memories - Read Only Memories - Speed, Size and Cost - Cache Memories:
Mapping Functions - Replacement Algorithms - Performance Considerations - Virtual Memories - Secondary Storage
BASIC PROCESSING UNIT 9
Fundamental Concepts - Execution of a Complete Instruction - Multiple Bus Organization - Hard-Wired Control -
Microprogrammed Control.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Carl Hamacher, Zvonko Vranesic and Safwat Zaky, "Computer Organization", 6th Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2011.
2. William Stallings, "Computer Organization and Architecture - Designing for Performance", 9th Edition, Pearson
Education, 2012.
REFERENCES
1. David A Patterson and John L Hennessy, "Computer Organization and Design: The Hardware Software Interface",
4th Edition, Elsevier, Reprint 2012.
2. David A Patterson and John L Hennessy, "Computer Architecture- A Quantitative Approach", 5th Edition, Elsevier,
Reprint 2012.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand and explore the basics of Computer Networks, Various Protocols and World Wide Web
Concepts.
CO2 : Describe a Network and flow of Information and further concepts of Network Security, Mobile and Ad hoc
Networks.
OVERVIEW OF THE INTERNET 15
Protocol - Layering Scenario - TCP/IP Protocol Suite: The OSI Model, Internet History Standards and Administration -
Comparison of the OSI and TCP/IP Reference Model -Physical Layer: Guided Transmission Media - Wireless Transmission
Media -Data Link Layer - Design issues - CRC Codes - Elementary Data Link Layer Protocols - Sliding Window Protocol
-Multi Access Protocols - ALOHA - CSMA - Collision Free Protocols - Ethernet - Physical Layer - Ethernet Mac Sub layer
- Data Link Layer Switching and Use of Bridges - Learning Bridges - Spanning Tree bridges, Repeaters- Hubs - Bridges -
Switches - Routers and Gateways.
NETWORK LAYER 15
Network Layer Design Issues - Store and Forward Packet Switching Connection Less and Connection Oriented networks
- Routing Algorithms - Optimality Principle - Shortest Path - Flooding - Distance Vector Routing, Control to Infinity
Problem - Hierarchical Routing - Congestion Control Algorithms - Admission Control - Internetworking: Tunneling -
Internetwork Routing - Packet fragmentation - IPv4 - IPv6 Protocol - IP addresses - CIDR - IMCP - ARP - RARP - DHCP.
TRANSPORT LAYER AND APPLICATION LAYER 15
Services provided to the Upper Layers Elements of Transport Protocol - Addressing Connection Establishment - Connection
Release - Connection Release - Crash Recovery - Internet Transport Protocols UDP - RPC - Real Time Transport Protocols
- Internet Transport Protocols - Introduction to TCP - TCP Service Model - TCP Segment Header - Connection Establishment
- TCP Connection Release - TCP Connection Management Modeling - TCP Sliding Window - TCP Congestion Control -
Future of TCP - Application Layer - Introduction - Providing services - Applications layer paradigms - Client server model
- Standard client - Server application - HTTP - FTP - Electronic mail - TELNET - DNS - SSH
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Behrouz A. Forouzan, "Data Communications and Networking", 5th Edition, TMH, 2013.
2. Andrew S Tanenbaum, "Computer Networks" 4th Edition, Pearson Education.
REFERENCES
1. S. Keshav, "An Engineering Approach to Computer Networks" 2nd Edition, Pearson Education.
2. W. A. Shay, "Understanding Communications and Networks", 3rd Edition, Cengage Learning.
3. Chwan-Hwa (John) Wu, J. David Irwin, "Introduction to Computer Networks and Cyber Security", CRC Press.
4. L. L. Peterson and B. S. Davie, "Computer Networks", 4th Edition, ELSEVIER.
5. James F. Kurose, K. W. Ross, "Computer Networking: A Top-Down Approach Featuring the Internet", 3rd Edition,
Pearson Education.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the generation and detection of analog modulation systems.
CO2 : Describe the operating principle of radio receiver and transmitter.
CO3 : Explain the generation and detection of waveform coding techniques.
CO4 : Describe the generation and detection of digital modulation techniques.
CO5 : Outline the various multiuser communication systems.
ANALOG MODULATION 17
Amplitude Modulation - Generation & Demodulation of AM waves, DSBSC waves and Coherent Detection of DSBSC
signal - Quadrature Carrier Multiplexing - Generation of SSB waves - Demodulation of SSB waves - Frequency Modulation
- Narrow & wide-band FM, Bandwidth of FM waves - Generation & Demodulation of FM waves - Noise in AM & FM
system.
RADIO TRANSMITTERS AND RECEIVERS 7
Radio Transmitter - Classification of Transmitter - AM Transmitter - FM Transmitter - Variable reactance type and phase
modulated FM Transmitter - RadioReceiver - Superheterodyne receiver - FM Receiver - Amplitude limiting.
WAVEFORM CODING AND DIGITAL MODULATION 12
Sampling theorem, Sampling of low pass and band pass signals, Generation and Detection of PAM, PWM, PPM,Pulse
code modulation, DM, ADM ,PSK, ASK and FSK.
MULTI - USERRADIO COMMUNICATION 9
Advanced Mobile Phone System (AMPS) - Global System for Mobile Communications (GSM) - Code division multiple
access (CDMA) - Cellular concept and Frequency Reuse - Channel Assignment and Hand - Overview of Multiple Access
Schemes - Satellite Communication.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Simon Haykin, "An Introduction to Analog and Digital Communication Systems", 2nd Edition, Wiley, 2012.
2. George Kennedy and Bernard Davis, "Electronics & Communication System", 5th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill, 2013.
3. Rappaport T.S, "Wireless Communications: Principles and Practice", 2nd Edition, Pearson Education, 2007.
REFERENCES:
1. B. P. Lathi, "Modern Digital and Analog Communication Systems", 4th Edition, John Wiley &Sons,2011.
2. Simon Haykin, "Communication Systems", 4th Edition,John Wiley & Sons, 2014.
3. Taub H and Schilling D.L, "Principles of Communication Systems", 4th Edition,Tata McGraw Hill, 2014.
4. B.Sklar "Digital communications: Fundamentals and Applications", 2nd Edition,Pearson Education, 2012.
WEB REFERENCES
1. nptel.ac.in/courses/106106097/
2. nptel.ac.in/courses/117106090/
3. nptel.ac.in/courses/117101051/
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the concepts of design of measurement systems.
CO2 : Examine the different types of ADCs in measurement systems.
CO3 : Discuss the different types of ADC interfaces, sensors and peripherals used with processors.
CO4 : Categorize the different control systems used in measurement.
CO5 : Describe the different analog interfacing techniques.
REFERENCES
1. Dogan Ibrahim, "Microcontroller-Based Temperature Monitoring and Control", 2nd Edition,Newnes, 2002.
2. Ramon Pallas - Areny and John G. Webster, "Sensors and Signal Conditioning", 2nd Edition,Wiley India Pvt. Ltd.,
2012.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the operation of thyristors and their applications.
CO2 : Illustrate the operation of various sensors and Actuators.
CO3 : Describe the concept of communication, vehicle motion control and integrated body.
CO4 : Exemplify the practical application on Pulse Width Modulation and power electronics converters in
conditioning the power supply.
REFERENCES
1. David Patterson and John L. Henessay, "Computer Organization and Design", 5th Edition, Morgan Kauffman, 2013.
2. Sen.P.C, "Power Electronics", 1st Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2008.
3. Robert Bosch Gambh, "Automotive Electrics Automotive Electronics Systems and Components", 5th Edition, John
Wiley & Sons Ltd., 2007.
4. James T. Humphries and Leslie P., "Industrial Electronics", 2nd Edition, Delmar Publications, 1993.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the principle and operation of solar thermal power generation systems, power conditioning
circuits and MPPT algorithms.
CO2 : Summarize the concepts and classifications of wind energy systems and Ocean Thermal Energy
Conversion.
CO3 : Instantiate the concepts, needs and functions of miscellaneous sources.
MISCELLANEOUS SOURCES 15
Principle and operation - Types - Efficiency - Effect of Polarization on Efficiency - Construction and Working of H2O2 and
Proton Exchange Membrane Fuel Cell - Introduction to Hydrogen Energy Production and Storage - Solar Pond - Magneto
Hydro Dynamic Systems - Geo-thermal Energy - Biomass Energy Conversion Technologies.
Total periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Rao. S and Paruklekar, "Energy Technology - Non Conventional, Renewable and Conventional", Khanna Publishers,
1999.
2. Mukund R. Patel, "Wind and Solar Power Systems", CRC Press LLC, 2006.
REFERENCES
1. Rai G. D, "Non Conventional Energy Sources", Khanna Publishers, 1993.
2. Garg, H. P, and Prakash J., "Solar Energy - Fundamentals and Applications", Tata McGraw Hill, 1997.
3. Charles E. Brown, "World Energy Resources", Springer, 2002.
WEB REFERENCE
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/108108078
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the concept of economics of power generation.
CO2 : Demonstrate the different types of conventional power generation schemes.
CO3 : Outline the different types of non conventional power generation systems.
REFERENCES
1. Deshpande M.V, "Elements of Electrical Power systems Design", Tata McGraw Hill Publications, 2001.
2. Peter Gevorkian, "Sustainable Energy Systems Engineering", McGraw Hill, 2007.
3. Bent Sorensen, "Renewable Energy, Elsevier", Academic Press, 2011.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/108108078
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/108102047
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the principle of domestic equipments and appliances.
CO2 : Interpret types of batteries in UPS and SMPS.
CO3 : Demonstrate and troubleshoot the problems in washing machine, microwave oven, mixer and grinder.
DOMESTIC APPLIANCES 12
Working principles and circuits of common domestic equipments and appliances - Calling Bell, Buzzer, Alarms, Electric
Iron, Heater, Light Electric Kettle, Heater / Immersion Heater, Hot Plate, Oven, Geyser, Cooking range, Mixer, Washing
machine, Motor Pump set, Concept of Neutral and Earth.
UPS/INVERTER 10
Various types of batteries used in UPS and Inverters and their maintenance - Different types of inverter, UPS, Working
principle, specifications, explanation with the help of block diagram.
SMPS 4
Block Diagram of Switch mode power supplies and their working principles.
WASHING MACHINE 9
Different types of machines, washing techniques, parts of manual, semi automatic and fully automatic machines, basic
working principle of manual, semi automatic and fully automatic machines, study the working of motors, different types of
timers, power supply circuits.
MICROWAVE OVEN 6
Different types of oven, study the various functions of Oven, Electrical wiring diagram of microwave oven, working of
Power supply - Thermostat controls.
MIXER & GRINDER 4
Various parts & functions of Mixer/Grinder, speed control circuit & automatic over load protector.
Total periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. David Herres, "Troubleshooting and Repairing Commercial Electrical Equipment", 1st Edition, McGraw-Hill Education,
2013.
2. Mark Brown,Jawahar Rawtani andDinesh Patil, "Practical Troubleshooting of Electrical Equipment and Control
Circuits", 1st Edition, Newnes Books, 2013.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On Successful Completion of course, students can able to
CO1 : Explain programming concepts of virtual instruments.
CO2 : Implement programming structure in LabVIEW
CO3 : Acquire data from hardware systems.
CO4 : Develop VI programs for specific applications.
LABVIEW ENVIRONMENT 15
Overview: Virtual Instruments, block diagram and architecture of a Virtual Instrument - Conventional Instruments versus
virtual Instruments graphical user interfaces 'G' programming, comparison with conventional programming- LabVIEW:
Key terms, front panel, block diagram, graphical programming pallets - Sub VI's, icon and connector panels - Data types -
Data flow programming - Editing, debugging and running a virtual instruments, object properties and their configuration -
Typical examples.
PROGRAMMING STRUCTURE 15
Loops, auto- indexing - Shift registers - CASE structure - State machine - Formula node - Sequence structures: flat and
stacked - Arrays and clusters functions, polymorphism, error clusters and error handling functions - Visual displays:
Waveform charts, waveform graphs, XY graphs and intensity graphs - Strings and string functions - File I/O - Attribute
modes: Local and global variables.
DATA ACQUISITION SYSTEM 10
Overview - Key terms, DAQ and other data acquisition acronyms - Connecting computer to real world - Signals - Selecting
and configuring DAQ measurement hardware - Data acquisition in LabVIEW - Understanding analog and digital I/O - NI-
DAQmx Tasks-VISA.
APPLICATIONS 5
Temperature indicator using NI- Thermocouple module, simulation of ON/OFF controller and PID controllers, image
acquisition and processing.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Jeffrey Travis, Jim Kring., "LabVIEW for Everyone", 3rd Edition, Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd., 2009.
2. Sumathi S. and Surekha P., "LabVIEW based Advanced Instrumentation Systems", 1st Edition, Springer Publications,
2007.
REFERENCES
1. Robert H. Bishop, "Learning with LabVIEW", 6th Edition, Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd., 2011.
2. Gary Johnson, Richard Jennings, "LabVIEW Graphical Programming",4th Edition, McGraw Hill Publications,2006.
3. Sanjay Gupta and Joseph John, "Virtual Instrumentation Using LabVIEW", 2nd Edition, McGraw Hill Publications,
2006.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://www.scribd.com/doc/106373645/Virtual-Instrumentation-Architecture.
2. www.vignanuniversity.org/subjectsnew/MT330.pdf.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the factors in measurement techniques for voltage, current, power and energy.
CO2 : Design a bridge circuit for the measurement of resistance and impedance.
CO3 : Describe the working of meters used for electronics applications.
CO4 : Use the display and recording devices.
REFERENCES
1. Gupta J.B, "A Course in Electronic and Electrical Measurements and Instrumentation", S.K. Kataria and Sons,
Delhi, 2012.
2. Kalsi H.S, "Electronic Instrumentation", McGraw Hill Publications, 2012.
3. Golding E.W and Widdis F.C, "Electrical Measurements and Measuring Instruments", Reem Publications Ltd.,
2011.
WEB REFERENCES
1. nptel.iitg.ernet.in/Electrical and Electronic Measurements(Video)
2. nptel.ac.in/courses/108106070/
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the components of Programmable logic controllers.
CO2 : Elaborate the hardware modules in PLC and its functioning.
CO3 : Develop PLC Ladder logic programs for sequential control applications.
CO4 : Establish communication between PLC and PC. CO5: Apply PLC in robotic and CNC machine applications.
REFERENCES
1. Gary D., " Introduction to Programmable Logic Controller", 3rd Edition, Cengage Learning India Ltd., 2016.
2. Bolton W., "Programmable Logic Controllers", 6th Edition, Elsevier Newnes Publications, 2015
3. Parr E.A., " Programmable Controllers - An engineer's guide", 3rd Edition, Elsevier Newnes Publication, 2003.
4. Johnson C.D., "Process Control Instrumentation Technology", 8th Edition, Pearson Education Ltd., 2014.
WEB REFERENCES
1. nptel.ac.in/courses/108105062/18
2. nptel.ac.in/courses/112102011/12
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the interfacing and challenges in smart sensors.
CO2 : Describe the building blocks of Internet of Things
CO3 : Know the hardware aspects of Raspberry Pi
CO4 : Perform programming and Hardware Interfacing with Raspberry Pi
SMART SENSORS 15
Primary sensors - Excitation - Amplification - Filters - Converters - Compensation- Information coding and processing -
Data communication - Standards for smart sensor interface - Automation-Interface electronic circuit for smart sensor -
Electronics interfacing overview and technology design rules - Challenges for interfacing the smart sensor
INTERNET OF THINGS 15
Characteristics of IoT- Physical design - Protocols - Logical design - Functional Blocks - Communication Models -
Wireless sensor networks - Cloud computing- Big data analytics - Communication protocols - Embedded systems -IoT
Levels and deployment templates.
RASPBERRY PI 15
Hardware aspects- Board details - Overview of available hardware resources - Operating systems- Programming the Pi :
Compilers - GCC and C programming - Python programming for Pi - Hardware interfacing: GPIO interfacing through
Python - LED, buzzer, switch and Sensors Interfacing.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Vijay Madisetti and ArshdeepBahga, "Internet of Things A Hands-On-Approach", VPT Publisher, 2014.
2. Jacob Fraden, "Handbook of Modern Sensors: Physics Designs and Applications", 4th Edition, Springer Publications,
2010.
3. Adrian Mc Ewen and Hakim Caussimally, "Designing the Internet of Things", Wiley Publications Pvt., Ltd.,
Reprint,2016.
REFERENCES
1. Adrian McEwen, "Designing the Internet of Things", 1st Edition, Wiley Publications Pvt., Ltd., 2014.
2. Wolfram Donat, "Learn Raspberry Pi Programming with Python", Technology in Action Publications, 2014.
3. Alex Bradbury and Ben Everard, "Learning Python with Raspberry Pi",Wiley Publications Pvt., Ltd., 2014.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=G4-CtKkrOmc
2. https://www.coursera.org/learn/iot-augmented-reality.../lecture/.../iot-introduction
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the methods for the measurement of strain and pressure.
CO2 : Describe the methods of measurement for motion and radiation.
CO3 : Identify and select suitable measurement instruments for measuring heat and temperature.
CO4 : Discuss the functions of electronic sensors.
REFERENCES
1. Doeblin. E. O., "Measurement Systems: Applications and Design", McGraw-Hill Publications., 2008
2. Bentley, "Principles of Measurement Systems", Addison Wesley Longman Ltd., UK, 2010
3. Patranabis. D.,"Sensors and Transducers", 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall India Pvt. Ltd, 2010.
WEB REFERENCES
1. nptel.ac.in/courses/117105082/
2. nptel.ac.in/courses/117105082/
COURSE OUTCOMES
On the successful completion of this course, Students will able to
CO1 : Comprehend the input information for human-machine system.
CO2 : Assess the human output, controls and work place design.
CO3 : Appraise the environmental conditions of an industry and the Bio mechanics for the human being for the
industry operations.
CO4 : Categorize the concepts of ergonomics such as Bio thermodynamics and Bioenergetics.
CO5 : Demonstrate the applications of ergonomics for industrial practice.
CO6 : Summarize the human factors applications and the approaches.
REFERENCES
1. Querenghi G, "Ergonomics", Jaico Publications, 2003.
2. Mark S Sanders, "Human Factors in Engineering and Design", McGraw Hill Inc., 1993.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/syllabus/107103004/
2. http://www.nptelvideos.in/2012/12/ergonomics-for-beginners-industrial.html
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, the student will be able to
CO1 : Classify Engineering Materials and recognize the importance of testing.
CO2 : Outline the concepts, principles and procedure of Liquid Penetrant Testing.
CO3 : Summarize the concepts, principles and procedure for conducting Magnetic Particle Inspection and Eddy
Current Inspection.
CO4 : Illustrate the concepts, principles and methods of Radiographic Testing.
CO5 : Outline the concept, principles and procedure for conducting Ultrasonic and Acoustic Emission Testing.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On the successful completion of this course, Students will able to
CO1 : Outline the need for the Identification of Research problems.
CO2 : Categorize the data collection methods which are used in Research methodology.
CO3 : Analyze the difference between various data analysis tools.
CO4 : Identify and select the proper data analysis tools based on its applications.
CO5 : Choose suitable Experimental technique based on the requirement of their research.
CO6 : Interpret the output results of their Experimental research.
RESEARCH PROBLEM 9
Formulation of Research Problem - Identification and selection of problem - ResearchDesign and Experimental Design,
purpose of using research design and principles of research design - Design Criteria - Different types of Research and
Experimental design.
DATA COLLECTION AND MEASUREMENT 9
Sources of data -methodsof data collection: observation, questionnaire, interview schedules and interviews -Measurement
And Scaling Techniques - Measurement in Research - measurement scales - scaling techniques, scale constitution
techniques - contentanalysis.
PROCESSING AND ANALYSIS OF DATA 9
Processing operations - problems in processing - types of analysis - Multivariate Analysis Techniques - Characteristics
and application of multivariate analysis - Classification of multivariate analysis - important multivariate techniques -
Factor Analysis, path analysis.
DESIGN OF EXPERIMENTS 9
Introduction to Design of Experiments - Methods of DOE - Taguchi approach: Achieving robust design, Steps in experimental
design.
INTERPRETATION AND REPORT WRITING 9
Meaning and techniques of interpretation - Significance of Report writing - Different types and steps in Report writing.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Kothari C.R, "Research Methodology - Methods and Techniques", Willey Eastern Ltd., 2004
2. Paneerselvam R., "Research Methodology", PHI Learning Pvt Ltd., 2014
REFERENCES
1. Kidder L.H, "Research Methods in Social Relations", Holt Saunders International Japan, 1981.
2. Sedhu A.M and Singh A., "Research Methodology in Social Sciences", Himalaya Publishing House, 1980.
WEB REFERENCE
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/121106007/
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Interpret the mobile application development platform, its characteristics, UI resources and lifecycle.
CO2 : Understand the unique aspects of mobile apps development.
CO3 : Design and develop mobile apps, using Android as development platform, with key focus on user
experience design, native data handling and background tasks and notifications.
CO4 : Use the thread services, notifications through broadcast receivers and develop custom animation API's.
CO5 : Identify the difference of native hardware play, location awareness, graphics and multimedia.
CO6 : Demonstrate testing, signing, packaging and distribution of mobile applications.
REFERENCES
1. Barry Burd, "Android Application Development All in one for Dummies", 1st Edition, John Wiley & Sons Publication,
2011.
2. Charlie Collins, Michael Galpin and Matthias Kappler, "Android in Practice", DreamTech, 2012.
3. Jeff McWherter and Scott Gowell, "Professional Mobile Application Development", John Wiley & Sons, Inc.,Wrox,
2012.
4. Lauren Darcey Shane Conder, "Teach Yourself Android Application Development in 24 Hours", 3rd Edition, SAMS
Publication, 2013.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the basic concepts and architecture of Database Management System.
CO2 : Make use of relational algebra, SQL queries to manipulate a database for a given domain.
CO3 : Identify and use suitable normal form for designing relational database.
CO4 : Illustrate storage management and file organization concepts.
CO5 : Explain concurrency control and recovery management techniques.
CO6 : Summarize various database system architecture, data warehousing & mining and NoSQL databases.
REFERENCES
1. Peter Rob, Carlos Coronel, "Database Systems: Design, Implementation and Management", 8th Edition, Thomson
Course Technology, 2009.
2. Ramez Elmasri and Shamkant B Navathe, "Fundamental Database Systems", 7th Edition, Addison Wesley, 2016.
3. Raghu Ramakrishnan, "Database Management System", 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2007.
WEB REFERENCE
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/106106093/
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Interpret the basics of Internet.
CO2 : Construct web pages using HTML 5.0
CO3 : Construct web pages using CSS.
CO4 : Construct web pages using XML.
CO5 : Develop programs using JavaScript.
CO6 : Develop programs using VB Script.
REFERENCES
1. Robert W. Sebesta, "Programming the World Wide Web", 8th Edition, Pearson, 2015.
2. Elliotte Rusty Harold, "XML Bible", 3rd Edition, IDG Books India (P) Ltd, 2004.
WEB REFERENCES
1. www.w3schools.com
2. http://www.nptel.ac.in/courses/106105084
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Summarise the various types of batteries and applications of advanced batteries.
CO2 : Describe the types and applications of fuel cells. CO3: Explain the methods of production of hydrogen
and its use as a fuel.
BATTERIES 9
Types - Battery characteristics: Voltage, current, capacity, electricity storage density, power, discharge rate, cycle life,
energy efficiency and shelf life - Primary cells: Fabrication, performance aspects, packing and rating of zinc-carbon,
alkaline, magnesium, silver oxide cells - Lithium primary batteries.
SECONDARY BATTERIES 9
Fabrication, performance aspects and rating of lead acid and sealed lead acid battery, nickel-cadmium,Ni-metal-hydride,
lithium ion batteries, Rechargeable Zinc alkaline batteries and thermal batteries.
ADVANCED BATTERIES 9
Metal/air, zinc-bromine, sodium-beta alumina and lithium/iron sulphide batteries-Photogalvanic cells-Battery specifications
for cars, heart pacemakers, torpedo batteries and satellite batteries.
FUEL CELLS 9
Classification, working principle, components, applications and environmental aspects of alkaline, phosphoric acid, solid
oxide, molten carbonate, direct methanol and proton exchange membrane fuel cells.
HYDROGEN AS FUEL 9
Sources of hydrogen - Hydrogen production: Electrolysis, thermochemical methods, fossil fuel methods and solar energy
method- Gas clean-up - Various methods of hydrogen storage - Hydrogen as an engine fuel - Features and limitations -
Ideal efficiency of a fuel cell.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Dell, Ronald M. Rand and David A. J., "Understanding Batteries", Royal Society of Chemistry, 2001.
2. AuliceScibioh M. and Viswanathan B., "Fuel Cells - Principles and Applications", University Press, 2006.
REFERENCES
1. Lindon David, "Handbook of Batteries", McGraw Hill, 2002.
2. Kiehne H. A., "Battery Technology Handbook", Expert Verlag, RenningenMalsheim, 2003.
3. Hoogers G. (Ed), "Fuel Cell Handbook", CRC, Boca Raton, FL, 2003.
4. Palanna O.G., "Engineering Chemistry', Tata Mc.Graw Hill Education Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi, 2009.
WEB REFERENCES
1. batteryuniversity.com/learn/
2. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Fuel_cell
3. http://www.afdc.energy.gov/fuels/hydrogen_basics.html
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the thermodynamics and kinetics of corrosion.
CO2 : Outline the various forms of corrosion and their control methods.
CO3 : Describe the various techniques of corrosion monitoring and testing.
THERMODYNAMICS OF CORROSION 9
Mechanism of electrochemical corrosion - Galvanic and concentration cells - Free energy criteria for corrosion reaction -
Thermodynamic vs kinetic considerations - Emf and galvanic series - Pourbaix diagram of Fe.
KINETICS OF CORROSION 9
Faradays laws - Corrosion rates expressions - Exchange current density - Activation and concentration polarization -
Tafel equation - Mixed potential theory - Combined polarization - Passivity - Potentiostatic polarization curves - Passivating
materials - High temperature corrosion - Pilling-Bedworth ratio - Protective and non protective oxides.
FORMS OF CORROSION 9
Atmospheric corrosion - Galvanic corrosion - Crevice corrosion - Pitting corrosion - Inter granular corrosion -
Mechanically assisted corrosion - Erosion corrosion - Cavitation corrosion - Fretting corrosion - Corrosion fatigue -
Environmentally induced cracking - Stress corrosion cracking and hydrogen embrittment.
CORROSION MONITORING AND TESTING 9
Classification - Weight loss method - Salt spray test - Electrochemical polarization techniques - Tafel extrapolation -
Linear polarization - AC impedance methods - Application of NDT techniques - Outline of on stream and off stream
corrosion monitoring methods.
PREVENTION OF CORROSION 9
Design - Selection of materials - Alloying: Stainless steel and brass - Oxidation resistant materials - Cathodic and anodic
protection methods - Corrosion inhibitors - Vapour phase inhibitors - Surface conversion processes - Metallic coatings -
Ceramic coatings - Superhydrophobic and self healing coatings.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Chatterjee U. K., "Environment degradation metals", Marcel Dekker Inc., 2001.
2. Zaki Ahmad and Digby Macdonald, "Principles of Corrosion Engineering and Corrosion Control", Butterworth-
Heinemann, 2013.
REFERENCES
1. Herbert H. Uhlig and Winston Revie , "Corrosion and Corrosion Control - An Introduction to Corrosion Science
and Engineering", John Wiley & Sons, 1985.
2. Kenneth R Trethewey and John Chamberlain, "Corrosion for Science and Engineering", Longman Inc., 1996.
3. Rajnarayan, "Metallic Corrosion and Prevention", Oxford Publications, 1988.
4. Mars G. Fontana, "Corrosion Engineering", McGraw Hill Inc., 1987.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://corrosion.ksc.nasa.gov/corr_fundamentals.html
2. www.academia.edu/8889383/Thermodynamic_in_Corrosion
3. http://corrosion-doctors.org/Modules/mod-prevention.html
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the various types of electrodes used in the biosensors.
CO2 : Summarize the various types of hydrogel based and Fluorophore and Chromophore based biosensors.
CO3 : Explain the determination of various metal ions based on anisotropy.
BIOSENSORS 9
Introduction - Amperometric enzyme electrodes - Characteristics - Enzyme activity determinations - Biosensors for enzyme
immunoassay - Potentiometric enzyme electrodes - Electrode characteristics and performance - pH, glass and ion-selective
electrodes - Solid-state pH and redox electrodes - Gas electrodes.
IMMUNO BIOSENSORS 9
Potentiometric Immunobiosensors: Immobilization techniques - Analytical applications - Principle and measurements of
enzyme thermistor devices - Transducer - Experimental techniques - Types of Biological Element: Immobilized enzymes
and Immobilized cells - Determination of enzyme activities in solution.
CHEMICALLY MEDIATED AND REDOX BASED HYDRO-GEL BASED BIOSENSORS 9
Introduction - Sensing chemistry and materials - Sensing techniques - Transducer types - Transducer-based fiber optic
biosensors - Optical biosensors based on competitive binding - Electron conducting redox polymer in biosensors -
Enzyme electrodes - Specific sensor examples - Hybridization at Oligonucleotide Sensitive Electrodes: Function of
oligonucleotide sensitive electrodes - Hybridization efficiency and sensitivity - Probe oligonucleotide structure and
dynamics - Hybridization conditions - Hybridization kinetics.
FLUOROPHORE AND CHROMOPHORES BASED FIBEROPTIC BIOSENSORS 9
Enzyme based nonmediated fiberoptic biosensors - Chromophores and flurophore detection - Bioluminescence and
chemiluminescence based fiberoptic sensors - Bioluminescent and chemiluminescent reactions - Analytical potential of
luminescent reactions - Applications.
DETERMINATION OF METAL IONS BY FLUORESCENCE ANISOTROPY 9
Theory of anisotropy based determination of metal ions - Fluorescent aryl sulfonamides for zinc determination - Removal
of zinc from carbonic anhydrase - Determination of zinc using reagent approach - Determination of copper and other ions
by using reagentless approach.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Copper J M and Cass E G A, "Biosensors", Oxford University Press, 2004.
2. Brian Eggins, "Chemical Sensors and Biosensors", John Willey & Sons, 2002.
REFERENCES:
1. BansiDhar M, Anthony T, "Advances in Biosensors: Perspectives in Biosensors (Advances in Biosensors)", JAI
Press, 2003.
2. Blum L J and Coulet P R, "Biosensor Principles and Applications", Marcel Dekker Inc, 1991.
WEB REFERENCES
1. www.edgefx.in
2. www.logobook.kz/af/11072868/2296/0199638454_sample.pdf
3. https://www.picoquant.com/applications/category/life-science/fluorescence-anisotropy-polarization
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the various organic heterocyclic based materials used in electronics.
CO2 : Explain the use of conducting and liquid crystalline polymers in electronics.
CO3 : Outline the applications of optical lithography.
REFERENCES
1. Kenneth G Budinski and Michael K Budinski, "Engineering Materials: Properties and Selection", Prentice Hall,
2004.
2. ArnostReiser, "Photoreactive Polymers the Science and Technology of Resists", Wiley Interscience, 1989.
3. Kohler M and Fritzsche W, "Nanotechnology: An Introduction to Nanostructuring Techniques", Wiley, 2007.
4. Arora G D, "Liquid Crystals and Polymers", Sarup and Sons, India, 2005.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Photolithography
2. willson.cm.utexas.edu/Teaching/.../Files/Liquid%20Crystalline%20Polymers.pdf
3. https://www.researchgate.net/.../263713988_Advanced_Materials_for_Organic_Electron
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the concept and types of nanomaterials.
CO2 : Describe the various methods of chemical synthesis of nanomaterials. CO3: Explain the methods of
functionalisation of nanomaterials and carbon nanomaterials.
INTRODUCTION TO NANOMATERIALS 9
Colloids - Concepts of nanomaterials - Size and confinement effects - Size induced metal to insulator transition - Surface
to volume ratio - Size effect on the lattice parameter - Energy levels in nanocrystals - Properties: Electronic, optical,
magnetic, thermal, mechanical and electrochemical properties.
TYPES OF NANOMATERIALS 9
Quantum dots - Wells - Wires - Nanoclusters - Nanorods - Nanofibers - Metal, semiconductor,oxide nanoparticles -
Polymer nanoparticles - Organic-inorganic hybrids - Porous materials (micro, meso and nano) - Self assmebled monolayers.
CHEMICAL SYNTHESIS 9
Nucleation- Mechanism of homogeneous and heterogeneous nucleation - Growth process: Isotopic and anisotopic
growth and seed mediated growth - Oswald ripening - Quenching process - Turkevich reduction - Electrochemical
synthesis - Micelles - Synthesis: Sol-gel synthesis, nonaqueous sol-gel synthesis, solvothermal, microwave technique,
sonochemical synthesis and biological synthesis - Shape control with biomolecules - Microbial synthesis.
FUNCTIONALIZATION OF NANOMATERIALS 9
Stabilization methods: Electrostatic stabilization and steric stabilization - Functionalization of nanoparticles - Monolayer
protected clusters (MPCs) - Ligand exchange reaction - Metal nanoparticles stabilization.
CARBON NANOMATERIALS 9
Carbon nanotubes (CNTs): Structure and properties - Single walled carbon nanotubes (SWNTs) - Multiwalled carbon
nanotubes (MWNTs) - Synthesis of CNTs: Arc discharge synthesis, laser ablation synthesis, thermal and chemical vapor
deposition methods - Functionalization of CNTs - Fullerenes: Synthesis and properties.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Cao G., "Nanostructures and Nanomaterials: Synthesis, Properties and Applications", ICP, London, 2004.
2. Pradeep T., "Nano: The Essentials", Tata Mcgraw Hill, 2007.
REFERENCES
1. Brinker C. J., Scherer G.W., "Sol-Gel Science, The Physics and Chemistry of Sol Gel Processing", Academic press
inc., CA,1990.
2. Sergeev G. B., "Nanochemistry", Elsevier, Netherlands, 2006.
3. Ozin G. A., Arsenault A.C., "Nanochemistry: A Chemical Approach to Nanomaterials", RSC, 2009.
4. Niederberger M. and Pinna N., "Metal Oxide Nano Particles in Organic Solvents: Synthesis, Formation, Assembly
and Application", Springer-Velvag London, 2009.
WEB REFERENCES
1. nptel.ac.in/courses/103103033/module9/lecture1.pdf
2. www.fi.tartu.ee/~rynno/raamat/Introduction%20in%20nanomaterials-sisu.pdf
3. https://www.uni-muenster.de/Chemie.pc/eder/research/nanocarbon.html
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the Physics principles of functional semiconductor devices.
CO2 : Outline the optical transport properties of semiconductors.
CO3 : Gain the knowledge of optical transport properties of Semiconductors.
CO4 : Explain the functioning of semiconductor devices and active and passive optoelectronic devices.
PROPERTIES OF SEMICONDUCTORS 9
Crystal structure- reciprocal lattice - Brillouin zone and rules for band (k-space) representation -Dynamics of electrons
in periodic potential: Kronig-Penny and nearly free electron models - Real methods for band structure calculations;
Bandgaps in semiconductors - Holes and effective mass concept - Properties of conduction and valence bands -
semiconductor defects - lattice mismatched structures - strained epitaxy.
ELECTRONIC LEVELS IN SEMICONDUCTORS 9
Particles in an attractive potential, bound states - Bloch theorem - Fermi distribution and energy - Density of states -
Valance and conduction band density of states - intrinsic carrier concentration - intrinsic Fermi level - Extrinsic
semiconductors: n and p type doping - Densities of carriers in extrinsic semiconductors and their temperature dependence
- extrinsic semiconductor Fermi energy level - Degenerate and non-degenerate semiconductors - Tailoring electronic
properties: alloys and quantum wells.
CHARGE TRANSPORT 9
Scattering Mechanism: electron - electron and electron - phonon scattering -Transport under an electric field - carrier
transport by diffusion - charge injection and quasi - Fermi levels - Carrier generation and recombination - current
conductivity.
OPTICAL TRANSPORT 9
Electron - hole pair generation and recombination: band to band -direct and indirect band gap transitions- intra band -
impurity related transitions, free - carrier and phonon transitions - Excitons: Origin, electronic levels and properties -
Radiative and non-radiative recombination -Shockley - Read - Hall and Auger processes - Carrier transport - continuity
equations - Optical constants: Kramers - Kronig relations.
SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES 9
Processing of Semiconductor devices - PN Semiconductor junctions - Homo and hetero junctions -Semiconductors -
MOS capacitor - MOSFET - Zener-Bloch oscillations - Resonant tunnelling - Quantum structures - density of states and
excitons - semiconductor photonic structures: 1D, 2D and 3D photonic crystals - Active and passive optoelectronic
devices: performance and response enhancement.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Neamen, D. and Biswas, D., "Semiconductor Physics and Devices", McGraw-Hill, 2012.
2. Pierret, R.F., "Semiconductor Device Fundamentals", Pearson, 2006
3. Sze, S.M. and K.K. Ng, "Physics of Semiconductor Devices", Wiley, 2008.
REFERENCES
1. Brennan, K.F. "The Physics of Semiconductors", Cambridge University Press, 1999.
2. Umesh K. Misra and Jasprit Singh, "Semiconductor Device Physics & Design", Springer, 2008.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/115102025/5
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/115102025/8
3. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/115102025/14
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Outline the basics of MEMS and micro fabrication.
CO2 : Explain the electrical and mechanical concepts of MEMS.
CO3 : Describe the various sensing and actuating technique.
CO4 : Recall the applications of polymers and optical MEMS.
REFERENCES
1. Charles P. Poole and Frank J. Owens, "Introduction to Nanotechnology", John Wiley & Sons, 2003.
2. Julian W.Gardner and Vijay K Varadhan, "Microsensors, MEMS and Smart Devices", John Wiley & sons, 2001.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://compliantmechanisms.byu.edu/content/introduction-microelectromechanical-systems-mems
2. http://www.tf.uni-kiel.de/matwis/amat/semitech_en/kap_7/backbone/r7_1_3.html
3. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/MEMS_magnetic_actuator
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Outline the new developments in non conventional and renewable energy studies.
CO2 : Recall the basics of solar radiation and application of solar energy.
CO3 : Explain the significance of wind energy and bio-mass energy.
CO4 : Discuss the principles and applications of ocean and tidal energy.
REFERENCES
1. Rao.S. & Parulekar, "Energy Technology", Khanna publishers, 4th Edition, 2005.
2. Pai.B.R, and Ram Prasad, "Power Generation through Renewable Sources of Energy", Tata McGraw Hill, 1991.
WEB REFERENCES
1. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Renewable_energy
2. https:// nptel.ac.in/courses/108108078/
3. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/Webcourse-contents/IISc-BANG/notused/Non-Conventional%20Energy%20Systems-
/Learning%20Materail%20-%20NCES.pdf
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Outline the concepts of solar radiation and collectors.
CO2 : Gain the knowledge of the solar thermal Technologies.
CO3 : Recall the principles and applications of Photovoltaic systems.
CO4 : Explain the concepts of solar passive architecture.
REFERENCES
1. Peter Würfel, “Physics of Solar Cells: From Basic Principles to Advanced Concepts”, Wiley-VCH, 2009.
2. Jeffrey M. Gordon, “Solar Energy: The State of the Art”, Earthscan, 2013.
3. Garg H. P. and Prakash J., “Solar Energy Fundamentals and Applications”, TataMcGraw- Hill Publishing, 7th Reprint
2006.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Interpret the attributes of the population by studying the sample drawn from it
CO2 : Formulate and solve real life situations involving linear variables
CO3 : Study and control repetitive production process using quality control techniques
REFERENCES:
1. Walpole, R.E., Myers, R.H., Myers, S.L. and Ye, K.," Probability and Statistics for Engineers and Scientists ", 8th
Edition , Pearson Education , Asia, 2007.
2. Devore, J.L., "Probability and Statistics for Engineering and the Sciences", 8th Edition, Cengage Learning, 2014.
3. Winston, W.L., "Operations Research - Applications and Algorithms", 4th Edition, Thomson, 1st Indian Reprint,
2007.
4. Gupta, P.K and Hira, D.S, " Operations Research " , S.Chand and Co, Delhi, 2012.
WEB REFERENCE
https://online courses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_mg10
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the role of important elements of discrete event simulation and modeling paradigm.
CO2 : Conceptualize real world situations related to systems development decisions, originating from source
requirements and goals.
CO3 : Develop skills to apply simulation software to construct and execute goal-driven system models.
CO4 : Interpret the model and apply the results to resolve critical issues in a real world environment.
INTRODUCTION TO SIMULATION 10
Simulation - Advantages, Disadvantages, Areas of application, System environment, components of a system, Model of
a system, types of models, steps in a simulation study - Simulation examples in inventory system.
GENERAL PRINCIPLES 10
Concepts in discrete event simulation - event scheduling/ Time advance algorithm - Simulation using event scheduling.
Random Numbers: Properties, Generations methods, Tests for Random number - Frequency test, Runs test, Autocorrelation
test.
ANALYSIS OF SIMULATION DATA 12
Input Modeling:Data collection, Identification and distribution with data, parameter estimation, Goodness of fit tests,
Selection of input models without data, Multivariate and time series analysis - Verification and validation of Model: Model
Building, Verification, Calibration and Validation of Models.
OUTPUT ANALYSIS 13
Types of Simulations with respect to output Analysis - Stochastic Nature of output data - Measures of Performance and
their estimation - Output analysis of terminating simulation - Output analysis of steady state simulations. Simulation
softwares: Selection of Simulation Software, Simulation packages, Trend in Simulation Software.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOK
1. Jerry Banks, John S. Carson II, Berry L. Nelson and David M. Nicol, "Discrete Event system simulation", 4th
Edition,Pearson Education Asia, 2007.
REFERENCES
1. Averill M. Law and David Kelton W., "Simulation Modelling & Analysis", 3rd Edition, McGraw Hill, 2000
2. Narsingh Deo, "Systems Simulation with Digital Computer", 3rd Edition, PHI Publication (EEE), 2004.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_ma01/course
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Acquire fundamental ideas on graph theory required for the study of Computer Science.
CO2 : Use the Fundamental Theorems in Graph Theory that emphasizes the study of computational and
algorithmic aspects of Graph Theory.
CO3 : Use the properties of trees to find a minimal spanning tree for a given weighted graph.
REFERENCES
1. Harary F., "Graph Theory", Addison Wesley,1998.
2. Wilson R.J., "Introduction to Graph Theory", 4th Edition, Pearson Education, 2000.
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_ma01/course
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Use the basic concepts of linear algebra to illustrate its power and utility through applications to computer
science and engineering.
CO2 : Learn the concepts of vector space, linear transformations, matrices and inner product space.
CO3 : Solve the problems in cryptography, computer graphics and some physical problems.
REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Charles W. Curtis, Linear Algebra, Springer (2004)
2. Howard Anton and Robert C Busby, Contemporary linear algebra, John Wiley (2003).
3. Gilbert Strang, Introduction to Linear Algebra, 4th Edition, Wellesley-Cambridge Press (2009).
WEB REFERENCE
https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_ma06/course
COURSE OUTCOMES
On Completion of this course the students will be able to
CO1 : Understand the various methods of preparation of nanomaterials
CO2 : Choose the appropriate instrument to characterize the nanomaterials with different morphology
CO3 : Acquire knowledge on nanotechnology based alternate energy and healthcare applications
REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Mark A. Ratner, Daniel Ratner, "Nanotechnology: A Gentle Introduction to the Next Big Idea", 1st Edition, Prentice
Hall, 2002.
2. Robert W. Kelsall, Ian W. Hamley and Mark Geoghegan, "Nanoscale Science and Technology", John Wiley &
Sons, Ltd., UK, 2005.
3. G. A. Ozin, A. C. Aresnault, L. Cadematriri, "Nanochemistry: A chemical approach to Nanomaterials", RSC Publishing.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://www.scielo.br/scielo.php?script=sci_arttext&pid=S0101-20612010000300002
2. http://journal.frontiersin.org/article/10.3389/fphys.2014.00002/full
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the basics of surface NDE techniques which enable to carry out various inspections in accordance
with the established procedures.
CO2 : Describe the procedure and techniques used for radiographic and ultrasonic testing.
REFERENCES
1. ASM Metals Handbook, "Non-Destructive Evaluation and Quality Control", American Society of Metals, 2002.
2. Paipetis, A.S, Matikas T. E and Aggelis D.G, "Emerging Technologies in Non-Destructive Testing", 1st Edition, CRC
Press, 2012.
WEB REFERENCE
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/113106070/.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the UAV system and sensors used based on their application.
COMPONENTS OF UAV 7
Various types of sensors used - Sensor integration - Data acquisition and data processing- Gimbal units.
UAVAPPLICATIONS 8
UAV - Aerial Imaging - Mapping - Inspection - Search and Rescue.
Total Periods: 15
TEXT BOOKS
1. Barnhart, R., Hoffman, S., Marshall, D. and Shappee, E. "Introduction to Unmanned Aircraft Systems",
1st Edition,CRC Press, 2012.
2. Fahlstrom, P. and Gleason, T. "Introduction to UAV Systems", 4th Edition, John Wiley & Sons Ltd. 2012.
REFERENCE
Wolf, P., DeWitt, B., and Wilkinson, B. "Elements of Photogrammetry with Applications in GIS", 4th Edition,
McGraw-Hill, 2014.
COURSE OUTCOME
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Integrate on clinical and technical application of critical care products, anesthesia
PATIENT MONITORING SYSTEMS 3
Function of each modules used in the patient monitors - cardiac output methods - SPO2 technology, ETCO2 (Main stream,
side stream, micro stream) measurement and types.
ANESTHESIA WORKSTATION 5
Anesthesia workstation overview - Types of anesthesia - Components of anesthesia machine - Respiratory breathing
system - modes of ventilation - difference b/w ICU and anesthesia ventilator.
QUALITY ASSURANCE OF DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENTS 5
CT, cath lab, chest x-ray, C-arm, Dental (intraoral, Otopentogram) , Radiation safety in hosptials- A case study.
ROLE OF BIOMEDICAL ENGINEERS IN CRITICAL CARE 2
Know the technology - Easy handling - Troubleshooting - Maintenance
HOSPITAL TRAINING
Total Periods: 15
REFERENCES
1. Joseph J Carr, John M Brown, "Introduction to Biomedical Equipment Technology", Pearson Education, New
Delhi, 2011.
2. Fred A MettlerJr, Milton J Guiberteau, "Essentials of Nuclear Medicine Imaging", Elsevier, 5th Edition, 2006
3. RüdigerKramme, Klaus-Peter Hoffmann, Robert S. Pozos (Eds.), "Handbook of Medical Technology", Springer,
2011
COURSE OUTCOME
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Use ANSYS for biomedical applications
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the primary, protein, structure sequence databases and tools for access, retrieval, analysis,
submission of biological data
CO2 : Explain the denovo ligand and structure based modelling in drug design
DATABASES 5
Overview of Bioinformatics, Scoring Matrices, Nucleotide Sequence Databases - NCBI, DDBJ, EMBL, MGDB, Protein
Sequence Databases - Swissprot, PIR, Protein Structure Databases - PDB, MMDB, Protein Secondary Structure Databases
- SCOP, CATH, Protein Domain Databases - Pfam, PROSITE, Metabolic Pathway Databases - KEGG, Sequence
DATA ANALYSIS 10
Analysis Tools - BLAST, FASTA, Clustal W, T-Coffee, EMBOSS, Structure Visualization - Rasmol, Tertiary Structure
Prediction, Swissmodel, Modeller, Protein Structure Validation - RamPage, SAVS, Active Site Prediction - CASTP, Docking
- AutoDock.
Total Periods: 15
REFERENCES
1. David W. Mount, "Bioinformatics sequence and genome analysis",2nd Edition,Coldspring Harbor Laboratory
press, 2004.
2. Kristian Stromgaard, Povl Krogsgaard-Larsen, Ulf Madsen, "Textbook of Drug Design and Discovery", 5th Edition,
CRC Press, 2016.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the various methods of soil exploration and field testing.
CO2 : Develop the Bore Log report of given soil profile.
COURSE CONTENT
Site visit - Soil exploration techniques- Field testing - Bore hole Investigation - Ground water table determination - Bore
Log report preparation from field data - Bearing capacity evaluation for different soil profile - Industrial geotechnical
ethics - Finalized geotechnical approval report for construction.
Total Periods: 15
COURSE OUTCOME
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Prepare tender document for Civil Engineering works.
COURSE CONTENT
Definition of tender-Reasons to float tender-Competent agency to call tender- Financial limit or powers to call a tender by
various officials in state and central government- Turnkey project-Execution methods - Global tender-company tie up-
Technical bid-Commercial bid -Techno commercial bid-Final selection-Vested powers/authority to finalize the tender in
public sector and in private sector - Single or monopoly tender - Delegation of powers -Documents /drawings to be
attached along with tender documents while selling the tender document and while filling the tender documents -Tender
document notification -Newspaper references.
Total Periods:15
COURSE OUTCOME
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Plan, Schedule and Cost the Project.
CO2 : Calculate Earned Value Generate Reports.
COURSE CONTENT
Introduction-Navigating-Project Structure-Creating a Project-Creating a Work Breakdown Structure (WBS)-Creating
Activity Codes-Adding Activities-Maintaining the Project Documents Library-Creating Relationships-Scheduling-Adding
Constraints-Formatting Data-Defining Resources-Assigning Resources and Costs-Analyzing Resources and Costs-
Optimizing the Project Plan-Baselining the Project Plan-Project Execution and Control-Reporting Performance-Project
Web Site.
Total Periods:15
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Identify Environmental Impacts and methods of their assessment.
CO2 : Select the mitigation methods of different Environmental Impacts.
CO3 : Interpret the implications Environmental attributes, Environmental settings and EIAnotifications.
CO4 : Summarize the Prediction Methods of assessments of Impacts.
COURSE CONTENT
Concepts of Environmental Impact Assessment Sustainable Development - Methods to Achieve SustainableDevelopment-
Environmental Impact Analysis, Assessment and Statement.
CONCEPTS OF ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACT ASSESSMENT
Project and EnvironmentDescription-Anticipated Environmental Impacts and Mitigation Measures-Environmental
MonitoringProgramme.
ENVIRONMENT ATTRIBUTES AND SETTING
Environmental attributes: Air,Water, Noise, Socioeconomic,Cultural and biological-Purposes of defining theEnvironmental
Setting- Inclusion or Exclusion of Environmental Items.
PREDICTION AND METHODS OF ASSESSMENT
Prediction and methods ofassessment of impacts onvarious attributes ofenvironment.
Total Hours:15
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Summarize the fundamentals of Mainframe Computer, IBM zEnterprise System and Hardware Architecture.
CO2 : Understand theVirtualization and Hipersocket on system z.
Introduction to the new Mainframe -What is a Mainframe - Who uses Mainframe Computers - Introducing the IBM
zEnterprise System - Systemz hardware architecture - Processor units - Networking and Memory - Disk devices - Typical
Mainframe Workloads - Roles in the Mainframe World - z/OS and other mainframe operating systems - Reliability,
Availabilityand Serviceability -Introduction to Systems Management - HMC and SE system management disciplines -
Hardware Management Console Introduction - Support Element Introduction - Introduction to Virtualization - System z
Virtualization - Channel Sub System Overview - Introduction to Network Virtualization - Hipersocket on system z - Key
Functions and Capabilities of IBM z13.
Total Periods: 18
Offered by : IBM, Bangalore
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Identify the basic concept of Shared Memory, Distributed Memory and Vectorization.
CO2 : Understand the Open MP and MPI for Parallelization.
Profiling and Optimization of Sequential Applications - Shared Memory and Distributed Memory Architecture - Modern
Processor Architecture Features - CPU and GPU - Introduction to Vectorization - Introduction to OpenMP - Introduction
to MPI - Performance analysis tools - Gprof, Perf tools, Valgrind Tools - Parallelization of Matrix multiplication - Introduction
to CUDA C programming
Total Periods: 18
Offered by : TCS, Bangalore
PRE REQUISITE
· Knowledge of Embedded Systems
· Programming in C/C++
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1: Identify the Basic Concepts of Embedded Software Testing.
CO2: Understand the Fundamentals of Software Analysis and Testing
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand the Basic Concepts Context Setting and Next Gen Imaging.
CO2 : Understand the Fundamentals of Hyper Spectral Imaging and Spectroscopy.
Introduction - Participant Introduction and Involvement Exercise - Context Setting - Expectation Gathering - Computer
Vision in the Industry - Next Gen Imaging - Overview - Technologies for Seeing Invisibles: Thermal Imaging - UV Imaging
- Spectroscopy - Hyper Spectral Imaging - Hyper Spectral Imaging - Deep Dive -Spectral Signature and Hyper Cube
concepts - Tools and Software - Hyper Spectral Imaging - Hands on: Software Installation - Overview - Hands-On
Experiments - Hyper Spectral Imaging - Applications of Hyper Spectral Imaging in various business verticals - Overview
about the spectroscopy - Single Pixel - Spectroscopy Concepts - hyper spectral imaging - NIR Spectroscopy - Deep Dive
and applications - Spectroscopy Hands on Software Installation and Data collection for a small experiment.
Total Periods: 18
Offered By: Wipro Technologies, Bangalore
PURPOSE
The purpose of this course is to introduce students on various electronics and communication systems and subsystems
used in automotive electronics application The main objective of this course is to familiarize the students on automotive
electronics fundamentals.
INSTRUCTIONAL OBJECTIVES
1. To familiarize with various electrical and electronics system used in automotives.
2. To familiarize with automotive engine components, sensors and actuators.
3. To familiarize with automotive communication protocol and architecture.
4. To familiarize with automotive control system and safety technologies.
AUTOMOTIVE VEHICULAR ELECTRICALAND ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS 3
Batteries and Charging Systems: Types of Batteries, Lead-acid, Lithium-ion, Nickel Metal Hydride, Comparison between
Battery Technologies. Charging Systems: Alternators, Charging Circuits. Starting Systems: Starter Motors and Circuits,
Ignition Systems-. Electronic Ignition and Ignition control. Lighting Systems - Head lights, Tail lights, Side lights, Control
of lights, Single and Double-ended schemes. Horn and Sounding Systems, Wiper Systems, Vehicle Electricals- Wire
Harnessing. Power Electronics and Drives
ENGINE SYSTEMS 3
Engine Management Systems - Diesel, Gasoline. Engine Peripherals - Fuel pumps, Solenoids, Catalytic Converters,
Exhaust Systems - EGR (Exhaust Gas Recirculation) control - HVAC Systems - Cooling Systems.
AUTOMOTIVE SENSORS AND ACTUATORS 3
Transducers and principles, Body sensors - Pressure, Temperature, Force, Flow, Torque, Speed, RPM. TPMS (Tyre
Pressure Monitoring System), Security Systems, Park-assist sensors, Tilt sensors, Yaw sensors, NOX sensors, Hall effect
sensors. MEMS in Automotive Applications.
Actuators - Brushless & Switched reluctance Motors, Servo & Stepper Motors, Solenoids, Smart micro Actuators.
TELEMATICS AND VEHICLE NETWORKS 3
OSI Reference Model- Communication Layers, Communication Protocols - Ethernet, TCP, UDP. Networks - CAN, LIN,
MOST, FLEXRAY,Wireless, Ethernet. Vehicle System Architecture - ECU networking, Sensors networking, Timing analysis.
Timing considerations for Networks.
VEHICLE DYNAMICS AND SAFETY TECHNOLOGIES 4
Automotive Control Systems : Digital Control System, Controller Design (proportional, Integral, Derivative Controllers)
Fundamentals of ECUs (Electronic Control Units).
Safety Technologies : Anti lock Braking Systems (ABS), Traction Control, Anti collision technologies. Vehicular Standards
- SAE Standards, EMI-EMC Standards.
Total Periods: 16
TEXT BOOKS
1. Tom Denton, Routledge, "Automobile Electrical and Electronics Systems", 3rd Edition, Taylor & Francis Group
London & New York, 2002.
2. Ronald K. Jurgen, "Sensors and Transducers", 2nd Edition, SAE, 2003.
3. Ronald K Jurgen, "Electronic Engine Control technology", Chilton's guide to Fuel Injection, Ford (OPTIONAL)
REFERENCES
1. "Automotive Electricals Electronics System and Components", 4th Edition,Robert Bosch Gmbh, 2004.
2. "Automotive Hand Book", Robert Bosch, Bentley Publishers 1997.
3. "Automotive Sensors", Bosch, 2002.
CURRICULUM AND SYLLABUS 239
16ECI002 AUTOMOTIVE CONTROLLER AREA NETWORKS AND 1001
SECURITY
INTRODUCTION 3
Basics of automotive electronic control units and building blocks - Exemplary ECU functionality -overview of automotive
in vehicular architecture.
SECURITY BASICS 3
Security goals - Security threats - Security Mechanisms - Application of security mechanisms in automotive systems.
AUTOMOTIVE CAN NETWORKS 3
Introduction - The CAN Standard - CAN Message - CAN Arbitration - Message Types - A Valid Frame - Error Checking
and Fault Confinement - The CAN Bus - CAN Transceiver Features.
AUTOMOTIVE DIAGNOSTICS OVER CAN 3
On-Board-Diagnostics -OBD Applications - Diagnostics Scan tool - OBD-II signal protocols - Diagnostics over CAN -
Remote Diagnostics and Future trends.
AUTOMOTIVE SECURITY VULNARABILITIES 4
Security Vulnerabilities in vehicular networks- Security Vulnerabilities in Diagnostics networks - Security Vulnerabilities
in multimedia systems - Exemplary CAR hack - Possible mitigations and Security measures.
Total Periods: 16
REFERENCES
1. William Stallings,"Cryptography and network security principles and practice", 5th Edition
2. Nicolas Navet, Francoise Simonot-Lion,"Automotive Embedded Systems Handbook"
3. William Ribbens,"Understanding Automotive Electronics: An Engineering Perspective"
4. Wilfried Voss,"A Comprehensible Guide to Controller Area Network"
5. Other E-Sources will be included in the slides (Most of the lectures will be based on E-Materials)
PURPOSE
The purpose of this course is to introduce students on various steps involved in the hardware system design using six
sigma methodology
INSTRUCTIONAL OBJECTIVES
1. To familiarize with Six Sigma concepts.
2. To familiarize with Hardware design methodology.
3. To familiarize with the process of using Six Sigma in Hardware design.
AIM
To provide an overview of various positioning technologies, deployment and their applications.
OBJECTIVES
1. To understand various positioning technologies like Satellite-based, Cellular-based and Indoor positioning.
2. To understand the interaction between various entities involved in aided positioning.
3. To understand and appreciate the usefulness of positioning technologies to human society.
INTRODUCTION TO POSITIONING 4
Speed distance formula - Triangulation - Earth's Ellipsoidal Models - 2D and 3D position coordinates - Satellite based
positioning systems: GPS, GLONASS, BEIDOU, GALILEO, IRNSS.
GPS POSITIONING 4
GPS constellation - Control segment - Space segment - Frequency of operation - PRN codes - Signal acquisition -
Computing position coordinates.
CELLULAR AND AIDED POSITIONING 4
Cell ID - Enhanced Cell ID (ECID) - Observed Time Difference on Arrival (OTDOA) - Assisted GNSS - Sensor augmentation.
APPLICATIONS 3
Navigation - Surveying - Tracking - Emergency calls - Indoor positioning.
INDIVIDUALASSESSMENT 1
Total Duration: 16
REFERENCE MATERIALS
1. Frank van Diggelen, "A-GPS: Assisted GPS, GNSS, and SBAS", ISBN-13: 978-1-59693-374-3, 2009.
2. 3GPP TS 25.215, "Technical Specification Universal Mobile Telecommunications System (UMTS); Physical Layer;
Measurements (FDD) (3GPP TS25.215 version 6.0.0 Release 6)", V6.0.0 (2003-12), pp. 1-19
3. LTE Location Based Services Technology Introduction (White paper) http://www.rohde-schwarz-wireless.com/
documents/LTELBSWhitePaper_RohdeSchwarz.pdf
PREAMBLE:
The Industrial Internet represents the next big wave of innovation and will fundamentally transform industrial sectors of
the economy. McKinsey Global Institute estimates an annual economic impact of $2.7 trillion to $6.2 trillion by 2025.
Gartner estimates it will lead to a digital workforce and smart machines that will replace 1 in 3 knowledge workers by 2020.
General Electric estimates that the Industrial Internet could add $10-$15 trillion to the global GDP over the next 20 years.
This transformation has already started, yet the Industrial Internet is still in its infancy stage. This course attempts to
introduce the world of Industrial IoT to the students and engage them with practical experiments using open source
industrial IoT technologies for connected motion use cases.
PRE-REQUISITE
· Drives and Motion Control
· Sensors & PLC
· Digital Electronics
· Fundamentals of C Programming
CO-REQUISITE
· Exposure to Linux Command Line - enables in completing the exercises faster
· Introduction to Networking Fundamentals
COURSE OUTCOMES
CO1 : Understand the Industrial IoT Architecture (from device to fog to cloud to iSMAC layers)
CO2 : Understand the idea of business transformation using connected car case study - Why you may never buy
a car in the near future?
CO3 : Learn the practically explore the the concepts behind "Connected Motion" Module No Topic No of
Lectures
Module No of
Topic
No Lectures
1 Basics of Industrial IoT 1
1.1 IIoT Architecture Layers
1.1.1 Introduction to IIoT End Point Gateway, Fog Layer and iSMAC Layers
(IoT, Social, Mobile, Analytics and Cloud) 1.1.1
Difference between traditional SCADA/DCS architectures and IIoT architectures -
"Business Transformation Potential" 2
Introduction to IIoT Business Transformation Potential using Connected Car Case Study 1
2.1 Future of Drives - "Connected Motion"
2.2 How connected drives will communicate with car's central computer
2.3 What are the other systems in the connected car - elimination of driver
2.4 Why should car's central computer communicate with the cloud?
2.5 Why you may never buy a car in the near future?
3 Connected Motion
3.1 Drives & Motion Control in a connected world 1
3.2 Introduction to Industrial Ethernet Protocols - (Profinet, EtherCAT, Ethernet/IP, Sercos,
POWERLINK, TSN-OPC-UA, IEEE 802.1 ) 1
3.3 Introduction to key concepts across different Industrial Ethernet Protocols 1
3.3.1 Concept of Time & Need for Time Synchronization (Atomic Clock, Clock, Drift,
Clock Domains, Clock Synchronization, GPS, NTP, PTP, IEEE 1588 1
3.3.2 Scheduling & Traffic Shaping 1
3.3.3 Time triggerred sending & Auto-response capabilites to utilize the underlying
hardware capabiliteis fully 1
3.3.4 Concept of Process Data & Service Data & Configuration Tool/Agents 1
3.4 Introduction to open source POWERLINK technology & how it implements the
key concepts of real time networking 1
3.5 Introduction to Rasperby Pi POWERLINK - open source openCONFIGURATOR 2
3.5.1 Lab experiements - Raspbery Pi POWERLINK Demo - Remote IO 2
3.5.2 Lab experiements - Raspbery Pi POWERLINK Demo - Distributed Remote IO &
Measuring Deterministic Behaviour 2
REFERENCE
www.kalycito.com/rpi2
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Demonstrate the philosophy of energy audit and energy management.
CO2 : Explain the different energy management methodologies used to develop an energy audit report.
CO3 : Summarize the types of instruments used for energy auditing and monitoring.
PREAMBLE
Hybrid Electric Vehicle covers hybrid and electric vehicle engineering concepts, theory and applications relevant to HEV,
PHEV, EREV, and BEV for the passenger car industry. While the theory and concepts readily apply to the commercial
vehicle industry as well, the examples and applications used will apply primarily to the passenger car industry.
BRIEF COURSE OVERVIEW
· Define and analyze fundamental electrochemistry of battery operation and performance requirements for HEV,
PHEV, EREV and full electric vehicle applications
· Learn to estimate the size of a cell to meet a specific requirement
· Learn the functions performed by a Battery Management System (BMS)
· Explain different approaches to estimating state of charge (SOC), state of health (SOH), Depth of Discharge (DOD),
Battery Aging & internal Resistance, power and energy
· Describe the main hybrid and electric vehicle development considerations and performance requirements for
various vehicle system
· Identify how to define key vehicle system requirements and select and size system components that bestmeet
those requirements
COURSE TOPIC AND CONTENTS:
SYSTEMS OVERVIEW, SYSTEM INTEGRATION AND ANALYTICS
· Vehicle Development Process Overview
F Requirements Development
· Hybrid Components and Architectures
F Major components in hybrid powertrain
F Controls integration
F Component sizing and integration tradeoffs
F Hybrid architecture overview
· System Design and Development Considerations
F Vehicle integration (ex. performance, drivability, NVH)
F Powertrain integration (ex. energy, power, efficiency, torque, thermal management)
F HV/LV electrical systems (ex. safety, DC/AC voltage, charging system, efficiency, cables, connectors, fuses,
F Chassis (ex. braking, vehicle dynamics, powertrain to chassis dynamics, ride and handling, steering, fuel
system)
F Displays/information (ex. messages, information aids, usage efficiency aids)
F HVAC (ex. HV compressor, HV heater, cabin comfort, efficiency considerations)
· Verification and Validation Considerations
F Verification and validation test requirements and planning
F Component test considerations
F System test considerations
F Fleet testing
ELECTROCHEMISTRY AND BATTERY MATERIALS DESIGN
· Electrochemical Principles of Energy Storage Systems
· General Overview; Physics and Chemistry of Advanced Lithium Battery Materials
· Advanced Positive and Negative Electrodes
· Advanced Electrolytes and Recent Developments
REFERENCE
Automotive handbook by "Bosch"
WEB REFERENCES
1. Basic Automotive Electronics and Circuit Overview.
2. https://WWW.youtube.com/watchv = E2nZZCkVreA.
5
DCS Evolution - DCS Overview - CENTUM VP system architecture - System builder - Configuration - Project creation -
Field control station configuration - IOM configuration - Human machine interface - Features - Configuration and working
of loops - Open loop and Closed loop - Different types of graphical user Interface(GUI)
5
Face plate - Tuning window operation - Configuration of loops (Contd) - Cascade loop - Ratio control - Split range control
- Signal Selectors - Multiple cascade - Control group - Trends Sequence Control - Functions
5
Generation of Interlocks using - Sequence tables - Logic charts - Real time graphics Configuration and Assessments
Total Periods: 15
REFERENCE
Training Handout-CENTUM VP Fundamentals & Engineering , 2nd Edition , Manual No:JE Y112JA02E-VPFE,
2012.
THERMOCOUPLE 3
a. Measurement of Temperature using Thermocouple.
b. Measurement of Cold Junction and Hot Junction Temperature
c. Effect of CJC in the temperature measurement.
d. Measurement of the voltage from the thermocouple and CJC compensation voltage.
e. Determination of the amplifier output voltage, ADC Count and Conversion of voltage to temperature data using
NIST standard
RTD 4
a. Measurement of temperature using the RTD.
b. Measurement of voltage output from the RTD and calculation of the resistance change of the RTD using constant
current excitation.
c. Conversion of measured voltage to Amplifier output voltage, ADC output and conversion to Temperature.
d. Elimination of the lead wire resistance in the 4-wire RTD compared to 2-wire & 3-wire RTD
STRAIN MEASUREMENT SETUP 4
a. Cantilever beam setup strain measurement using strain gauges. (quarter, half and full bridge configuration).
b. Measurement of bridge output voltage for the given excitation voltage.
c. Conversion of the bridge output voltage to amplifier output voltage, ADC counts output and conversion to
displacement.
d. Comparison of the bridge output in quarter, half and full bridge configuration.
DISPLACEMENT MEASUREMENT 4
a. Displacement measurement using LVDT (AC or DC LVDT)
b. Measurement of the output voltage from the LVDT.
c. Conversion of measured voltage to Determination of the measured voltage into Amplified voltage, ADC output
and displacement
d. Effect of residual voltage in LVDT measurement.
e. Calibration of LVDT.
Total Periods: 15
TEXT BOOK
Jovitha Jerome "Virtual Instrumentation Using LabVIEW", PHI Learning Pvt,. Ltd., 2010.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : proceed with the procedures and steps involved in the implementation of FMEA.
CO2 : carry out the interfacing between FMEA with other tools to provide the enhanced solutions for the
failures.
CO3 : sketch a FMEA project in a manufacturing industry.
COURSE CONTENT
1. Basics of FMEA and their types
2. Procedure and Steps involved
3. Linking FMEA with other tools
4. Planning a FMEA project
Total Periods: 15
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : provide the overview of SCM and logistrics and distribution channels
CO2 : illustrate the economic and cost analysis on transportation and effective packing
COURSE CONTENT
1. Introduction to SCM & Logistics
2. Distribution channels
3. Transportation and cost effective packing
4. International Logistics
Total Periods: 15
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Ellaborate the fundamentals and methodology of QFD
CO2 : Illustrate the main components and phases of QFD
COURSE CONTENT
1. QFD methodology
2. Voice of customer
3. House of Quality
4. Four phases of QFD & case study
Total Periods: 15
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO 1 : Summarize the fundamentals, roles and eight pillars of TPM
CO 2 : Work on different methods in implemention and benefits of TPM in an industry
CO 3 : Explore the 5s concept and its mplications imparted in manufacturing industries
CO 4 : Discuss the overview of losses and its impact in manufacturing in technical and financial aspects
COURSE CONTENT
1. Basics, Eight Pillars and role of TPM
2. Implementation methods
3. 5S and it's importance
4. Losses and its impact in manufacturing
5. Benefits of TPM in today's business
Total Periods: 15
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : List the Seven Qualtiy Tools and apply them effectively to solve any TQM problem
CO2 : Prepare suitable control chart for the statistical process control vrialble and attributes
CO3 : Apply the control charts for the study of process capability
COURSE CONTENT
1. Zero Defect Concept
2. Introduction to 7QC Tools
3. Check Sheet
4. Histogram
5. Pareto Diagram
6. Fish Bone Diagram
7. Stratification
8. Scatter Diagram
9. Introduction to Statistical Process Control
10. Variable Vs Attribute Data
11. Measures of Variation (Simulation game)
12. Stability Vs Predictability
13. Control Charts (Activity on Preparation of Control Charts)
14. Interpretation of Control Charts
15. Process Capability Study
16. Activity on Process Capability Study
Total Periods: 15
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the history of Lean and seven wastes
CO2 : Demonstrate the concepts of 5s, Kaizen and Lean tools
CO3 : Apply the concept of lean for any small and medium scale
COURSE CONTENT
1. Brief History of Lean
2. Seven Wastes
3. Understanding and Eliminating waste
4. 5S + 1S
5. Kaizen
6. Striker game on 5S
7. Lean Tools
8. Value Stream Mapping
9. Standard Symbols for Value Stream Mapping
10. TAKT Time Production
11. Pull Vs Push Production 12. Single Piece Flow
13. Standard Work
14. Autonomation (Jidoka)
15. Case study Presentation
16. Simulation Game on Lean
Total Periods: 15
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Apply quality principles and perform Inspection (Incoming, Inprocess and Final Inspection) in an industry
CO2 : Apply quality mananagement concepts to manage quality of the system.
CO3 : Apply and implement Quality Management Suatem(QMS) for any SME
COURSE CONTENT
1. Introduction to Quality, Quality Control and Quality Assurance
2. Spiral Progress of Quality Characteristics
3. Incoming Inspection
4. In-process Inspection
5. Final Inspection
6. Barrier Audit
7. Poka - Yoke
8. Activity on Quality Process
9. Introduction to ISO
10. 8 Quality Management Principles
11. Process Approach
12. Types of Audit
13. Management Responsibilities on QMS
14. Product Realization
15. Monitoring and Presentation
16. Case Study Presentation
17. Activity on Quality Management System
Total Periods: 15
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Concepts of TPM for planned, focused and quality maintenance
CO2 : Educate and train resources on the concepts of TPM for Safety, Health and Environment
CO3 : Apply the concepts to TPM for Brake down maintenaceand access the losses
COURSE CONTENT
1. Introduction to Total Productive Maintenance
2. Roles & Responsibilities for TPM
3. Pillars of TPM
4. Autonomous Maintenance
5. Planned Maintenance
6. Focused Maintenance
7. Quality Maintenance
8. Activity on TPM
9. Initial Phase Management System
10. Education & Training
11. Office TPM
12. Safety, Health and Environment
13. Steps for Implementing TPM
14. TPM Key Indicator
15. TPM & Break down maintenance
16. Six Big Machine Losses
17. Activity on TPM
Total Periods: 15
The objective of the course is to give an in-depth perspective of Mobile Web Application Development with ColdFusion.
PREREQUISITES
· HTML and CSS
· Introduction to RDBMS
COREQUISITES
· Computer with at-least 4 GB RAM and Windows Operating System
· Internet Connection to Install MySQL
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Fundamental understanding on Web App Architecture.
CO2 : Have a clear understanding on implementing Bootstrap to design web pages.
CO3 : Troubleshoot the application logs to find out where the errors are and how to correct them.
CO4 : Understand and Implement ACID properties in multilevel transactional processing.
CO5 : Have a fundamental understanding of Web Services.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Develop and apply vocabulary in ideal situations.
CO2 : Understand the meaning of targeted grammatical structure in written and spoken form
CO3 : Improve on the Deductive and Logical skills.
CO4 : Understand, analyze and perfect a solution.
CO5 : Improve the numerical and conceptual ability.
CO6 : Improve the ability to use measurable data and get reliable results.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand and apply the advance grammar forms.
CO2 : Understand grammatical structure on written and spoken forms.
CO3 : Demonstrate a better capability for analytical and conceptual thinking.
CO4 : Recognize and comprehend pattern and solve real time problems.
CO5 : Exhibit real time engineering and calculative skills.
CO6 : Improve the psychometric and mental ability.
ADVANCE GRAMMAR AND COMPREHENSION 12
Advance Grammar- Subject verb agreement, Pronoun agreement, pronoun case, pronoun reference, Phrasal verbs;
Modifiers, Parallel structures, Faulty comparison, Tense shift; Comprehension -Short passage, Nonfiction and information
passage Fact inference and judgment, Philosophy and literature passages Theme detection, Long passage
INDUCTIVE REASONING 13
Statements and action; Statement and assumptions; Syllogism Input and output Data interpretation; Data sufficiency;
Venn diagram based; Visual reasoning.
ENGINEERING AND APPLIED MATHEMATICS 20
Averages, Time and Work: ,Pipes and cisterns: Time and distance-concept of relative speed Trains, boats and streams,
circular motion: Permutation and combination, Probability-concept of areas,Calendars and clocks
Total Periods: 45
REFERENCES
1. Thorpe Edgar and Thorpe Showich, "Objective English",Pearson Education 2016.
2. Bakshi.S.P, "Objective General English",Arihant Publication 2015.
3. Edgar Thrope, "Test of Reasoning for Competitive Examinations", 4th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill, 2014
4. Sijwali.B.S, "A New Approach to Reasoning Verbal and Non-Verbal",Arihant Publication 2015.
5. Anand.P.A, "Quantitative Aptitude", Wiley Publication, 2015.
6. Abhijit Guha, "Quantitative Aptitude for Competitive Examinations", 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw Hill, 2015
• Mini Project in the curriculum can be done individually or by a group of students (4 Maximum) as decided by the
Head of the Department.
• In order to promote interdisciplinary culture, preference should be given for teams formed by students from
various departments with the permission of the Heads of Departments concerned in the second year itself.
• There will be periodic reviews (one review after each internal test) of the progress by the Review Committee as
assigned by the HoD / Director
• The mini project will be assessed by a Review Committee which consists of 3 members out of whom one member
is the Guide.
• For inter disciplinary projects, guides shall be from one or more among the departments to which the students
belong.
• On completion of the mini project, the student shall submit a report in the prescribed form to the department.
Number of copies and the format will be as per the department guidelines.
• The final mini project viva voce shall be conducted by the Review Committee (Guide and HoD or higher nominee)
along with an external examiner.
• Project work may be assigned to a single candidate or a group of candidates not exceeding 3 per group.
• There shall be two assessments during the semester by a review committee. The student shall make presentation
on the progress made before the committee.
• The Head of the Department shall constitute a project review committee for each programme.
• The project evaluation shall be carried out by a project committee comprising Head of the Department or his/her
nominee (Chairperson), Project Coordinator, (Prof/Assoc. Prof) and Project Faculty Guide.
• The project work assessment shall be based on :
H Conceptual understanding of Engineering Fundamentals
H Ability to design and develop solution and conduct investigation of complex problems
H Ability to use modern engineering and IT tools
H Decision making ability
H Interdisciplinary approach
H Initiative, leadership, sense of responsibility
H Ability to produce research information for team
H Ability to demonstrate understanding of team rules when assigned, share in team work
H Ability to demonstrate good communication skills
H Completion of objectives
H Presentation
H Answer to queries
• The candidate(s) is expected to submit the project report on or before the last working day of the semester.
• The semester end examination for project work shall consist of evaluation of the final project report submitted by
the candidate or students of the project group by an external examiner followed by a viva-voce examination
conducted separately for each student by a committee consisting of the external examiner, the guide of the project
group and an internal examiner.
• If the project report is not submitted on or before the specified deadline, then the student(s) is deemed to have
failed in the Project Work. The failed student(s) should repeat the same in the subsequent semester.
PREREQUISITES
16CE204 Solid Mechanics/16AE212 Mechanics of Materials
16MA216 Probability and Statistics/ 16MA218 Numerical Methods and Calculus of variations
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Recall the basic steps involved in finite element method and matrix approach in mechanical engineering
applications.
CO2 : Apply the concepts of integral formulations and variational approach in structural problems.
CO3 : Derive the stiffness matrix for one dimensional element using different approach.
CO4 : Solve the heat transfer of steady state one–dimensional problem.
CO5 : Derive the finite element formulation for 2–D plane stress and plane strain problem using Constant Strain
Triangular elements.
CO 6 : Formulate the stiffness matrix and force vector for any axisymmetric continuum.
INTRODUCTION TO FINITE ELEMENT METHOD AND ANALYTICAL APPROACH 15
Basic Concept, Historical Background, Engineering Applications, General Steps of the FEM, Matrix Algebra, Gaussian
Elimination. Boundary, Initial, and Eigen value Problems, Variational methods of Approximation – Rayleigh–Ritz method
and weighted residual approach.
ONE DIMENSIONAL FINITE ELEMENT ANALYSIS 15
Finite element modeling–Coordinates and shape functions–Potential energy approach– Galerkin approach–Assembly of
stiffness matrix and load vector– Finite element equations – Quadratic shape functions–Applications to plane trusses.
Steady state heat transfer – Application of one–dimensional heat transfer problems.
TWO DIMENSIONAL FINITE ELEMENT ANALYSIS 15
Concepts of Plane stress and plane strain, Finite element modeling, Constant–Strain Triangle – Potential energy approach,
Galerkin approach, Element stiffness matrix and force vector, Stress Calculation, Axisymmetric
formulation – Galerkin approach– Element stiffness matrix and force vector, Body forces and temperature effects, Stress
calculations.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Logan, D.L., “A First Course in Finite Element Method”, Thomson Asia Pvt. Ltd., 2002.
2. Chandrupatla and Belagundu, “Introduction to Finite Elements in Engineering”, Prentice Hall College Div, 2009.
REFERENCES
1. Reddy J.N., “An Introduction to the Finite Element Method”, 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw–Hill, 2005.
2. Seshu P, “Text Book of Finite Element Analysis”, Prentice–Hall of India Pvt. Ltd., 2007.
3. Rao S.S., “The Finite Element Method in Engineering”, 3rd Edition, Butterworth Heinemann, 2004.
WEB REFERENCE
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105108141/
PREREQUISITES
16PH207 Engineering Physics
16AE206 Mechanics of Fluids
COURSE OF OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe theories of aerodynamics.
CO2 : Illustrate the governing equations of incompressible flows.
CO3 : Describe Kutta condition and Kelvin’s circulation theorem.
CO4 : Describe the airfoil / wing theories.
CO5 : Describe boundary layer theory.
CO6 : Explain the flow over a plate and boundary layer seperation.
BASIC AERODYNAMICS 9
Aerodynamic forces and moments – Review of governing equations – Potential flows – Elementary flows and their
combinations.
INCOMPRESSIBLE FLOW 12
Ideal Flow over bodies – Kutta-joukowski theorem and generation of lift – Airfoil characteristics –Vortex sheet – Kutta
condition – Kelvins circulation theorem.
AIRFOIL AND WING THEORY 14
Airfoil – Nomenclature – Kutta condition – Starting vortex – Method of singularities and thin airfoil theory – Elements of
panel method – Experimental characteristics of airfoils – Prandtl’s lifting line theory – Induced drag – Effect of geometrical
parameter on lift and induced drag – Element of lifting surface theory.
BOUNDARY LAYER THEORY 10
Boundary layer – Displacement thickness, Momentum thickness and Energy thickness – Flow over the flat plate – Blasius
solution – Boundary layer separation and blowing.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Anderson, J.D., “Fundamentals of Aerodynamics”, 5th Edition, Mc Graw Hill Book Co, 2010.
2. Clancy, L J., “Aerodynamics”, 7th Edition, Sterling book house, 2006.
REFERENCES
1. Houghton, E.L., and Carpenter, P.W., “Aerodynamics for Engineering students”, Elsevier Publications, 2013.
2. Milne Thomson, L.H., “Theoretical Aerodynamics”, 5th Edition, Dovar Publications,1996.
3. John J Bertin., “Aerodynamics for Engineers”, 6th Edition, Pearson Education Ltd., 2014.
4. Kuethe, A.M and Chow, C.Y, “Foundations of Aerodynamics”, 5th Edition, John Wiley & Sons, 2000.
WEB REFERENCE
1. NPTEL Course: http://nptel.ac.in/courses/101105059/.
PREREQUISITE
16ME205 Engineering Mechanics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Demonstrate the concepts of stress and strain.
CO2 : Determine the shear force and bending moment for different types of beams under various load conditions.
CO3 : Calculate the slope and deflection of beams
CO4 : Calculate the torsion developed in the shaft and the deflection of springs
CO5 : Calculate the principal stresses and principal planes using analytical and mohr’s circle method.
CO6 : Determine the stresses developed in thin cylindrical and spherical shells.
STRESS, STRAIN AND DEFORMATION OF SOLIDS 10
Stress and strain due to axial force – Elastic limit – Hooke’s law – Factor of safety – Stepped bars – Uniformly varying
sections – Stresses in composite bars due to axial force and temperature – Lateral strain – Poisson’s ratio – Volumetric
strain – Changes in dimensions and volume – Relationship between elastic constants.
TRANSVERSE LOADING AND DEFLECTION OF BEAMS 10
Relationship between Load, Shear force and Bending moment – Shear force and bending moment diagrams for cantilever,
Simply supported and overhanging beams under concentrated loads, Uniformly distributed loads and Uniformly varying
loads – Theory of simple bending – Analysis of stress – Deflection of beams – Macaulay’s method – Moment area
method.
TORSIONOF SHAFTS AND SPRINGS 10
Theory of torsion and assumptions – Equation of pure Torsion – Polar modulus – Stresses in solid and hollow circular
shafts – Power transmitted by a shaft – Shear stress distribution – Shear flow – Application to closed coiled helical spring
– Deflection of helical coil spring under axial load.
TWO DIMENSIONAL PRINCIPAL STRESSES AND FAILURE THEORIES 15
State of stress at a point – Normal and tangential stresses and their planes – Principal Stress and their planes – Plane of
maximum shear stress – Analytical method – Mohr’s circle method – Maximum Stress theory – Maximum Strain Theory –
Maximum Shear Stress Theory – Distortion Theory – Maximum Strain energy theory – Application to aircraft Structural
problems – Hoop and longitudinal stresses in thin cylindrical and spherical shells under internal pressure – Change in
length dimension and volume.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Ramamrutham S. and Narayan R., “Strength of Materials”, Dhanpat Rai Publishing Company Limited, 2008.
2. Bansal.R.K, “A text book of Strength of Materials”, 6th Edition, Laxmi Publications Pvt. Ltd., 2012.
REFERENCES
1. Punmia B.C, Ashok Jain and Arun Jain., “Strength of Materials and Theory of Structures”, 2nd Edition, Laxmi
Publications, 2000.
2. Rajput.R.K, “Strength of Materials”, 4th Edition, S.Chand & Co, 2008.
3. KazmiS.M.A ., “Solid Mechanics” , 1st Edition, Tata McGraw Hill Pvt Ltd., 2011.
4. Rattan S.S., “Strength of Materials”, 3rd Edition, Mc Graw Hill Education Pvt. Ltd., 2017.
PREREQUISITE
16AE207 Thermodynamics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the fundamentals of gas turbine engines and working principle.
CO2 : Explain the flow through the inlet.
CO3 : Explain the flow through the nozzle.
CO4 : Describe the performance of combustion chamber.
CO5 : Explain the flow through the compressor and turbine.
CO6 : Explain the flow throught the turbine.
AIR BREATHING ENGINES 14
Gas turbine engine working principle – Thrust of the engine – Factors affecting thrust – Effect of inlet conditions –
Methods of thrust augmentation – Characteristics of turbojet, turboprop, turbofan and turbo shaft - Performance
characteristics – Ramjet and Scramjet engines.
INLETS AND NOZZLES 16
Subsonic inlets – Internal flow and Stall in subsonic inlets – Boundary layer separation – Major features of external flow
near a subsonic inlet – Relation between minimum area ratio and external deceleration ratio – Diffuser performance –
Supersonic inlets – Starting problem on Supersonic inlets – Shock swallowing by area variation – External declaration –
Isentropic nozzles – Nozzle choking – Nozzle throat conditions – Nozzle efficiency – Losses in nozzles – Types of nozzles
and its operation – Interaction of nozzle flow with adjacent surfaces – Thrust reversal – Thrust vector.
COMBUSTION CHAMBER 10
Classification of combustion chambers – Constraints of combustion chamber design – Combustion process – Combustion
chamber performance – Effect of operating variables on performance – Flame tube cooling – Flame stabilization – Use of
flame holders.
COMPRESSOR AND TURBINE 20
Principle operation of compressor – Turbine – Velocity triangles – Elementary theory of compressor and turbine blade –
Air angle distributions for free vortex and constant reaction designs – Performance characteristics.
Total Periods: 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. Hill, P.G. & Peterson C.R. “Mechanics & Thermodynamics of Propulsion”, 2nd Edition, Addison Wesley Longman,
2010.
2. Mathur M.L. and Sharma R.P, “Gas Turbine Jet and Rocket Propulsion”, Standard Publishers & Distributors
2010.
REFERENCES
1. Cohen H.Rogers G.F.C. and Saravanamuttoo H.I.H, “Gas Turbine Theory”, 5th Edition, Longman, 2002.
2. Oates G.C, “Aero thermodynamics of Aircraft Engine Components”, AIAA Education Series, 1985.
3. Rolls Royce, “Jet Engine”, 5th Edition, Rolls Royce Technical Publications, 2005.
4. V.Ganesan, “Gas Turbines”, 3rd Edition, Published by Tata McGraw Hill Education Pvt Ltd., 2010.
PREREQUISITES
16MA209 Partial differential equations and transforms
16AE206 Mechanics of Fluids
16AE211 Incompressible Aerodynamics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Solve the one dimensional compressible flow problems.
CO2 : Explain the compressible flow behaviour of air.
CO3 : Explain the characteristics of normal shock waves.
CO4 : Describe the formation of oblique shocks and expansion waves.
CO5 : Explain the behaviour of high speed flow over an airfoil.
CO6 : Understand the advanced wind tunnel techniques.
CONCEPTS OF COMPRESSIBLE FLOW 12
Adiabatic steady state flow equations – Area-Mach number – Velocity Relations – Mach cones – Mach angle – Flow
through converging diverging passages – Performance under various back pressures.
NORMAL SHOCKS AND ITS APPLICATIONS 12
Development of normal shocks – Normal shock equations – Prandtl-Hugoniot equations – Propagating and reflected
shock waves – Shock tube and shock tunnel – Modern Applications.
PREREQUISITES
16AE203 Aviation Development
16AE211 Incompressible Aerodynamics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Understand the forces and moments acting on an airplane and various parameters in level flight conditions.
CO2 : Estimate the performance of airplane in maneuvering conditions.
CO3 : Explain the concepts of longitudinal Static Stability.
CO4 : Explain rhe concepts of lateral and directional stability.
CO5 : Understand the concepts of Dynamic Stability.
CO6 : Understand the unstable modes of airplane.
PRINCIPLES OF FLIGHT 14
Physical properties and structure of the atmosphere, International Standard Atmosphere, Indian Standard Atmosphere,
Temperature, pressure and altitude relationship, Measurement of speed – True, Indicated and Equivalent air speed,
Streamlined and bluff bodies, Various Types of drag in airplanes, Drag polar, methods of drag reduction of airplanes.
FLIGHT PERFORMANCE 15
Estimation of drag co-efficient – Drag polar of vehicles from low speed to high speeds – Variation of thrust, power with
velocity and altitudes for air breathing engines – Performance of airplane in level flight – Power available and power
required curves – Maximum speed in level flight – Conditions for minimum drag and power required – Range and
endurance – Climbing and gliding flight – Turning performance – Bank angle and load factor – Pull up and Push over – V-
n diagram and load factor.
STATIC LONGITUDINAL STABILITY 10
Degree of freedom of rigid bodies in space – Static and dynamic stability – Inherently stable and marginal stable airplanes
– Static and Longitudinal stability – Stick fixed stability – Basic equilibrium equation – Stability criterion – Effects of
fuselage and nacelle – Influence of CG location – Power effects – Stick fixed neutral point – Stick free stability – Hinge
moment coefficient – Stick free neutral points – Symmetric maneuvers – Stick force gradients – Stick force per ‘g’ –
Aerodynamic balancing.
LATERAL AND DIRECTIONAL STABILITY 13
Dihedral effect – Lateral control – Coupling between rolling and yawing moments – Adverse yaw effects – Aileron
reversal – Static directional stability – Weather cocking effect – Rudder requirements – One engine inoperative condition
– Rudder lock.
DYNAMIC STABILITY 8
Introduction to dynamic longitudinal stability – Equation of motion – Modes of stability – E ffect of freeing the stick,
lateral and directional – Spiral, divergence, Dutch roll, auto rotation and spin.
Total Periods: 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. John D Anderson, “Aircraft Performance and Design”, 1st Edition, Mc Graw Hill Book Co., 1999.
2. Nelson, R.C.,”Flight Stability and Automatic Control”, 2nd Edition, Mc Graw Hill Book Co., 2007.
REFERENCES
1. Perkins, C.D., and Hage, R.E., “Airplane Performance stability and Control”, John Wiley & Son.Inc, 1988.
2. Etkin, B., “Dynamics of Flight Stability and Control”, 2nd Edition, John Wiley, 1982.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/101106041/
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/101104007/6
CURRICULUM AND SYLLABUS 275
16AE216 AIRCRAFT STRUCTURES 3104
PREREQUISITE
16AE212 Mechanics of Materials
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Evaluate crippling load of columns structures with appropriate theories.
CO2 : Solve determinate and indeterminate structures applying the moment equation.
CO3 : Evaluate the symmetrical and unsymmetrical bending of structures with appropriate theories.
CO4 : Evaluate the shear flow in open and closed sections of members of structures.
CO5 : Determine the shear flow bending with wall effective and in effective.
CO6 : Explain Buckling of plates and analysis of shear in wing and fuselage, applied to aircraft structures.
ENERGY METHODS AND COLUMNS 10
Strain Energy due to axial, bending and Torsional loads – Castigliano’s theorem – Maxwell’s Reciprocal theorem – Unit
load method – Application to beams, trusses, frames, rings – Columns with various end conditions – Euler’s Column curve
– Rankine’s formula – Column with initial curvature – Eccentric loading – South well plot – Beam column.
STATICALLY DETERMINATE AND INDETERMINATE STRUCTURES 10
Analysis of plane truss – Method of joints – 3D Truss – Plane frames – Composite beam – Clapeyron’s Three Moment
Equation – Moment Distribution Method.
SYMMETRICALAND UNSYMMETRICAL BENDING 10
Introduction to symmetrical and unsymmetrical sections – Bending stresses in beams of symmetrical and unsymmetrical
sections – Bending of symmetric sections with skew loads.
SHEAR FLOW IN OPEN AND CLOSED SECTIONS 18
Thin walled beams – Concept of shear flow, shear centre – Elastic axis with one axis of symmetry, with wall effective and
ineffective in bending – Unsymmetrical beam sections – Bredt-Batho formula – Single and multi cell structures –
Approximate methods – Shear flow in single and multicell structures under torsion – Shear flow in single and multicell
under bending with walls effective and ineffective.
BUCKLING OF PLATES AND SHEAR ANALYSIS IN WING AND FUSELAGE 12
Rectangular sheets under compression – Local buckling stress of thin walled sections – Crippling stresses by Needham’s
and Gerard’s methods – Thin walled column strength – Sheet stiffener panels – Effective width, inter rivet and sheet
wrinkling failures – Thin webbed beam – With parallel and non parallel flanges – Shear resistant web beams – Tension field
web beams (Wagner’s).
Total Periods: 60
TEXT BOOKS
1. Donaldson B.K., “Analysis of Aircraft Structures – An Introduction”, McGraw Hill, 1993.
2. Timoshenko S., “Strength of Materials”, 3rd Edition, Princeton D Von Nostrand Co., 1990.
3. Peery, D.J., and Azar, J.J., “Aircraft Structures”, 2nd Edition, Dover Publications, 2011.
REFERENCES
1. John Cutler and Jeremy Liber, “Understanding Aircraft Structures”, John Wiley & Sons, 2008.
2. Megson, T.M.G., “Aircraft Structures for Engineering Students”, Elsevier Publishers, 2007.
3. Rivello R.M., “Theory and Analysis of Flight Structures”, 2nd Edition, Mc Graw Hill, 1993.
PREREQUISITES
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
16PH207 Engineering Physics
16PH217 Aircraft Materials and Processes
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the fundamentals of composite materials.
CO2 : Explain the various methods of manufacturing composites.
CO3 : Describe the stacking orientation of laminates.
CO4 : Describe the characterization of lamina and sanwich construction.
CO5 : Explain the micro and macro mechanics approach.
CO6 : Illustrate the failure criteria of laminates.
INTRODUCTION 15
Composite: Reinforcements and matrices – Classification, advantages and disadvantages – Manufacture of fibers: Glass
fiber and Carbon fiber – Manufacturing of composites: Open mould and Closed mould composites.
LAMINATED PLATE THEORY 15
Generalized Hooke’s Law – Elastic constants reduction from anisotropic to isotropic materials – Symmetric ply, unidirectional
ply, anti-symmetric ply, angle ply and cross ply laminates – Classical lamination theory – Experimental characterization of
lamina – Sandwich construction: Basic design, materials and failure modes.
METHOD OF ANALYSIS 15
Micro mechanics – Mechanics of materials approach and elasticity approach to determine material properties – Macro
Mechanics – Stress-strain relations with respect to natural axis, arbitrary axis – Determination of material properties –
Netting Analysis – Failure criteria for composites.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Jones R.M., “Mechanics of Composite Materials”, 2nd Edition, McGraw-Hill, Kogakusha Ltd., 1985.
2. Autar K. Kaw, “Mechanics of Composite Materials”, 2nd Edition, Taylor & Francis Group, 2006.
REFERENCES
1. Agarwal B.D., and Broutman L.J., “Analysis and Performance of Fibre Composites”, 3rd Edition, John Wiley and
sons. Inc., 1995.
2. Calcote L R., “The Analysis of laminated Composite Structures”, Reprinted Editions, Von Noastrand Reinhold
Company, 2007.
3. Allen Baker, “Composite Materials for Aircraft Structures”, 2nd Edition, AIAA Series, 1999.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112104168/
2. http://nptel.ac.in/downloads/101104010/
PREREQUISITES
16MA209 Partial Differential Equations and Fourier Transform /
16MA208 Differential Equations and Numerical Methods
16AE206 Mechanics of Fluids / 16ME206 - Fluid Mechanics & Machinery
16AE207 Thermodynamics / 16ME219 - Heat Transfer
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Formulate governing partial differential equations of fluid flow and heat transfer problems.
CO2 : Understand the baskcs of finite volume method.
CO3 : Solve and find the solution to fluid dynamics problems using suitable numerical methods.
CO4 : Understand the advanced computational fluid dynamics methods in real time problems.
CO5 : Understand the basics of grid generation.
CO6 : Explain the basics of problem solving techniques of fluid dynamics using commercial solvers.
GOVERNING EQUATIONS AND BOUNDARY CONDITIONS 9
Basics of computational fluid dynamics – Governing equations of fluid dynamics – Continuity, Momentum and Energy
equations – Chemical species transport – Initial and Physical boundary conditions – Classification of partial differential
equations:Hyperbolic, Parabolic, Elliptic and Hyperbolic.
DISCRETIZATION METHODS 9
Discretization concept – Structure of discretization equation – Taylor-series Formulation – Variational Formulation –
Weighed Residual methods – Control Volume Formulation – Examples – Basics of Finite Difference, Finite Volume and
finite element approaches.
HEAT CONDUCTION 9
Finite volume formulation of steady/transient one-dimensional conduction equation – Thomas Algorithm –Source term
linearization – Incorporating boundary conditions – Finite volume formulations for Two dimensional and Three dimensional
conduction problems.
CONVECTION AND DIFFUSION 9
Finite volume formulation of steady one-dimensional Convection – Diffusion problems – Central, Upwind, Hybrid and
Power – Law schemes – Discretization equations for two dimensional convection and diffusion.
CALCULATIONS ON FLOW FIELD 9
Representation of the pressure – Gradient term and continuity equation – Staggered grid – Pressure and velocity corrections
– Pressure – Correction equation –SIMPLE algorithm and its variants. Theory of Turbulence: Turbulence energy equation
– RANS equation – Mixing length model – One equation and two equation turbulence models.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Suhas V, Patankar, “Numerical Heat Transfer and Fluid Flow”, Hemisphere, 2016.
2. Versteeg.H.K, and Malalasekera.W, “An Introduction to Computational Fluid Dynamics”, and “The Finite Volume
Method”, Longman, 2007.
REFERENCES
1. J. D. Anderson., Jr. “Computational Fluid Dynamics- The Basic with Applications”, Tata McGraw Hill Publishing
Company Pvt Ltd., 2015.
2. Wendl, “Computational Fluid Dynamics”, Yesdee Publishers, 2013.
3. Muralidhar and T. Sundarajan, “Computational Fluid Flow and Heat Transfer”, Narosa Publishing, 2014.
WEB REFERENCES
1. NPTEL Course: https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_ch02/preview
2. NPTEL Course: http://nptel.ac.in/syllabus/101106045/
278 B.E AERONAUTICAL ENGINEERING
16AE219 AVIONICS 3 0 0 3
PREREQUISITES
16AE203 Aviation Development
16AE204 Aircraft Electrical and Electronics
16AE210 Digital and Embedded Systems
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain different layers of Avionics sub system and various air data systems.
CO2 : Ability to built a digital avionics architecture and Data buss in aircraft.
CO3 : Explain the concept of cockpit display units and its operation.
CO4 : Describe the operation of Radar, Navigation System.
CO5 : Explain satellite navigation system and space system.
CO6 : Explain the concept of Autopilot system used in aircraft.
INTRODUCION OF AVIONICS AND AIR DATA SYSTEMS 10
Need of avionics systems – Integrated Avionics and Weapon Systems – Typical avionics subsystems, design requirements
– Air data quantities – Altitude, Air speed and Vertical speed – Mach number – Total air temperature – Mach warning –
Altitude warning - Data acquisition systems.
AVIONICS ARCHITECTURE AND COCKPIT DISPLAY UNIT 12
Avionics system architecture – Data buses – MIL-STD-1553B – ARINC-429 – ARINC-629 – Control and display
technologies: LED, LCD, EL and plasma panel – Touch screen – Direct voice input (DVI) – Civil and Military Cockpits:
MFDS, HUD, MFK, HOTAS.
AIRCRAFT RADAR 11
Introduction to Radar – Tracking radars – Radar applications in weapon systems – Radar types and characteristics – EW
Technology and Future Trends.
NAVIGATION AND AUTOPILOT SYSTEMS 12
Radio navigation – ADF, DME, VOR, LORAN, OMEGA and ILS – Inertial Navigation Systems (INS) – Inertial sensors and
INS block diagram – Satellite Navigation systems – Space system – Autopilot systems.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Albert Helfrick .D., “Principles of Avionics”, 8th Edition, Avionics Communications Inc., 2004
2. Collinson.R.P.G. “Introduction to Avionics”, 2nd Edition, Chapman and Hall, 1996.
REFERENCES
1. Middleton, D.H., Ed., “Avionics systems, Longman Scientific and Technical”, 3rd Edition, Longman Group UK Ltd.,
1989.
2. Cary Spitzer, Uma Ferrell, Thomas Ferrell, “Digital Avionics Systems”, 3rd Edition, Prentice-Hall, 2014.
3. Spitzer. C.R. “The Avionics Hand Book”, 2nd Edition, CRC Press, 2000.
4. Sen, A.K. Bhattacharya, A.B. “Radar Systems and Radar Aids to Navigation”, Khanna Publishers, 1988.
WEB REFERENCE
1. http://www.nptel.ac.in/syllabus/syllabus.php?subjectId=101999908.
PREREQUISITES
16PH207 Engineering Physics
16AE207 Thermodynamics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain about conductive heat transfers under steady and transient state conditions.
CO2 : Solve problems on free, forced convection systems.
CO3 : Outline rhe application of heat exchangers and the method of analysis.
CO4 : Elucidate the concept of black body radiation and radiative heat transfer.
CO5 : Explain and correlate heat transfer analysis using numerical methods approach.
CO6 : Describe about conductive and convective heat transfer using finite difference approximation.
CONDUCTION 11
Governing equation in Cartesian, cylindrical and spherical coordinates – 1-D steady state heat conduction with and
without heat generation – Composite wall – Electrical analogy – Critical thickness of insulation – Heat transfer from
extended surface – Effect of temperature on conductivity – 1-D Transient analysis – Aerodynamic heating and ablative
heat transfer in thermal protection systems.
CONVECTION 12
Review of basic equations of fluid flow – Dimensional analysis – Forced convection – Laminar flow over flat plate and
flow through pipes – Flow across tube banks – Turbulent flow over flat plate and flow through pipes – Free convection
– Heat transfer from vertical plate using integral method – Empirical relations – Types of heat exchangers – Overall heat
transfer coefficient – LMTD and NTU methods of analysis.
RADIATION 11
Basic definitions – Concept of black body – Laws of black body radiation – Radiation between black surfaces – Radiation
heat exchange between grey surfaces – Radiation shielding – Shape factor – Electrical network analogy in thermal
radiation systems.
NUMERICAL METHODS 11
1-D and 2-D steady and unsteady state heat conduction – Composite walls-heat generation – Variable thermal conductivity
– Extended surfaces analysis using finite difference method – Convective heat transfer – Stream function – Vorticity
method – Creeping flow analysis – Convection – Diffusion – 1-D and 2-D analysis using finite difference approximation
– Numerical methods applicable to radiation heat transfer.
Total Periods: 45
Note: Use of approved Heat and Mass Transfer Data Book is permitted in the examination.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Yunus A. Cengel., “Heat Transfer – A PRACTICALS approach”, 2nd Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2002.
2. Holman J.P., “Heat Transfer”, 6th Edition, McGraw-Hill Book Co.Inc., 1991.
REFERENCES
1. Sachdeva S.C., “Fundamentals of Engineering Heat & Mass Transfer”, Wiley Eastern Ltd., 1981.
2. Incropera. F.P.and Dewitt.D.P. “Introduction to Heat Transfer”, 5th Edition, John Wiley and Sons, 2002.
3. Lienhard J.H. “A Heat Transfer Text Book”, Prentice Hall Inc., 1981.
4. Sutton.G.P.,”Rocket Propulsion Elements”, 5th Edition, John Wiley and Sons, 1986.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/downloads/112108149/
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/103103032/
PREREQUISITES
16AE203 Aviation Development
16AE204 Aircraft Electrical and Electronics
16AE208 Control Systems for Aircraft Applications
16AE210 Digital and Embedded Systems
16AE219 Avionics
16AE261 Avionics Laboratory
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the components of aircrafts.
CO2 : Explain power plants used in aircraft.
CO3 : Discuss Structural components of airplane.
CO4 : Explain materials used for UAV structures.
CO5 : Discuss basic electronics concepts.
CO6 : Discuss UAV navigation and control units.
PRELIMINARY DESIGN 15
Configuration of airplane – Layout of various aircrafts – Factors affecting configuration – Stages in aircraft design – Data
Collection – Weight estimation – Weight fractions for various segments of mission – Choosing thrust and wing loading
– Choosing power plant – Location of power plant.
AIRCRAFT COMPONENT DESIGN AND PERFORMANCE ESTIMATION 15
Wing Design – Selection of airfoil, sweep and aspect ratio – Loads on wing – Tail design – Fuselage Design – Elements
of fuselage – Loads on fuselage – Drag estimation – Climbing performance – V-n Diagram – Landing and take off distance
estimation.
UAV SYSTEMS 15
Auto Pilot – Pressure sensors – Servos – Accelerometer – Gyro unit – Processor integration, Configuration and testing –
Telemetry – Way point navigation – Ground control unit – Payloads – Case Studies – Introduction to SUAVs and MAVs.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Raymer, D. P., “Aircraft Conceptuel Design”, 5th Edition, AIAA series, 2012.
2. Reg Austion, “Unmanned Aircraft Systems UAV Design, Development and Deployment”, 4th Edition, Wiley, 2010.
REFERENCES
1. Dr. Armand J. Chaput, “Design of Unmanned Air Vehicle Systems”, 2nd Edition, Lockheed Martin Aeronautics
Comapany, 2001.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the basic casting processes, forming and equipments used.
CO2 : Elucidate the various welding processes and basic conventional operations.
CO3 : Outline the various CNC Machine tools and basic CNC programming.
CO4 : Describe above CAM software packages and micro machining processes.
CO5 : Explain the fundamentals of CIM.
CO6 : Elucidate the data trasmission methods and computer communication methods in CIM.
MANUFACTURING PROCESSES 18
Patterns – Moulding Sands: Types and Properties – Core: Classification and Requirements – Core Prints – Casting:
Classification and types – Cold and hot working: Rolling, Drawing, Extrusion and Forging Processes: Operations,
Applications and Defects – Sheet Metal Cutting: Bending, Blanking, Punching and their applications –Welding:
Classification, Filler and Flux Materials, Welding Electrodes, Oxy-Acetylene Welding, TIG and MIG – Working principle
of Lathe, Milling, drilling, Reaming, Boring and Grinding operations.
CNC MACHINE TOOLS 15
Constructional features of a CNC Machine Tool, Turning Center, Milling Center – Typical CNC Machine Tools – Machining
Capabilities of a CNC Machine – Tooling for CNC Machine Tools – CNC Programming – Introduction to common CNC
controllers – Features of typical CAM software packages – Introduction to micromachining process – Micro milling and
turning.
CIM 12
CIM as a concept and a technology – CASA/SME model of CIM,CIM II – Benefits of CIM – Communication –
Matrix in CIM – Fundamentals of computer communication in CIM – CIM data transmission methods: Series,
parallel, asynchronous, synchronous, modulation, demodulation, simplex and duplex – Types of communication in CIM –
Point to point (PTP) – Star and Multiplexing.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Jon Stenerson and Kelly Curran., “Computer Numerical Control”, 3rd Edition, Prentice-Hall of India Pvt. Ltd, 2008.
2. Hajra Choudhury.S.K.,Hajra ChoudhuryA.K., “Elements of Workshop Technology”, 7th Edition, Media Promoters
and Publishers PvtLtd, 2007.
3. Mikell. P. Groover ”Automation, Production Systems and Computer Integrated Manufacturing”, 3rd Edition,
Pearson Education , 2007.
REFERENCES
1. Nagpal.G.R., “Metal Forming Processes” , 3rd Edition, Khanna Publishers, 1998.
2. SME, “Tool and Manufacturing Engineers”, Vol.2, Mcgraw Hill Book Co., 1984.
3. Heine.R.W, Loper C.R and Rosenthal P.C., “Principles of Metal Casting”, 2nd Edition,Tata McGraw Hill Publishing
Co. Ltd., 1997.
4. Richerd.R.Kibbe, John E.Neely, Roland O.Merges and Warren J.White,” Machine Tool Practices”, 3rd Edition,
Prentice Hall, 2003.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112102011/
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112105211/
PREREQUISITES
16AE206 Mechanics of Fluids
16AE211 Incompressible Aerodynamics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Determine the limitations of the wind tunnel.
CO2 : Demonstrate the experiments on two and three dimensional models.
CO3 : Demonstrate the experiments on two and three dimensional models using analysis tool.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Boundary Layer formation in the Test Section.
2. Pressure distribution over cylinder.
3. Pressure distribution over symmetric airfoil.
4. Pressure distribution over unsymmetrical airfoil.
5. Determination of Pressure distribution over airfoils using computational tools.
6. Aerodynamic forces and moments on symmetrical airfoil.
7. Aerodynamic forces and moments on unsymmetrical airfoil.
8. Determination of Aerodynamic forces and moments over airfoils using computational tools.
9. Determination of Aerodynamic coefficients of airfoils using analysis tools such as XFLR.
10. Determination of elementary flow using MATLAB
WEB REFERENCE
1. http://vlab.amrita.edu/?sub=77&brch=297
PREREQUISITES
16AE207 Thermodynamics
16AE213 Propulsion
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Demonstrate the experiments on a heat exchanger
CO2 : Demonstrate the experiments on free and forced convection heat transfer over flat plate.
CO3 : Experiment the studies of free and wall jets.
CO4 : Calibrate the shock tube for various conditions.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Determination of effectiveness of a parallel flow heat exchanger
2. Determination of effectiveness of a counter flow heat exchanger
3. Determination of Thermal Resistance of a Composite wall.
4. Determination of free convective heat transfer over a flat plate.
5. Determination of forced convective heat transfer over a flat plate.
6. Determination of performance of a variable pitch propeller.
7. Measurement of speed of a shock wave using shock tube.
8. Measurement of pressure and temperature across the shock wave.
9. Supersonic flow over a blunt body using shock tunnel
10. Determination of velocity profiles of free jet and wall jet.
REFERENCES
1. Hill, P. G. & Peterson C. R. “Mechanics & Thermodynamics of Propulsion”, 2nd Edition Addison Wesley Longman
INC, 2010.
2. Mathur M. L. and Sharma R. P, “Gas Turbine Jet and Rocket Propulsion”, Standard Publishers and Distributors
2010.
3. Cohen H. Rogers G.F.C. and Saravanamuttoo H.I.H, “Gas Turbine Theory”, 5th Edition, Longman, 2002.
4. Nag P. K., “Engineering Thermodynamics”, 5th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill, 2013.
5. Rajput R.K., “Heat and Mass Transfer”, 5th Edition, S.Chand Publications, 2012.
PREREQUISITE
16AE209 Aircraft Safety and Maintenance Practices
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the positioning of aircraft for maintenance procedures.
CO2 : Demonstrate the dimensional and NDT checks on aircraft engines.
CO3 : Demonstrate the starting procedure of aircraft piston engines.
CO4 : Demonstrate the various patch repairs on airframe.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
AERO ENGINE MAINTENANCE
1. Dimensional check of the aircraft
2. Aircraft jacking procedure
3. Aircraft symmetric check procedure
4. Starting procedure for an aircraft piston engine
5. Aircraft engine dimensional checks and NDT checks
AIRFRAME MAINTENANCE
6. Aircraft Wood gluing
7. Repair of Sandwich composites
8. Fabric patch repair
9. Riveted patch repair
10. Sheet metal forming
PREREQUISITES
16AE212 Mechanics of Materials
16AE216 Aircraft Structures
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : use the computational tools for analyzing the stresses on any structural material.
CO2 : simulate the structural and non-structural elements by coding.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
ANALYSIS EXPERIMENTS
1. Stress analysis for different beams.
2. Plane stress analysis over a plate with a central hole.
3. Structural analysis of columns.
4. Structural analysis of a tapered wing.
5. Structural analysis of a composite laminate structure.
CODING EXPERIMENTS
6. Strain displacement of a one dimensional bar element.
7. Structural deflection of a truss.
8. Structural analysis of axially loaded bar.
9. Thermal analysis of an axially loaded bar.
10. Heat transfer through a composite wall.
PREREQUISITE
16AE254 Mechanical Sciences Laboratory
COURSE OUTCOME
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Demonstrate the experiments relevant to Aircraft Structures.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Deflection of a cantilever beam.
2. Deflection of a simply supported beam.
3. Deflection of beams with different end conditions.
4. Determination of Young’s modulus of aluminium using mechanical extensometers.
5. Unsymmetrical bending of Z-section beams.
6. Shear centre location for channel section.
7. Shear centre location for ‘L’ section.
8. Flexibility matrix for cantilever beam.
9. Stresses in circular discs and beams using photo elastic techniques.
10. Wagner beam- Tension field beam.
PREREQUISITES
16AE203 Aviation Development
16AE204 Aircraft Electrical and Electronics
16AE210 Digital and Embedded Systems
16AE219 A vionics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will able to
CO1 : Demonstrate the operation of avionics data bus MIL Std 1553
CO2 : Use the avionics component and analyze using avionic simulator
CO3 : Demonstrate the operations of transducers using Lab VIEW.
CO4 : Demonstrate the operations of transducers using Arduino C.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
AVIONICS DATA BUSES
1. MIL-Std – 1553 Data Buses Configuration with Message transfer.
2. MIL-Std – 1553 Remote Terminal Configuration.
AVIONICS SIMULATORS
3. Design & Demonstrate Pitch Attitude, altitude hold with autopilot by giving suitable rate of climb.
4. Design and demonstrate bank angle hold, hedging hold, yaw damper
5. Find the ILS operation and response during localizer and glide slope signals on the approach in final course into
an airport using simulator to support lateral and vertical navigation down to the runway threshold
6. Find the VOR radial in which the aircraft is flying and to record the magnetic heading to reach the VOR by twisting
the OBS (Omni bearing selector) of VOR1Demonstrate pitch attitude in autopilot by selecting rate of climb
7. Find the nearest airport ident and program the GPS for a direct routing to nearest or next nearest airport. Also find
the distance to nearest airport on GP-500
SIMULATION USING LABVIEW
8. Inductive Transducers – LVDT.
9. Variable resistivity transducers – Strain Gauge.
10. Measurement of temperature – Thermocouple.
PROGRAM USING ARDUINO C
11. Interfacing Ultrasonic Sensor, PIR Sensor, Temperature Sensor.
12. Interfacing Accelerometer, Gyroscope.
PREREQUISITES
16AE253 Computer aided drawing and modeling Laboratory
16AE206 Mechanics of Fluids
16AE211 Incompressible Aerodynamics
16AE255 Aerodynamics Laboratory
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Simulate the computational tools for the different flows over various objects.
CO2 : Utilize the computational tools to analyze the heat conduction and convection in a material.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Simulation of flow over a wedge and a circular cylinder Using Open FOAM and MATLAB.
2. Simulation of flow over an aerofoil Using Open FOAM and MATLAB.
3. Simulation of flow through a Converging-diverging nozzle Using Open FOAM.
4. Simulation of flow through an axial flow compressor blade passage Using ANSYS Fluent.
5. Simulation of supersonic flow over a wing of biconvex cross section Using ANSYS Fluent.
6. Simulation of through an axial flow turbine blade passage Using ANSYS Fluent.
7. Simulation of hot gas flow through subsonic and supersonic diffusers Using ANSYS Fluent.
8. Thermal analysis of heat conduction throughout the beam Using ANSYS Fluent.
9. Thermal analysis of heat transfer from the solid plate to the environment Using ANSYS Fluent.
10. Thermal analysis of heat convection from a closed composite wall Using ANSYS Fluent.
REFERENCES
1. Anderson J. D., “Computational Fluid Dynamics - The Basic with Applications”, 4th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill
Publishing Company Pvt Ltd., 2015.
2. Suhas V and Patankar, “Numerical Heat Transfer and Fluid Flow”, Revised Edition, Hemisphere, 2016.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://www.openfoam.com/
2. http://www.ansys.com/Products/Fluids/ANSYS-Fluent
3. https://in.mathworks.com/support/learn-with-matlabtutorials.html?requestedDomain=www.mathworks.com
PREREQUISITES
16AE252 Aero Engineering Workshop
16AE215 Flight Dynamics
16AE216 Aircraft Structures
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : To carry out preliminary design of aircraft configuration
CO2 : To carry out preliminary structural design of aircraft components
CO3 : To estimate aircraft performance and stability parameters.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Comparative study of the different type of the airplanes and their specifications, selection of key parameters
2. Preliminary weight estimation using MATLAB and Power plant selection,
3. Design of wing and Tail using MATLAB
4. Estimation of drag and rate of climb
5. Take off and landing distance calculations, V-n diagram
6. Estimation of Stability parameters
7. Design of structural components of wing
8. Design of structural components of fuselage
9. Layout preparation
10. Fabrication of Model aircraft
PREREQUISITES
16AE203 Aviation Development
16AE204 Aircraft Electrical and Electronics
16AE208 Control Systems for Aircraft Applications
16AE210 Digital and Embedded Systems
16AE219 Avionics
16AE261 Avionics Laboratory
16AE222 UAV System Design
COURSE OUTCOME
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Fabricate a radio controlled aircraft and use raspberry pi to control actuators
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Introduction to various UAVs (Fixed wing, Rotary wing and flapping wing)
2. Introduction to Auto pilot and its various subsystems
3. Study on Electronic equipment used in Radio Control Aircraft.
4. Sizing analysis of Radio control aircraft using computer programs.
5. Fabrication of Fuselage.
6. Fabrication of Wing and Tail.
7. Integration of Radio Control UAV.
8. Training in piloting using computer simulation software.
9. Flight testing of built model.
PREREQUISITE
16ME205 Engineering Mechanics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Recognize the kinematic chain and mobility for given mechanism.
CO2 : Explain the friction in screw, nut and belt drives.
CO3 : Demonstrate power transmission in gears and explain the procedure to design of cams.
CO4 : Describe the balancing principles and techniques to control it.
MECHANISMS 12
Fundamental concepts of Link, Pair, Chain, Mechanism, Machine and Structure, Degrees of freedom – Gruebler’s criteria
– Kutzback Criterian, Grashoff’s Law – Inversions of Four bar and Slider Crank Mechanisms – Determination of velocity
(relative velocity method) and acceleration in slider crank mechanism.
FRICTION 11
Friction in screw threads – Pivot and collar – Thrust bearing – Belt (flat and V) and rope drives – Ratio of tensions – Effect
of centrifugal and initial tension – Condition for maximum power transmission – Open and crossed belt drive.
GEARS AND CAMS 11
Nomenclature of spur gears – Gear trains: Simple compound and epicyclic gear trains – Cams – Types – Design of profiles
– Knife edged roller and flat face ended followers with and without offsets for various types of follower motions.
BALANCING AND GOVERNORS 11
Introduction – Balancing of a simple mass rotating in same plane – Different planes – Balancing of several masses rotating
in same plane – Different planes – Swaying couple – Hammer Blow – Balancing of V engines. Governors – Types – Watt,
Porter and Proell Governors.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Pennock, Shigley J.E. and Uicker J.J. “Theory of Machines and Mechanisms”, Oxford University Press, 2014.
2. Rattan.S.S “Theory of Machines”, 2nd Edition, Tata McGraw Hill Publishing & Co., 2004.
REFERENCES
1. Gosh A. and Mallick A.K. “Theory of Machines and Mechanisms”, East West, 2008.
2. John Joseph Uicker, “Theory of machines and mechanisms”, Oxford university Press, 2010.
3. Ballaney P.L , “Theory of Machines and mechanisms”, Khanna publishers, 2003.
4. Anup Goel, “Theory of Machines & Mechanisms”, 1st Edition, Technical Publications, 2016.
WEB REFERENCE
1. http://www.nptelvideos.in/2012/12/kinematics-of-machines.html.
PREREQUISITE
16PH217 Aircraft Materials and Processes
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the creep behavior and the resistance to creep.
CO2 : Classify the types of fracture at different environmental conditions.
CO3 : Identify the reason of oxidation and defects of corrosion.
CO4 : Illustrate the processing methods to strengthen the materials.
CREEP 15
Factors influence functional life of components at elevated temperatures – Various stages of creep –Metallurgical factors
influencing various stages – Design of creep: Hardening, Strain hardening, Expressions of rupture life of creep, Ductile
and brittle materials and Monkman-Grant relationship.
HIGH TEMPERATURE FRACTURE AND CORROSION 15
Various types of fracture – Brittle to ductile from low temperature to high temperature – Cleavage fracture – Ductile
fracture due to micro void coalescence – Fracture maps for different alloys and oxides – Oxidation: Definition, Pilling-
Bedworth ratio, Kinetic laws of oxidation – Hot gas corrosion deposit – Modified hot gas corrosion – Effect of alloying
elements on hot corrosion – Methods of combat hot corrosion.
STRENGTHENING OF MATERIALS 15
Iron base, Nickel base and Cobalt base super alloys – Composition control – Solid solution strengthening – Precipitation
hardening – Grain boundary strengthening – TCP phase – Embrittlement – Solidification of single crystals – Intermetallics
– High temperature ceramics.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Courtney T.H., “Mechanical Behavior of Materials”, 2nd Edition, McGraw-Hill, 1990.
2. Hertzberg R. W. “Deformation and Fracture Mechanics of Engineering materials”, 4th Edition, John Wiley, 1996.
REFERENCES
1. Boyle J.T., Spencer J., “Stress Analysis for Creep”, Butterworths, 1983.
2. Bressers. J., “Creep and Fatigue in High Temperature Alloys”, Applied Science, 1981.
3. McLean D., “Directionally Solidified Materials for High Temperature Service”, The Metals Society, 1985.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/122102008/.
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/113106032/.
PREREQUISITES
16AE203 Aviation Development
16AE211 Incompressible Aerodynamics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the structure of atmosphere and assess the wind resource availability.
CO2 : Describe the various modern wind energy convertor concepts.
CO3 : Solve the design parameters of a wind turbine using computational tools.
CO4 : Recognize the impact of wind turbines on the environment.
THEATMOSPHERE 9
Atmospheric circulation – Local winds – Atmospheric boundary layer – Governing equations – Mean velocity profiles –
Power law and logarithmic law wind speeds – Atmospheric turbulence profiles – Wind resource assessment.
WIND ENERGY CONVERTOR CONCEPTS 18
Windmills – Horizontal and vertical axis rotors – Tubercles wind rotors – Artificial vortex concept – Venturi effect
machines – Wind energy concentrators – Solar wind turbine concept – Magnus Flettner turbine – Thom and Lesh rotor
– Multi rotor concept – Downdraft tower concept – Airborne wind turbine – Offshore wind turbine.
WIND TURBINE DESIGN 18
Rotor aerodynamics – Elementary momentum theory – Blade element theory – Power characteristics – Aerodynamic
power control – Airfoils – Rotor design features – PROPID – Loads on the wind turbine – Sources of loading – Design
load assumptions – Structural stresses in Wind Turbine.
ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACT 9
Biological impact – Shadow flicker – Sound impact – Measurement, prediction and assessment – Communication impact
– Effect on climate – Impact on people – Safety.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Ahmed S., “Wind Energy: Theory and Practice”, 3rd Edition, PHI Learning, 2015.
2. Erich Hau, “Wind Turbines”, 3rd Edition, Springer, 2005.
REFERENCES
1. Pramod J., “Wind Energy Engineering”, 1st Edition, McGraw-Hill, 2011.
2. Mathew S., “Advances in Wind Energy Conversion Technology”, 1st Edition, Springer, 2011.
WEB REFERENCE
1. NPTEL Course: Energy Resources & Technology: http://nptel.ac.in/courses/108105058/21#.
PREREQUISITES
16AE203 Aviation Development
16AE211 Incompressible Aerodynamics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the various configurations and design features of helicopters
CO2 : Describe the rotor aerodynamics of a helicopter.
CO3 : Predict the performance of a helicopter in forward and vertical flight.
CO4 : Describe the operating methods of Ground Effect Vehicles, V/STOL Aircrafts and Rotorcrafts.
HELICOPTER CONFIGURATION 14
Helicopter components – Configuration – Control requirements – Collective and cyclic pitch control – Flapping and
feathering – Power plants – Defence services in India – HAL Rudra and Kamov Ka-27.
AERODYNAMICS AND PERFORMANCE CHARACTERISTICS 17
Characteristics of helicopter rotor – Momentum theory – Blade element theory – Performance in forward flight and vertical
flight – Power requirements – Induced, profile and parasitic power.
GEM, V/STOL AND ROTORCRAFTS 14
Ground effect vehicles – Classification – Hovercrafts – Introduction to V/STOL aircrafts – configurations – Classification
of rotorcrafts – Operating principle – Applications.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Prouty R. W., “Helicopter Aerodynamics”, 2nd Edition, Shroff Publications, 2004.
2. Franklin D. H., “Introduction to Autogyros, Helicopters and other V/STOL Aircraft”, NASA Centre for Aerospace
Information, 2011.
REFERENCES
1. Seddon J. M. and Newman S., “Basic Helicopter Aerodynamics”, 3rd Edition, John Wiley & Sons, 2011.
2. Gessow A. and Meyers G. C., “Aerodynamics of Helicopter”, 1st Edition, Macmillan & Co., 1999.
3. Johnson W., “Helicopter Theory”, 1st Edition, Dover Publications, 1995.
WEB REFERENCE
1. NPTEL Course:Introduction to Helicopter Aerodynamics and Dynamics:http://nptel.ac.in/courses/101104017/
PREREQUISITES
16AE203 Aviation Development
16AE211 Incompressible Aerodynamics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Identify the atmospheric boundary layer and the types of wind turbines.
CO2 : Analyse the aerodynamics of road vehicles.
CO3 : Analyse the aerodynamics of buildings.
CO4 : Understand the real-life problems due to flow induced vibrations.
ATMOSPHERE AND WIND ENERGY 11
Types of winds – Atmospheric boundary layer – Turbulence profiles – Horizontal and vertical axis wind turbines – Power
coefficient – Betz limit – Wind power in India.
VEHICLE AERODYNAMICS 12
Major forces acting on vehicles – Power requirements and drag coefficients of automobiles – Effects of cut back angle –
Automotive wind tunnel.
BUILDING AERODYNAMICS 12
Pressure distribution on low rise buildings – Wind forces on buildings – Special problems of tall buildings – Ventilation
and architectural aerodynamics.
FLOW INDUCED VIBRATIONS 10
Effects of Reynolds number on wake formation of bluff shapes – Vortex-induced vibrations – Galloping and stall flutter –
Overview on Aeroacoustics.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Ahmed S., “Wind Energy: Theory and Practice”, 3rd Edition, PHI Learning, 2015.
2. Lawson T., “Building Aerodynamics”, 1st Edition, Imperial College, 2010.
REFERENCES
1. Sovran G., “Aerodynamics and Drag Mechanisms of Bluff Bodies and Road Vehicles”, 1st Edition, Springer, 2012.
2. Blevins R. D., “Flow-Induced Vibrations”, 2nd Edition, Krieger Publishing Company, 2006.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the working principles of modern control systems used in aircraft.
CO2 : Describe the working principle of engine systems of the aircraft.
CO3 : Describe the working principle of auxiliary system of the aircraft.
CO4 : Describe the operations of various instruments used in aircraft.
AIRPLANE CONTROL TECHNIQUES 10
Conventional Systems – Power actuated systems – Engine control systems – Push pull rod system – Components –
Modern control systems – Digital fly by wire systems – Automatic flight control System –Intelligent flight control system
– Communication and Navigation systems – Radio navigation System – Inertial navigation system – Global positioning
system – Instrument landing systems and VOR System.
ENGINE AND AUXILLIARY SYSTEMS 20
Hydraulic systems – Modes of operation – Pneumatic systems – Working principles – Brake system – Landing Gear
systems – Shock absorbers – Retractive mechanism – Fuel systems and Lubricating systems for piston and jet engines –
Starting and Ignition systems – Stall warning system – Ground proximity warning system – Traffic collision avoidance
system – Oxygen systems – Fire protection systems Deicing and anti icing systems.
AIRCRAFT INSTRUMENTS AND COCKPIT LAYOUTS 15
Flight Instruments and Navigation Instruments – Gyroscope – Accelerometers – Air speed Indicators – TAS EAS – Mach
Meters – Altimeters – Principles and operation – Aircraft display types – Glass cockpits of modern aircrafts – Electronic
flight instrument system – Study of various types of engine instruments – Tachometers – Temperature gauges – Pressure
gauges – Operation and Principles – Product manufacturers in India and in abroad.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Kross and Watkins, “Aircraft Maintenance & Repair”, 7th Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2010.
2. Nagabhushana.S and Sudha.L.K, “Aircraft Instrumentation and Systems”, 1st Edition, IK International, 2010.
REFERENCES
1. Mekinley J.L. and Bent R.D. “Aircraft Power Plants”, McGraw-Hill, 1993.
2. Treager S, “Gas Turbine Technology”, McGraw-Hill, 1997.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the assumptions in elasticity and explain stress- strain relation and various moduli.
CO2 : Describe principles, stresses and strains and Solve plane stress and strain problems.
CO3 : Describe the use of polar coordinates and its applications.
CO4 : Apply torsion theories for shafts to solve the problems.
BASIC EQUATIONS OF ELASTICITY 10
Definition of Stress and Strain: Stress – Strain relationships – Equations of Equilibrium – Compatibility equations –
Boundary Conditions – Saint Venant’s principle – Principal Stresses – Stress Ellipsoid – Stress invariants.
PLANE STRESS AND PLANE STRAIN PROBLEMS 20
Airy’s stress function – Bi-harmonic equations – Polynomial solutions – Simple two dimensional problems in Cartesian
coordinates like bending of cantilever and simply supported beams.
POLAR COORDINATES AND TORSION 15
Equations of equilibrium – Strain – Displacement relations – Stress-strain relations – Airy’s stress function – Axi-
symmetric problems – Curved beam analysis – Lame’s, Michell’s and Boussinesque problems –
Navier’s theory – St. Venant’s theory – Prandtl’s theory on torsion and applications to shafts of circular –Equilateral
triangular and rectangular sections.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Timoshenko, S., and Goodier, T.N., “Theory of Elasticity”, 3rd Edition, McGraw Hill Education Pvt. Ltd., 2010.
2. Bhaskar, K., and Varadan, T. K., “Theory of Isotropic/Orthotropic Elasticity An Introuductory Primer”, ANE Books,
2009.
REFERENCES
1. Sadhu Singh.S “Theory of Elasticity”, Khanna Publishers, 2002.
2. Landau “Theory of Elasticity” volume 7, 3rd Edition, CBS Publishers and Distributers, 2005.
3. Atkin R “An Introduction to the Theory of Elasticity”, Dover Publications Inc., 2005
4. “Elasticity: Theory and Applications”, Chenvei Publishers, 2nd Edition, 2014.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the classical plate theory and solve problems on rectangular plates with different boundary conditions.
CO2 : Describe the problems on axis symmetric loads and simple vibrations of rectangular plates.
CO3 : Describe the behavior of rectangular plates by approximate methods.
CO4 : Describe the cylindrical shells using membrane bending theories.
CLASSICAL PLATE THEORY 16
Classical Plate Theory – Assumptions – Differential Equation – Boundary Conditions – Navier’s Method of Solution for
Simply Supported Rectangular Plates – Leavy’s Method of Solution for Rectangular Plates under Different Boundary
Conditions – Governing Equation – Solution for Axi-symmetric loading – Annular Plates – Plates of other shapes.
ANALYTICAL METHODS 17
Eigen Value Analysis – Stability and free Vibration Analysis of Rectangular Plates – Approximate Methods – Rayleigh –
Ritz – Galerkin Methods – Finite Difference Method – Application to Rectangular Plates for Static Free Vibration and
Stability Analysis.
SHELLS 12
Basic Concepts of Shell Type of Structures – Membrane and Bending Theories for Circular Cylindrical and Conical Shells.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Timoshenko S.P. Winowsky. S.,”Theory of Plates and Shells”, 2nd Edition, McGraw-Hill Book Co., 1990.
2. Reddy.J.N, “Theory and Analysis of Elastic Plates and Shells”, 2nd Edition, CRC Press, 1992.
REFERENCES
1. Timoshenko S.P. and Gere J.M, “Theory of Elastic Stability”, McGraw-Hill Book Co.,1986.
2. Flugge W. “Stresses in Shells”, Springer, 1985.
PREREQUISITES
16CH203 Engineering Chemistry
16AE207 Thermodynamics
16AE213 Propulsion
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain about the fundamentals of chemical kinetics in combustion and an overview about flames.
CO2 : Explain about radiation and combustion in gas turbine engines.
CO3 : Explain about the propellants used for combustion in rockets.
CO4 : Explain about supersonic combustion and the combustion mixing.
FUNDAMENTAL CONCEPTS IN COMBUSTION CHEMICAL KINETICS AND FLAMES 15
Thermo-chemical equations – Heat of reaction first order second order and third order reactions – Premixed flames –
Diffusion flames – Measurement of burning velocity – Various methods – Effect of various parameters on burning
velocity – Flame stability – Detonation – Deflagration – Rankine - Hugoniot curve – Radiation by flames.
COMBUSTION IN GAS TURBINE ENGINES 12
Combustion in gas turbine combustion chambers – Re-circulation – Combustion efficiency – Factors affecting combustion
efficiency – Fuels used for gas turbine combustion chambers – Combustion stability – Flame holder types – Numerical
problems.
COMBUSTION IN ROCKETS AND SUPERSONIC COMBUSTION 18
Solid propellant combustion – Double base and composite propellant combustion – Various combustion models
Combustion in liquid rocket engines – Single fuel droplet combustion model – Combustion in hybrid rockets –Introduction
– Supersonic combustion controlled by mixing diffusion and heat convection – Analysis of reaction and mixing processes
– Supersonic burning with detonation shocks.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Sharma S.P. and Chandra Mohan, “Fules and Combustion”, 1st Edition, Tata McGraw Hill Publishing Co., Lt 1987.
2. Loh W.H.T. Jet Rocket Nuclear Ion and Electric Propulsion Theory and Design, 2nd Edition, Springer, 1982.
REFERENCES
1. Beer J.M. and Chigier N.A, “Combustion Aerodynamics Applied Science”, Standard Publishers Ltd., 1981.
2. Chowdhury R, “Applied Engineering Thermodynamics”, Khanna Publishers, 1986.
3. Sutton G.P, “Rocket Propulsion Elements”, John Wiley and Sons Inc., 1993.
4. Mathur M and Sharma R.P. “Gas turbines and Jet and Rocket Propulsion”, Standard Publishers, 1988.
PREREQUISITES
16AE206 Mechanics of Fluids
16AE211 Incompressible Aerodynamics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Summarize the classification, layouts and design parameters of wind tunnel.
CO2 : Describe various types of balances and calibration of wind tunnel.
CO3 : Explain various wind tunnel instrumentation to measure flow parameters and tell flow visualization techniques.
INTRODUCTION TO WIND TUNNEL 15
Wind tunnels – Similarly considerations – Types of wind tunnels and their Characteristic features – Operation and
performance – Layouts – Sizing and design parameters.
CALIBRATION OF WIND TUNNELS AND BALANCES 15
Test section speed – Horizontal buoyancy – Flow angularities – Turbulence measurements – Six component balances –
External and Internal balances.
INSTRUMENTS AND FLOW VISUALIZATION TECHNIQUES 15
Pressure and velocity measurements – Force measurements – Smoke and Tuft grid techniques – Dye injection special
techniques – Optical methods of flow visualization.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Barlow, J. B., Rae Jr, W. H., and Pope, A., “Low-Speed Wind Tunnel Testing”, 3rd Edition, Wiley, 1999.
2. Rathakrishnan. E,”Instrumentation, Measurement and Experiments in Fluids”, CRC Press, 2007.
REFERENCES
1. Barlow, J. B., Rae Jr, W. H., and Pope, A., “High-Speed Wind Tunnel Testing”, 3rd Edition, Wiley, 1999.
2. Pankhrust and Ower, “Measurement of Airflow”, 5th Edition, Elsevier, Pergamon Press. 2000.
WEB REFERENCE
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/101106040/.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to,
CO1 : Identify the unique properties of nano materials.
CO2 : Evaluate and implement nano materials synthesis strategies.
CO3 : Fabricate standalone and composite materials for various applications in Aeronautical Engineering.
INTRODUCTION 9
History of nanotechnology – Basic principles of nano scale materials – Surface to volume ratio – Size dependent properties
at nanoscale – Classification of nanostructures – Nanotechnology: Necessity, Economics, Environmental influences and
Ethics – Nanotechnology products in market with examples.
FABRICATION 9
Dip coating - Spin coating – Electroplating – Electroless plating – Doctor blade coating – Sputter deposition – Chemical
vapor deposition – Screen Printing – Inkjet Printing.
NANOCOMPOSITES 9
High strength polymers – Composites – Nanofillers – Synergistic effect – Unique Properties of nanocomposites: Mechanical,
Thermal and Optical – Types of nanocomposites – Naturally Inspired nanocomposites – Application of nanocomposites
– Methods of production: Mechanical alloying, Template assisted synthesis and Hydrothermal method.
APPLICATIONS I 9
High strength materials – Carbon nanostructures – Corrosion prevention – Water repellent and insulating paints –
Foldable light weight solar cells – Superconducting magnets in transportation – Nanosensors – Solid Batteries.
APPLICATIONS II 9
Hydrogen fuel: storage and harvesting – Emission control – Nano lubricants – Nanoengines – Nanofluidics – Space
applications – Smart and functional fabrics – Fire retardant and insulating materials – Electrochromic glasses – Self
healing materials – Shape memory alloys – Aerogels.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOK
1. Hornyak G L, Tibbals H.F, Dutta J, Moore J J, “Introduction to Nanoscience and Nanotechnology”, CRC Press,
2008.
REFERENCES
1. Ratner M, Ratner D., “Nanotechnology: A Gentle Introduction to the Next Big Idea” Prentice Hall Professional,
2003.
2. Cao G Z, Wang Y, “Nanostructures& Nanomaterials: Synthesis, Properties & Applications”, 2nd Edition, World
Scientific Publishing, 2011.
3. Lindsay S M., “Introduction to Nanoscience”, Oxford University Press Inc., 2010.
4. Mancini L H, Esposito C L., “Nanocomposites: Preparation, Properties and Performance”, Nova Science Publisher
Inc., 2008.
5. Bandhyopadyay A K., “Nanomaterials” NewAge International (P) Ltd., Publishers, 2008.
PREREQUISITES
16AE207 Thermodynamics
16AE213 Propulsion
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO 1 : Apply classical thermodynamics principles to various cryogenics systems.
CO 2 : Calculate the rate of heat transfer for various cryogenic systems.
CO 3 : Design typical cryogenic insulation system for space propulsion.
CO 4 : Analyze the performance parameters of cryogenic rockets and apply general safety principles.
BASIC PRINCIPLES 8
Introduction to Cryogenics and superconductivity – Applications of Cryogenics – Common Cryogens and their properties
– Cryogenic rockets – Thermodynamic analysis of low temperature systems – Basic principles of low temperature heat
transfer, Cryogenic liquefaction process.
CRYOGENIC HEAT TRANSFER 12
Basic modes of heat transfer: Conduction, Convection and Radiation in cryogenic systems in steady and unsteady
conditions – Temperature dependent thermal conductivity, Boiling and two phase flow, Pool and film boiling of cryogenic
fluids – Thermal contact resistance: Unique problems of heat transfer in cryogenic applications.
Thermo-physical properties of cryogenic systems: PVT behavior of a pure substance – Mechanical properties of materials
used in cryogenic systems – Prediction of thermodynamic properties, ultra-low temperature refrigerators, Cry coolers.
CRYO INSULATION AND DEVICES 10
Storage vessel – Thermal shields and insulation – Effect of size and shape of storage vessel on heating leak – Vapour
shielding, Vacuum insulation, Evacuated porous insulation, Solid foams, Multilayer insulation, Composite insulation,
Critical radius of insulation – Micro-sphere insulation – Typical insulation systems for space propulsion – Aerogel beds
– Light density Mylar – Comparison of insulations.
PERFORMANCE ANALYSIS OF CRYOGENIC ROCKETS AND SAFETY 15
Design concepts of cryogenic rockets – Selection of propellants and its challenges – Boil-off rate – Tank pressurization
and vent system – Two-phase flow and heat transfer in reduced gravity – Process design parameters and launch window
– Physiological hazards – Explosions and flammability – Excessive pressure gas, suitability of materials and construction
techniques, safety considerations for liquid hydrogen and liquid oxygen – General safety principles.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Thomas M. Flynn, “Cryogenic Engineering”, 2nd Edition, CRC Press, Taylor and Francis Inc., 2004.
2. Barron, R., “Cryogenic Systems”, 2nd Edition, Oxford Science Publications, Oxford University Press, 1985.
REFERENCES
1. Barron, R.F, “Cryogenic Heat Transfer”, Philadelphia, PA: Taylor and Francis Publishers, 1999.
2. Augustynowicz, S.D. and Fesmire, J.E., “Cryogenic Insulation System for Soft Vacuum”, Advances on Cryogenic
Engineering, Vol. 45, Kluwer Academic / Plenum Publishers.
3. Mamata Mukhopadhyay, “Fundamentals of Cryogenic Engineering”, Prentice Hall India Pvt Ltd., 2010.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the physical aspects of fatigue.
CO2 : Determine the low cycle and high cycle fatigue behavior with appropriate theories.
CO3 : Explain the fatigue behavior of a structure and its statistical aspects.
CO4 : Define the fatigue theories and safe design of aerospace structures.
PHYSICAL ASPECTS OF FATIGUE AND STRUCTURES 16
Phase in fatigue life – Crack initiation – Crack growth – Final Fracture – Dislocations – Fatigue fracture surfaces – S.N.
curves – Endurance limits – Effect of mean stress, Goodman, Gerber and Soderberg relations and diagrams – Notches and
stress concentrations – Neuber’s stress concentration factors – Plastic stress concentration factors – Notched S.N.
curves.
STATISTICAL ASPECTS OF FATIGUE BEHAVIOUR 14
Low cycle and high cycle fatigue – Coffin - Manson’s relation – Transition life – Cyclic strain hardening and softening –
Analysis of load histories – Cycle counting techniques – Cumulative damage – Miner’s theory – Other theories.
FRACTURE MECHANICS AND DESIGN 15
Strength of cracked bodies – Potential energy and surface energy – Griffith’s theory – Orwin extension of Griffith’s theory
to ductile materials – Stress analysis of cracked bodies – Effect of thickness on fracture toughness – Stress intensity
factors for typical geometries – Safe life and Fail-safe design philosophies – Importance of Fracture Mechanics in
aerospace structures – Applica-tion to composite materials and structure.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Prasanth Kumar ,”Elements of fracture mechanics”,Wheeter publication, 2014.
2. Barrois W, Ripely, E.L., “Fatigue of aircraft structure”, Pergamon press, 1983.
REFERENCES
1. Anderson. T.L, “Fracture Mechanics” 3 rd Edition, Taylor & Francis Group, 2005.
2. Tribrikram Kundu., “Fundamentals of Fracture Mechanics”, Taylor & Francis Group, 2008.
PREREQUISITES
16AE203 Aviation Development
16ME205 Engineering Mechanics
16AE215 Flight Dynamics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the basic concepts of space mechanics and general body problems.
CO2 : Describe the satellite orbits and the concepts of injections & orbit perturbation of satellites.
CO3 : Explain interplanetary trajectories.
CO4 : Explain Space environment and selection of space craft materials.
BASIC CONCEPTS 6
The Solar System – References Frames and Coordinate Systems – The Celestial Sphere – The Ecliptic – Motion of Vernal
Equinox – Sidereal Time – Solar Time – Standard Time – The Earth’s Atmosphere.
THE GENERAL N-BODY PROBLEM 9
The many body Problem – Lagrange - Jacobian Identity – The Circular Restricted Three Body Problem – Libration Points
– Relative Motion in the N-body Problem – Two - Body Problem – Satellite Orbits – Relations
Between Position and Time – Orbital Elements.
SATELLITE INJECTION AND SATELLITE ORBIT PERTURBATIONS 10
General Aspects of satellite Injections – Satellite Orbit Transfer – Various Cases – Orbit Deviations Due to Injection Errors
– Special and General Perturbations – Cowell’s Method – Encke’s Method – Method of vibrations of Orbital Elements –
General Perturbations Approach.
INTERPLANETARY TRAJECTORIES 20
Two Dimensional Interplanetary Trajectories – Fast Interplanetary Trajectories – Three Dimensional Interplanetary
Trajectories – Launch if Interplanetary Spacecraft – Trajectory about the Target Planet – The Boost Phase – The Ballistic
Phase – Trajectory Geometry – Optimal Flights – Time of Flight – Re-entry Phase – The Position of the Impact Point –
Influence Coefficients – Space Environment – Peculiarities – Effect of Space Environment on the Selection of Spacecraft
Material.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Cornelisse J.W,”Rocket Propulsion and Space Dynamics”, 3rd Edition, W.H Freeman & Co, 1984.
2. Parker E.R, “Materials for Missiles and Spacecraft”, 4th Edition, McGraw Hill, 1982.
REFERENCES
1. Sutton.G.P, “Rocket Propulsion Elements”, 8th Edition, JohnWiley, 2010.
2. Van de Kamp.P.,”Elements of Astromechanics”, Reprint Editon, Pitman, 1979.
WEB REFERENCE
1. http://www.nptelvideos.in/2012/11/space-flight-mechanics.html
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the working and operation of extensometers.
CO2 : Describe the concept of Photoelasticity.
CO3 : Describe the concept of moiré techniques of strain analysis.
CO4 : Describe the defects by using various Non-destructive Testing methods.
MEASUREMENTS AND EXTENSOMETERS 15
Principles of measurements – Accuracy – Sensitivity and range of measurements – Mechanical, Acoustical, Optical and
Electrical extensometers and their types, Uses, Advantages and disadvantages – Principle and operation of electrical
resistance strain gauges – Materials for strain gauges – Calibration and temperature compensation – Rosette analysis –
Wheatstone bridge and potentiometer circuits for static and dynamic strain measurements – Product manufacturers in
India and in abroad.
PHOTOELASTICITY AND BRITTLE COATING 18
Two dimensional photo elasticity – Stress optic law Interpretation of fringe pattern – Compensation and separation
techniques – Photo elastic materials – Relation between stresses in coating – Use of failure theories in brittle coating –
Moire method of strain analysis.
NON – DESTRUCTIVE TESTING 12
Fundamentals of NDT Radiography – Ultrasonic – Magneti particle inspection – Fluorescent penetrant technique –
Eddy current testing – Acoustic Emission Technique – Holography – Thermograph – Fiber-optic Sensors.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Srinath L.S. Raghava M.R. Lingaiah K.Garagesha G. Pant B.and Ramachandra K., “Experimental Stress Analysis”,
Tata Mc Graw Hill, 1984.
2. Baldev Raj, Jayakumar.T, Thavasimuthu.M, “Practical Non-destructive Testing”, 2nd Edition, Woodhead Publishing
Limited, 2002.
REFERENCES
1. Hetyenyi M. “Hand book of Experimental Stress Analysis” John Wiley and Sons Inc., 1972.
2. Dally, J.W. and Riley, W.F., “Experimental Stress Analysis”, College House Enterprises, 2005.
PREREQUISITES
16AE206 Mechanics of Fluids
16AE211 Incompressible Aerodynamics
16AE214 Compressible Aerodynamics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to,
CO1 : Describe the basics of viscous flow.
CO2 : Predict and apply the governing equations of boundary layers.
CO3 : Solve the laminar boundary layer problems.
CO4 : Solve the turbulent boundary layer problems
VISCOUS FLOW 15
Fundamental equations of viscous flow – Governing Equation – Dimensional parameters in viscous flow – Non-
dimensionalising the basic equations and boundary conditions – Boundary layer flow – Development of boundary layer,
Displacement thickness, Momentum and Energy thickness.
LAMINAR BOUNDARY LAYER 15
Laminar boundary layer equations – Boundary layer over a curved body – Flow separation – Similarity solutions – Blasius
solution for flat plate flow – Boundary layer temperature profiles for constant plate temperature – Reynold’s analogy –
Integral equation of Boundary layer – Thermal boundary layer calculations.
TURBULENT BOUNDARY LAYER 15
Turbulence – Physical and mathematical description – Two-dimensional turbulent boundary layer equations – Velocity
profiles – The law of the wall – The law of the wake – Turbulent flow in pipes and channels – Turbulent boundary layer
on a flat plate – Boundary layers with pressure gradient, Eddy Viscosity, mixing length , Turbulence modeling.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. White, F. M., “Viscous Fluid Flow”, 3rd Edition, Mc Graw Hill, 2005.
2. Ian. J. Sobey, “Introduction to interactive Boundary Layer Theory”, 1st Edition, Oxford University Press, 2001.
REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Schlichting, H., “Boundary Layer Theory”, 8th Edition, Springer Publishers, 2000.
2. Reynolds, A, J., “Turbulent Flows Engineering”, Reprint Edition, John Wiley and Sons, 1980.
3. Reynolds. J., “Turbulent flows in Engineering”, 1st Edition, John Wiley & Sons,1992.
WEB REFERENCE
1. https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_me04/preview
PREREQUISITE
16AE213 Propulsion
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the construction, working principles and design considerations of a rocket.
CO2 : Summarize the various types of propellant characteristics and combustion instability of a rocket.
CO3 : Explain the propellant feed systems and utilization of Thrust vector control methods.
CO4 : Describe the selection of material requirements and its performances.
FUNDAMENTALS OF ROCKETS 10
Introduction to rockets – Classification – Definitions: Rocket thrust, Exhaust velocity, Specific Impulse, Vehicle acceleration,
Effective exhaust velocity, Characteristic velocity, Mass ratio, Propellant mass fraction, Burning time, Total impulse –
Thrust coefficient – Isentropic flow throw nozzles – Under and over expanded nozzles.
SOLID PROPELLANT ROCKETS 12
Grain geometry – Propellant characteristics – Liners, Insulator and Inhibitors – Propellant processing and manufacturing
– Combustion instability – Casing – Common Nozzle configurations – Rocket motor design.
LIQUID PROPELLANT ROCKETS 12
Fundamentals – Liquid propellants – Propellant feed systems – Propellant tanks – Valves and pipe lines – Injectors,
Design consideration of thrust chambers – Cooling methods – Thrust Vector Control – Methods –Thrust Termination –
Relative advantages of liquid rockets over solid rockets – Hybrid rocket propulsion.
MATERIALS AND TESTING OF ROCKETS 11
Selection of Materials – Special requirements of materials to perform under adverse conditions – Ablative materials –
Rocket testing – Types – Plume effects – Safety and Environmental concerns.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. George P. Sutton and Oscar Biblarz “Rocket Propulsion Elements”, 7th Edition, Wiley Pvt Ltd, 2010.
2. Cornelisse.J.W. “Rocket Propulsion and Space Dynamics”, J.W. Freeman & Co. Ltd., 1982.
REFERENCES
1. Davenas.A, “Solid Rocket Propulsion Technology”, Pergamon, 2012.
2. Martin J.L Turner, “Rocket and Spacecraft Propulsion”, 3rd Edition, Springer, 2013.
3. Dieter k. Huzel and David H. Huang “Modern Engineering for Design of Liquid-Propellant Rocket Engines”
American Institute of Aeronautics & Astronautics, 1992.
4. Ramamurthi. K, “Rocket Propulsion”, Laxmi Publications Pvt. Ltd, 2016.
WEB REFERENCE
1. http://www.nptelvideos.in/2012/12/rocket-propulsion.html
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Illustrate the air transport commercial practices and uses.
CO2 : Explain the management perspectives.
CO3 : Explain about the economical strategy of airline industry.
CO4 : Describe the scheduling procedures based on various factors.
AVIATION INDUSTRY & AIRLINE MANAGEMENT 15
Development of air transportation – Comparison with other modes of transport – Role of IATA and ICAO – The general
aviation industry airline – Factors affecting general aviation – uses of aircraft – Airport: Airline management and Organization
– Levels of management, functions of management, Principles of Organization planning the Organization – Chart, Staff
departments and line departments.
AIRLINE ECONOMICS 15
Forecasting: purposes, methods – Airline pricing: pricing and demand, types of passenger fares, pricing process, airline
costs, pricing and output determination – Aircraft selection process: Technical aspects, Fleet rationalization, Fleet
commonality, Factors affecting choice of fleet, Fleet planning process.
PRINCIPLES OF AIRLINES SCHEDULING 15
Equipment maintenance – Flight operations and crew scheduling – Ground operations and facility limitations – Equipments
and types of schedule – Hub & spoke scheduling – Aircraft reliability – Maintenance schedule and its determination –
Aircraft scheduling with reference to engineering.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. L Alexander T Wells,”Air Transportation”, 7th Edition ,Wadsworth Publishing Company, 2011.
2. Fedric J.H. “Airport Management”, Digitized Edition, Richard D. Irwing, 2007.
REFERENCES
1. Gene Kropf “Airline Procedures”, Himalayan Book house, 1949.
2. Wilson & Bryon “Air Transportation”. Himalayan Book house , 2006.
3. Philip Locklin D “Economics of Transportation”, Richard D. Irwing, 1972.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Discuss the scope and importance of business and ownership in real life situation.
CO2 : Predict the micro and macro economics to perform breakeven analysis for engineering decisions.
CO3 : Infer the market structure and the time value of money and to review the Indian economy and the various
monetary policies adopted by the government.
FORMS OF BUSINESS OWNERSHIP 9
Introduction to Forms of business ownership – Sole Proprietorship, Partnership, Company, Cooperatives – Selection of
an appropriate form of business ownership.
OVERVIEW OF MSME IN INDIA 9
Micro Small and Medium Enterprises – Essential Characteristics, Scope and Objectives – Government support policies for
MSME’s in India – Environmental Clearance for SMEs – Environmental Restrictions for SSI Sector – E nvironmental
Clearance Process.
FUNDAMENTALS OF ETHICS AND MANAGEMENT ACCOUNTING 9
Management accounting – Principles of Financial accounting and Basic concepts – Financial statements – Accounting
ratios – Funds flow statement – Cash flow statement.
EVALUATINGALTERNATIVE INVESTMENTS 9
Real Estate – Investment Property – Equipment Replace Analysis – Depreciation – Tax before and after depreciation –
Value Added Tax (VAT) – Inflation.
ECONOMICS AND FUNDS MANAGEMENT 9
Economics – Relationship between science and Engineering – Micro and Macro Economics – Project Finance – Sources
of finance – Working Capital Management – Inventory valuation – Mortgage Financing.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Blank, L.T., and Tarquin.A.J., “Engineering Economy”,7th Edition, Mc Graw Hill Book Co., 2011.
2. Patel, B.M., “Project management strategic Financial Planning, Evaluation and Control”, Vikas Publishing House
Pvt. Ltd., 2000.
3. Prasanna Chandra, “Fundamentals of Financial Management”, 8th Edition, Tata Mc Graw Hill, 2012.
REFERENCES
1. Collier C and GlaGola C, “Engineering Economics and Cost Analysis”, 4th Edition, Addison Wesley Education
Publishers, 1998.
2. Shrivastava,U.K., “Construction Planning and Management”, 2nd Edition, Galgotia Publications Pvt. Ltd., 2000.
3. L. M. Prasad, “Principles and Practices of Management”, 1st Edition, Sultan Chand, 2014.
4. Kulkarni. P. V and Satya Prasad. B. G, “Financial Management”, 16th Edition, Himalaya Publishing House, 2014.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the basic necessity of air traffic control services and its operations.
CO2 : Illustrate the functions of radar and various air traffic service responsibilities.
CO3 : Interpret the aerodrome design requirements in runway markings and lighting systems.
CO4 : Describe the significance of visual aids used in airports.
BASIC CONCEPTS 15
Objectives of ATS – Parts of ATC service – VFR and IFR operations – Classification of ATS air spaces in India and
overseas airport – Altimeter setting procedures – Varies kinds of separation – Vertical lateral and longitudinal separations
based on time / distance – RNAV and RNP – ATC clearances – Flight plans – Position report.
ATC SERVICES 15
Radar service – Identification procedures using primary/secondary radar – Use of radar in area and approach control
services – Assurance control and coordination between radar / non radar control – Emergency service – Flight information
and advisory service – Alerting service – Co–ordination and emergency procedures – Rules of the air.
AERODROME PHYSICAL DATA AND NAVIGATION SERVICES 15
Aerodrome data–Aerodrome reference code – Aerodrome reference point – Aerodrome elevation – Aerodrome reference
temperature – Instrument runway physical Characteristics: length of primary and secondary runway– Visual aids for
navigation–Wind direction indicator – Landing direction indicator – Various markings–general requirements – Various
lighting systems – Aerodrome beacon, Identification beacon – VASI and PAPI – Visual aids for denoting obstacles.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Nolan M S, “Fundamentals of Air Traffic Control” 5th Edition, CENGAGE Learning, 2010.
2. DGCA, “Aircraft Manual” (India) Volume I & II”, The Sterling book house, 2016.
REFERENCES
1. AAI, “Manual of air traffic services”,4th Edition, Part–I, 2015.
2. ICAO 9157 Document, “Aerodrome Design Manual” 1st Edition, Part–VI, 2016.
PREREQUISITE
16AE209 Aircraft Safety and Maintenance Practices
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the function of each component in piston engine and its maintenance checks.
CO2 : Explain about inspection schedules and troubleshooting methodology with the NDT testing techniques.
CO3 : Describe the various materials, fuels and preservation techniques used in the aviation workshop.
CO4 : Explain the various jet engines maintenance and overhaul procedures for the health monitoring.
PISTON ENGINE AND ITS MAINTENANCE 15
Types of piston engines – Principles of operation – Function of components – Materials used – Details of starting the
engines – Details of carburetion and injection systems – Ignition system components – Spark plug details – Induction,
Exhaust and Cooling systems – Engine operating conditions at various altitudes – Compression testing of cylinders –
Engine fuel control and exhaust systems – Engine mount and super charger.
TOOLS, TROUBLESHOOTING AND INSPECTION 15
Troubleshooting steps – Tools and equipment requirements for various checks and alignment during overhauling –
Tools for inspection – Maintenance and Inspection check to be carried out in the aviation industry – Tools for safety –
Methods and Instruments for Non Destructive Testing Techniques – Engine testing procedures and schedule preparation
– Line maintenance – Hangar maintenance.
JET ENGINE AND ITS OVERHAUL PROCEDURES 15
Types of jet engines – Principles of operation – Functions of components – Materials used – Details of starting and
operating procedures – Types of lubrication and fuels used – Gas turbine engine inspection and checks – Gas turbine
testing procedures – Special inspection procedures: Foreign Object Damage – Storage of Engines – Preservation and
depreservation procedures – Engine Overhaul procedures – Procedures for rectification – Condition monitoring of the
engine on round and at altitude – Engine health monitoring and corrective methods.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Kroes and Wild, “Aircraft Power plants” 8th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill, 2014.
2. Treager, “Aircraft Gas Turbine Engine Technology”, 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw Hill, 2002.
REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Mangham E and Peace A, “Jet Engine Manual”, Sterling Book House, 2006.
2. Casamassa and Bent,” Jet Aircraft Power Systems”, Sterling Book House, 2011.
3. Pratt and Whitney, “The Aircraft Gas turbine Engine and its Operation”, 3rd Edition, United Technologies, 1988.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Recognize the use of various types of permanent fastening and sheet metal maintenance and repair.
CO2 : Explain the primary defects to be noted and procedure to rectify the same.
CO3 : Describe the problems in aircraft systems and maintenance.
CO4 : Describe the safety precautions and practices.
AIRFRAME WELDING AND MAINTANANCE 15
Equipments used in welding shop and their maintenance – Ensuring quality welds – Welding jigs and fixtures –Soldering
and brazing. Inspection of damage – Classification: Repair or replacement – Sheet metal inspection – N.D.T. Testing –
Riveted repair design Damage investigation – Reverse technology.
Review of types of plastics used in airplanes – Maintenance and repair of plastic components – Repair of cracks holes etc.
– Various repair schemes – Scopes – Inspection and Repair of composite components – Special precautions – Autoclaves.
HYDRAULIC AND PNEUMATIC SYSTEM MAINTANANCE 15
Trouble shooting and maintenance practices – Service and inspection – Inspection and maintenance of landing gear
systems – Inspection and maintenance of air–conditioning and pressurization system water and waste system – Installation
and maintenance of Instruments – Handling – Testing – Inspection – Inspection and maintenance of auxiliary systems –
Fire protection systems – Ice protection system – Rain removal system – Position and warning system – Auxiliary Power
Units (APUs).
AIRCRAFT CONTROL ASSEMBLY MAINTENANCE AND SAFETY PRECAUTIONS 15
Balancing of control surfaces – Inspection and maintenance – Helicopter flight controls – Tracking and balancing of main
rotor – Hazardous materials storage and handling Aircraft furnishing practices – Equipments – Trouble shooting –
Theory and practices.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Kroes, Watkins and Delp, “Aircraft Maintenance and Repair” 3rd Edition, McGraw–Hill, 1992.
2. Harry A Kinnison, “Aviation Maintenance Management, 2nd Edition, McGraw–Hill, 2004.
REFERENCES
1. Larry Reithmeir, “Aircraft Repair Manual”, Palamar Books, 1992.
2. Brimm D.J. Bogges H.E, “Aircraft Maintenance”, Pitman Publications, 1940.
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the fundamentals of helicopter maintenance and the head maintenance of main rotor system.
CO2 : Understand the operations of various control systems.
CO3 : Explain the maintenance of dampener, mast, main rotor transmission systems and its components.
CO4 : Describe the maintenance of power plant tail rotor and airframes of helicopter.
HELICOPTER FUNDAMENTAL 12
Basic directions – Ground handling bearing – Gears – Flight control systems collective – Cyclic-Mast and Flight Control
Rotor – Mast Stabilizer – Dampeners – Swash plate– Push pull tubes – Torque tubes – Bell cranks – Mixer box.
MAIN ROTOR SYSTEM 12
Head maintenance – Blade alignment – Static main rotor balance – Vibration – Tracking – Span wise dynamic balance –
Blade sweeping – Electronic balancing – Dampener maintenance – Counter weight adjustment – Auto rotation adjustments
–– Gradient unit control boosts.
MAIN ROTOR TRANSMISSIONS & TAIL ROTORS 10
Engine transmission coupling – Drive shaft – Maintenance clutch – Freewheeling units – Sprag clutch – Roller unit –
Torque meter – Rotor brake – Maintenance of these components – Vibrations – Mounting systems – Transmissions – Tail
rotor system – Servicing tail rotor track – System rigging.
POWER PLANTS, AIRFRAMES AND RELATED SYSTEMS 11
Fixed wing power plant modifications – Installation – Different type of power plant maintenance – Fuselage maintenance
– Airframe Systems – Special purpose equipment.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOK
1. Jeppesen, “Helicopter Maintenance”, 2nd Edition, Jeppesons and Sons Inc., 2000.
REFERENCE
1. “Civil Aircraft Inspection Procedures”, Part I and II, CAA English Book House, 1986.
PREREQUISITES
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
16MA204 Laplace Transforms and Vector Calculus
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Formulate and solve real life situations involving linear variables.
CO2 : Optimize transportation and assignment problems.
CO3 : Plan inventory situations.
CO4 : Construct and interpret project network.
LINEAR PROGRAMMING 10
Formulation of Linear Programming models – Graphical solution – Simplex method – Artificial Variable Techniques –
Duality – Primal dual relationship – Dual Simplex method.
TRANSPORTATION AND ASSIGNMENT PROBLEMS 15
Transportation Problem – Standard transportation problem – Unbalanced transportation problem – Initial Basic feasible
solution by Vogel’s Approximation Method – Optimal solution by MODI method – Assignment problem – Standard
assignment problem – Unbalanced assignment problem – Hungarian method – Travelling salesman problem.
INVENTORY MODELS 10
Inventory Models – EOQ models (with and without shortages) – EPQ models (with and without shortages) – EOQ with
price breaks – Quantity discounts models – Inventory problems with uncertain demand.
NETWORK SCHEDULING 10
Network and basic components – Rules of network construction – Time calculations in networks – Critical path method
– Project Evaluation and Review Technique – PERT calculations – Resource Analysis in Network Scheduling.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Taha H.A., “Operation Research”, 8th Edition, Prentice Hall of India, 2011.
2. Kanti Swarup, Gupta P.K. and Manmohan, “Operations Research”, Sultan Chand & sons , 2010.
REFERENCES
1. Fredrick S. Hillier and Gerald J. Liebermann, “Introduction to Operations Research”, 8th Edition, McGraw Hill, 2011.
2. Anderson, “Quantitative Methods for Business”, 10th Edition, Thomson Learning, 2009.
3. Sharma J.K., “Operations Research Theory and Applications”, 3rd Edition, MacMillan Business Books, 2006.
WEB REFERENCE
1. https://online courses.nptel.ac.in/noc17_mg10
PREREQUISITES
16MA203 Algebra and Calculus
16MA204 Laplace Transforms and Vector Calculus
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Construct simple Probability measures for discrete and continuous random variables and compute the
expected value, variance, and moments generating functions of the distributions.
CO2 : Determine Covariance, correlation and regression using two dimensional random variables.
CO3 : Perform Testing of Hypothesis as well as calculate confidence interval for a population and Learn non-
parametric test.
CO4 : Find a basis of the subspace and construct orthogonal bases for a given basis.
PROBABILITY AND RANDOM VARIABLE 11
Random variables – Probability mass function – Probability density function – Properties – Moments – Moment generating
functions – Standard Distributions: Binomial, Poisson, Geometric, Uniform, Exponential and Normal distributions and
their properties.
TWO DIMENSIONAL RANDOM VARIABLES 10
Joint distributions – Marginal and conditional distributions – Covariance – Correlation and regression – Transformation
of random variables – Central limit theorem.
TESTING OF HYPOTHESIS 12
Sampling distributions – Testing of hypothesis for mean, variance, proportions and differences using Normal, t, and F
distributions – Chi square tests for independence of attributes and Goodness of fit.
VECTOR SPACE 12
Vector spaces over real field, Subspaces, Linear dependence, Independence, Basis, Dimension – Inner product – Gram-
Schmidt orthogonalization process – Linear transformation – Null space and nullity, Range and rank of linear transformation.
Total Periods: 45
Note: Use of approved statistical table is permitted in the examination.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Veerarajan T., “Probabilitiy, Statistics and Random process”, 4th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill Publications, 2015.
2. Jain R. K. and Iyengar, S. R. K., “Advanced Engineering Mathematics”, 5th Edition, Alpha Science Intl. Ltd, 2015.
REFERENCES
1. Ross S., “A first course in probability”, 6th Edition, Pearson Education, 2008
2. Wylie C. Ray and Barrett Louis C., “Advanced Engineering Mathematics”, 6th Edition, McGraw-Hill, Inc., 2005.
3. Gupta S.C and Kapur J.N., “Fundamentals of Mathematical Statistics”, 9th Edition, Sultan Chand, 1996.
WEB REFERENCE
1. https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc16_ma03/preview
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Recall various quality concepts and imbibe the different TQM principles like customer satisfaction and
employee involvement.
CO2 : Conceptualize continuous process improvement and recognize the importance of Employee involvement
and performance measurement.
CO3 : Apply the various statistical process control charts to improve the quality of the product.
CO4 : Apply various tools like QFD and FMEA for quality improvement
CO5 : To interpret the concept of Quality Management Systems and recognize the need for ISO 9000 and ISO
14000 Quality Systems.
TQM PRINCIPLES AND APPROACHES 6
Definition of Quality, Dimensions of Quality, Factors affecting Quality, Quality Planning, Quality costs. Principles of
TQM: Evaluation, Concept and definition of TQM, principles, Models, characteristics, and benefits of TQM. Approaches
to TQM: Deming Philosophy, Barriers to TQM Implementation.
ESSENTIALS OF TQM 11
Customer focus, types of customer- customer perception of quality, customer satisfaction, customer retention, supplier
Partnership, TQM leadership- role and commitment and accountability of leadership, quality policy and objectives,
Organizational structure for TQM, role of HR in TQM, training for TQM, developing quality culture. Business Excellence
Models and Various national total quality awards
TOOLS AND TECHNIQUES FOR TQM 22
Continuous process improvement: Juran Trilogy, PDSA Cycle, 5S, Kaizen. Taguchi's Quality Engineering - Quality Loss
Function, quality circles and poka-yoke.
Seven quality control tools, Statistical methods for quality improvement, Process control -Control charts for variables: X,
R charts and Control charts for attributes - P, np, c and u charts. Concept of Process Capability, six sigma and new seven
management tools Benchmarking - Reasons to Benchmark, Benchmarking Process, Quality Function Deployment (QFD)
- House of Quality, QFD Process, Benefits, Total Productive Maintenance (TPM) - Concept, Improvement Needs, FMEA
- Stages of FMEA.
QUALITY MANAGEMENT SYSTEM 6
Introduction; major elements, ISO 9001:2015: Structure, clauses, contents, interpretation and implementation and Quality
audit. ISO 14000: Environmental Management System, elements, Model and benefits.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Dale.H.Besterfiled, et al., "Total Quality Management", Pearson Education Asia, 2nd Edition, 1999, Indian Reprint,
2002.
2. Subburaj Ramasamy., "Total Quality Management", Tata McGraw Hill, 2005.
REFERENCES
1. James.R.Evans, and William.M.Lidsay., "Management and Control of Quality", Thompson Learning, 2005.
2. Narayana.V and Sreenivasan.N.S., "Quality Management - Concepts and Tasks", New Age Publications
International Edition, 1996
3. Kanishka Bedi., "Total Quality Management", Oxford University Press, 2006.
4. Mukherjee.P.N, "Total Quality Management", Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd.,2005.
WEB REFERENCES
http://nptel.ac.in/courses/110101010/
COURSE OUTCOMES
On the successful completion of the course, Students will able to
CO1 : Explain various forms of energy sources and its effects on the environment.
CO2 : Describe the solar energy and working of various solar systems.
CO3 : Demonstrate the Wind energy and its conversion systems.
CO4 : Describe the various Biogas Plants.
CO5 : Explain the Ocean and Geo thermal Energy systems.
CO6 : Outline the Direct and Hydrogen energy conversion systems.
ENERGYAND ENVIRONMENT 6
Primary energy sources – World energy resources–Indian energy scenario – Energy cycle of the earth –Environmental
aspects of energy utilization, CO2 emissions and Global warming – Renewable energy resources and their importance –
Potential impacts of harnessing the different renewable energy resources.
SOLAR AND WIND ENERGY 16
Principles of Solar Energy Collection – Solar Radiation – Measurements – Instruments – Data and Estimation – Types of
collectors – Characteristics and Design Principles of different type of collectors – Performance of collectors – Solar
thermal applications – Water heaters and air heaters – applications – Solar cooling – Solar drying – Solar ponds – Solar
tower concept – Solar furnace.
Energy from the wind – General theory of Windmills – Power of the wind – Types of Windmills – components and working
principles – site selection – Applications.
BIO, OCEAN AND GEO THERMAL ENERGY 14
Energy from Bio Mass and Bio Gas Plants – various sources – Fermentation, Pyrolysis, Gasification and Combustion, Bio
gas – Power generation – Design Principles of Biogas Plants – applications. Energy from wastes – Waste Burning Power
Plants – Utilization of industrial and municipal wastes – Energy from the agricultural wastes.
Energy from tides and waves – Working principles of Tidal Plants and Ocean Thermal Energy Conversion (OTEC) plants
– Power from Geothermal Energy – Geothermal resources – working principle of Geothermal Power Plants.
OTHER RENEWABLE ENERGY SOURCES 9
Direct energy conversion (Description, principle of working and basic design aspects only) – Magneto Hydrodynamic
Systems (MHD) – Thermoelectric Generators – Thermionic Generators – Fuel cells – Solar PV cells – Types, power output,
losses and efficiency and applications – Hydrogen Conversion and Storage systems.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Rai G. D., “Non–Conventional Energy Sources”, Khanna Publishers, 5th Edition, New Delhi, 2011.
2. Godfrey Boyle, “ Renewable Energy: Power for a Sustainable Future”, Oxford University Press, U.K, 1996.
REFERENCES
1. Garg H.P. and Prakash J., “Solar Energy – Fundamentals and applications”, TMH, 3rd Edition New Delhi,2012.
2. Sukhatme S.P., “Solar Energy”, TMH, 2nd Edition, 2008.
3. John F.Walker and Jenkins N., “Wind Energy Technology”, John Wiley and sons, Chichester, 1997.
WEB REFERENCE
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/108105058/8
PRE REQUISITE
16ME216 Thermal Engineering
COURSE OUTCOMES
On the successful completion of the course, Students will able to
CO1 : Describe the working principle of Fuel Injection System in Spark Ignition Engine.
CO2 : Explain the working principle of Fuel Spray penetration in Compression Ignition Engines.
CO3 : Demonstrate the occurrence of Pollution due to combustion in IC Engine and its control.
CO4 : Summarize the performance of IC Engine using Alternative Fuels.
CO5 : Recognize the developments in IC Engine.
CO6 : Outline the Engine Management System in IC Engine.
SPARK IGNITION ENGINES AND COMPRESSION IGNITION ENGINES 15
Spark ignition engine mixture requirements – Fuel, Injection systems – Monopoint and Multi point injections – Stages of
combustion – Normal and abnormal combustions – factors affecting knock – Combustion chambers.
States of combustion in C.I. Engine – Direct and indirect injection systems – Combustion chambers – Fuel spray behavior
– spray structure – spray penetration – evaporation – air motion – Introduction to Turbo charging.
POLLUTANT FORMATION AND CONTROL USING ALTERNATIVE FUELS 15
Pollutant – Sources – Formation of carbon monoxide, Unburnt hydrocarbon, NOx, Smoke and Particulate matter – Methods
of controlling Emissions – Catalytic converters and Particulate Traps – Methods of measurements – Introduction to
emission norms and Driving cycles.
Alcohol, Hydrogen, Natural Gas and Liquefied Petroleum Gas – Properties, suitability, Merits and Demerits of fuels –
Engine Modifications.
DEVELOPMENTS IN IC ENGINES 10
Homogeneous Charge Compression Ignition Engine – Plasma Ignition – Surface Ignition Engine – Lean Burn Engines –
Stratified charge Engines – Four Valve and Overhead cam Engines – Common Rail Direct Injection Diesel Engine –
Gasoline Direct Injection Engine –Multi–valving – Tuned main folding – camless valve gearing – EGR.
ENGINE MANAGEMENT SYSTEM 5
Data Acquisition System – pressure pick up, charge amplifier, Combustion and Heat release analysis in Engines – Laser
Doppler Anemometry.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. John B Heywood, “Internal Combustion Engine Fundamentals”, Tata McGraw–Hill, 2011.
2. Ganesan V., “Internal Combustion Engines”, Third Edition, Tata McGraw–Hill, 2007.
REFERENCES
1. Ramalingam K.K., “Internal Combustion Engine”, scitech publications, Chennai, 2003.
2. Heinz Heisler, “Advanced Engine Technology,” SAE International Publications, USA, 1998.
3. Robert Bosch–GmbH, “Automotive Hand Book”, Germany, 2000.
4. Benson R.S., Whitehouse N.D., Internal Combustion Engines, Pergamon Press, Oxford, 1979.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/105104099/
2. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/108103009/
3. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/112104033/
PREREQUISITE
16EC214 Digital Communication / 16AE219 – Avionics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Explain the fundamentals of RADAR communication.
CO2 : Explain the functionality of RADAR transmitter, receiver and detection.
CO3 : Describe the concepts of RADAR tracking and measurement.
CO4 : Discuss the RADAR direction finding, ranges and different radar navigational methods.
PRINCIPLES OF RADAR COMMUNICATION 15
Radar equation – Radar block diagram and operation – Radar frequencies – Millimeter and sub millimeter waves –
Applications of radar – Prediction of range performance – Minimum detectable signal – Receiver noise – Signal to noise
ratio – Matched filter impulse response – Integration of radar pulses – Radar cross section of targets – Cross section
fluctuations – Radar clutter.
Radar signals: Real, complex, analytic Radar signals – Duration – Frequency – Bandwidth of radar signals – Doppler effect
– CW radar – FMCW radar – Airborne doppler navigation – Multiple frequency CW radar.
RADAR TRANSMITTER AND RECEIVER 15
Radar Transmitters : Linear beam power tubes – Solid state RF power sources – Magnetron – Crossed field amplifiers –
Other RF power sources – Other aspects of radar transmitter – The Radar receiver – Receiver noise figure – Super
heterodyne receiver – Duplexers and receiver protectors – Radar displays – Radar detection: Optimum bayesian decision
rules – Detection criteria for different target models – Mono pulse – Optimum mono pulse systems.
RADAR SIGNAL TRACKING AND MODERN NAVIGATION 15
Range and doppler measurements and tracking – Range and doppler frequency resolutions – Optimum receivers –
Optimum filters for doppler measurements – Coherent and non coherent implementations – Angle measurement and
tracking by conical scan.
Modern navigation: Aids to approach and landing – Instrument landing system – Ground controlled approach system –
Microwave landing system – Distance measuring equipment – TACAN – Doppler frequency equations – Track stabilization
– Doppler navigation system – GPS principle of operation – Position location determination – GPS receiver.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Merrill I Skolnik, “Introduction to Radar System”, 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw Hill Education, 2003.
2. Peyton Z Peebles, “Radar Principles”, John Wiley, 2004.
REFERENCES
1. Toomay J.C., “Principles of Radar”, 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall of India, 2004.
2. Nadav Levanon, “Radar Signals”, 1st Edition, IEEE Computer Society Press, 2004.
3. N.S. Nagaraja, “Elements of Electronic Navigation”, 2nd Edition, Tata McGraw Hill Education, 2006.
PREREQUISITE
16EC214 Digital Communication / 16AE219 – Avionics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Describe the basic concepts of satellite communication and orbit dynamics.
CO2 : Explain the concept of geostationary orbits and space segment components.
CO3 : Estimate satellite losses, link and power budget.
CO4 : Describe the concepts of satellite access techniques and applications.
BASIC PRINCIPLES OF SATELLITE COMMUNICATION 9
Introduction – Frequency allocations for satellite services – Kepler’s laws of planetary motion – Definitions of terms for
earth orbiting satellites – Orbital elements – Apogee and perigee heights – Orbital perturbations – Effects of a nonspherical
earth – Atmospheric drag – Inclined orbits.
GEOSTATIONARY ORBIT AND SPACE SEGMENT 12
Introduction – Antenna look angles – The polar mount antenna – Limits of visibility – Near geostationary orbits – Earth
eclipse of satellite – Sun transit outage – Launching orbits – Problems – Power supply – Altitude control – Spinning
satellite stabilization – Momentum wheel stabilization – Station keeping – Thermal control – TT & C subsystem –
Transponders – Wideband receiver – Input demultiplexer – Power amplifier – Antenna subsystem.
SATELLITE LINK DESIGN 12
Equivalent isotropic radiated power – Transmission losses – Free space transmission – Feeder losses – Antenna
misalignment losses – Fixed atmospheric and ionospheric losses – Link – Power budget equation – System noise –
Antenna noise – Amplifier noise temperature – Amplifiers in cascade – Noise factor – Noise temperature of absorptive
networks – Overall system noise temperature – Combined uplink and downlink C/N ratio – Intermodulation noise – Effects
of rain.
SATELLITE ACCESS AND APPLICATIONS 12
Multiple access schemes: FDMA, TDMA, CDMA – VSAT systems – Basic techniques – VSAT earth station engineering
– System design – Overview of GPS.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOKS
1. Dennis Roddy, “Satellite Communication”, 4th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill Education Pvt. Ltd., 2006.
2. Timothy Pratt, Charles Bostian and Jeremy Allnutt, “Satellite Communications”, 2nd Edition, John Wiley & Sons
(Asia) Pvt. Ltd., 2004.
REFERENCES
1. Wilbur L. Pritchard, Hendri G. Suyderhoud and Robert A. Nelson, “Satellite Communication Systems Engineering”,
2nd Edition, Prentice Hall, 1993.
2. Richharia M., “Satellite Communication Systems: Design Principles”, 2nd Edition, MacMillan, 2001.
3. Pratt and Bostian, “Satellite Communication”, 2nd Edition, John Wiley, 2003.
WEB REFERENCES
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/117105131/
PREREQUISITE
16EC205 Anagalog Electronics / 16AE219 - Avionics
COURSE OUTCOMES
On successful completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1 : Outline the concepts of MEMS techniques and MEMS based wireless applications.
CO2 : Explain the concepts of RF MEMS enabled circuit elements.
CO3 : Illustrate the operation of RF MEMS reconfigurable circuits.
CO4 : Describe the operation of MEMS filters and oscillators.
INTRODUCTION 9
Conceptual wireless systems – Wireless transceiver architectures – MEMS based wireless appliances enable ubiquitous
connectivity – Physical aspects of RF circuit design – Transmission lines on thin substrates – Self-resonance frequency
–Quality factor – Packaging – Practical aspects of RF circuit design – Dc biasing – Impedance mismatch effects in RF
MEMS.
RF MEMS ENABLED CIRCUIT ELEMENTS 14
RF/Microwave substrate properties – Micromachined enhanced elements – Capacitors – Inductors – Varactors – MEM
switches – Shunt MEM switch – Push-pull series switch – Folded beam springs suspension series switch – Transmission
line planar resonators – Cavity resonators – micromechanical resonators – Film bulk acoustic wave resonators – MEMS
modeling – Mechanical modeling – Electromagnetic modelling.
RECONFIGURABLE CIRCUITS 14
Reconfigurable circuit elements – The resonant MEMS switch – Capacitors – Inductors – Tunable CPW resonator –
MEMS microswitch arrays – Double – Stub tuner – Filters – Resonator tuning system – Massively parallel switchable RF
front ends– Reconfigurable antennas – Tunable dipole antennas – Tunable microstrip patch – Array antenna – Phase
shifters – Concepts – True time – Delay digital phase shifters.
FILTERS & OSCILLATORS 8
Film bulk acoustic wave filters – FBAR filter fundamentals – FBAR filter for PCS applications – RF MEMS filters – A Ka-
Band millimeter – Wave Micromachined tunable filter – RF MEMS Oscillators – Concepts.
Total Periods: 45
TEXT BOOK
1. Hector J. De Los Santos, “RF MEMS Circuit Design for Wireless Communications”, Artech House, 2002.
REFERENCES
1. Vijay K.Varadan, K.J. Vinoy and K.A. Jose, “RF MEMS and their Applications”, Wiley India Pvt. Ltd, 2011.
2. Gabriel M. Rebeiz, “RF MEMS Theory, Design & Technology”, Wiley India Pvt. Ltd, 2010.
WEB REFERENCE
1. http://nptel.ac.in/courses/117105082/